X.S0057-B v1.0 - 20121018 - HRPD
X.S0057-B v1.0 - 20121018 - HRPD
X.S0057-B v1.0 - 20121018 - HRPD
0
October, 2012
E-UTRAN - eHRPD
Connectivity and Interworking: Core Network
Aspects
2012 3GPP2
3GPP2 and its Organizational Partners claim copyright in this document and individual Organizational
Partners may copyright and issue documents or standards publications in individual Organizational Partner's
name based on this document. Requests for reproduction of this document should be directed to the 3GPP2
Secretariat at secretariat@3gpp2.org. Requests to reproduce individual Organizational Partner's documents
should be directed to that Organizational Partner. See www.3gpp2.org for more information.
REVISION HISTORY
Revision
Description of Changes
Date
Rev 0 v1.0
April 2009
Rev 0 v2.0
December 2009
Rev 0 v3.0
September 2010
Rev A v1.0
Rev A v2.0
October 2012
Rev B v1.0
October 2012
April 2011
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
CONTENTS
1
8
9
10
11
Introduction .............................................................................................................................................. 1
1.1
Scope.......................................................................................................................................... 1
1.2
1.3
References .................................................................................................................................. 2
1.3.1
Normative References ................................................................................................. 2
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
4.2
4.3
4.4
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
Definitions ................................................................................................................................. 8
2.1.1
Symbols and Abbreviations ....................................................................................... 11
60
4.4.4
4.4.5
4.4.6
4.5
4.6
4.7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
4.8
PPP/VSNCP Renegotiation...................................................................................................... 71
4.9
26
30
4.10
4.11
25
27
28
29
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
4.12
4.13
4.14
4.15
4.16
53
55
5.1
5.2
47
48
49
50
51
52
54
56
57
58
59
60
ii
5.2.1
5.2.2
5.2.3
1
2
3
4
5
6
5.3
5.4
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
6.1
17
6.2
18
6.3
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Gxa Interface between the HSGW and the PCRF ................................................................................ 121
7.1
7.2
7.3
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
A11 Interface between the HSGW and the eAN/ePCF ........................................................................ 124
Main Service Connection between the UE and the HSGW ................................................... 126
9.1.1
Establishment of a Main Service Connection .......................................................... 126
9.1.2
HSGW-UE Link Layer Encapsulation .................................................................... 126
9.1.3
PPP-Based Main Service Connection ...................................................................... 127
9.1.4
3GPP2 Vendor Specific Network Control Protocol (VSNCP) Packet for PDN
Connectivity ............................................................................................................ 127
9.1.5
3GPP2 Vendor Specific Network Protocol (VSNP) Packet Format ........................ 139
9.1.6
RSVP Protocol......................................................................................................... 140
9.1.7
Always On Service in eHRPD ................................................................................. 153
9.1.8
PPP Link Maintenance ............................................................................................ 154
9.1.9
HSGW Requirements for UE Context Maintenance ............................................... 156
9.1.10 Version Indication ................................................................................................... 157
9.1.11 Capability Indication ............................................................................................... 157
9.1.12 IPCP Handling ......................................................................................................... 157
9.2
Auxiliary Service Connections between the UE and the HSGW ........................................... 158
9.2.1
PDN Identifier Description ...................................................................................... 159
9.3
57
9.4
58
9.5
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
59
60
iii
9.6
3GPP2 Vendor Specific Extension for LCP Echo-Request packet ........................................ 162
9.6.1
Information Elements for LCP Echo-Request packet .............................................. 163
1
2
3
10
10.1
13
10.2
10.3
10.4
6
7
8
10
11
12
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
11
11.2
Intra-eHRPD Handoff with HSGW Relocation without Context Transfer ............................ 191
11.3
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
12
12.2
13
14
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
13.1
13.2
55
57
54
56
58
59
60
iv
15
15.1
15.2
15.3
15.4
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
16
Annex A (Informative) Mapping QoS between 3GPP and 3GPP2 ................................................... 251
17
Annex B (Informative) Mapping Gxa Parameters between 3GPP and 3GPP2 ................................. 256
18
Annex C (Informative) CDR Parameters Supported for Offline Charging ....................................... 260
19
20
Annex E (Informative) Deriving 3GPP2 Network Parameters from 3GPP EPS Parameters ............ 265
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Figure 5
Figure 6
Figure 7
Figure 8
Figure 9
Figure 10
Figure 11
Figure 12
Figure 13
Figure 14
Figure 15
Figure 16
Figure 17
Figure 18
Figure 19
Figure 20
Figure 21
Figure 22
Figure 23
Figure 24
Figure 25
Figure 26
Figure 27
Figure 28
Figure 29
Figure 30
Figure 31
Figure 32
Figure 33
Figure 34
Figure 35
Figure 36
Figure 37
Figure 38
Figure 39
Figure 40
Figure 41
Figure 42
Figure 43
Figure 44
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
vi
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
Figure 45
Figure 46
Figure 47
Figure 48
Figure 49
Figure 50
Figure 51
Figure 52
Figure 53
Figure 54
Figure 55
Figure 56
Figure 57
Figure 58
Figure 59
Figure 60
Figure 61
Figure 62
Figure 63
24
25
26
27
28
Figure 64
Figure 65
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
vii
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1
Table 2
Table 3
Table 4
Table 5
Table 6
Table 7
Table 8
Table 9
Table 10
Table 11
Table 12
Table 13
Table 14
Table 15
Table 16
Table 17
Table 18
Table 19
Table 20
Table 21
Table 22
Table 23
Table 24
Table 25
Table 26
Table 27
Table 28
Table 29
Table 30
Table 31
Table 32
Table 33
Table 34
Table 35
Table 36
Table 37
Table 38
Table 39
Table 40
Table 41
Table 42
Table 43
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
viii
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
Table 44
Table 45
Table 46
Table 47
Table 48
Table 49
Table 50
Table 51
Table 52
Table 53
Table 54
Table 55
Table 56
Table 57
Table 58
Table 59
Table 60
Table 61
Table 62
Table 63
Table 64
Table 65
Table 66
Table 67
Table 68
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
ix
FOREWORD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
This document contains portions of material copied from 3GPP document number(s):
14
15
16
TS 23.401
17
18
19
TS 23.402
20
21
TS 33.402
22
23
The copyright on the 3GPP documents is owned by the Organizational Partners of 3GPP
(ARIB - Association of Radio Industries and Businesses, Japan; CCSA- the China
Communications Standards Association, China; ETSI European Telecommunications
Standards Institute; ATIS, USA- Alliance for Telecommunication Industry Solutions; TTA Telecommunications Technology Association, Korea; and TTC Telecommunication
Technology Committee, Japan), which have granted license for reproduction and for use by
3GPP2 and its Organizational Partners.
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
This document is subject to change following formal approval. Should this document be
modified, it will be re-released with a change of release date and an identifying change in
version number as follows:
33
37
34
35
36
38
39
where:
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
cdma2000 is the trademark for the technical nomenclature for certain specifications and
standards of the Organizational Partners (OPs) of 3GPP2. Geographically (and as of the date
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
1
2
Introduction
This document provides a specification of the functions and interfaces of the evolved High
Rate Packet Data (eHRPD) Serving Gateway (HSGW) and the IP level interfaces of the
eHRPD user equipment (UE).
4
5
6
The eHRPD network provides an IP environment that supports attachment to multiple Packet
Data Networks (PDNs) and allocation of IPv4 address or IPv6 address or both IPv4 and IPv6
addresses for each PDN via the 3GPP Evolved Packet Core (EPC). The UE uses networkbased mobility and relies on the use of Proxy Mobile IPv6 (PMIPv6) within the network for
mobility management.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1.1
16
Scope
The scope of this document covers support for an evolved access terminal (UE as known in
this specification) using the eHRPD air interface and the S101 tunnel to access the core
network architecture defined in 3GPP TS 23.401 [24] and TS 23.402 [25]. Specifically, this
specification covers:
17
18
19
20
21
22
An interface between the HRPD Serving Gateway (HSGW) and the Packet Data Network
Gateway (P-GW, also known as PDN GW) and procedures for that interface.
An interface between the UE and the HSGW and procedures for that interface.
An interface between the HSGW and the PCRF and procedures for that interface.
An interface between the HSGW and the AAA and procedures for that interface.
An interface from the S-GW to the HSGW to support data forwarding during handoff
from E-UTRAN to eHRPD.
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
1.2
Document Convention
Shall and shall not identify requirements to be followed strictly to conform to the
standard and from which no deviation is permitted. Should and should not indicate that
one of several possibilities is recommended as particularly suitable, without mentioning or
excluding others; that a certain course of action is preferred but not necessarily required; or
that (in the negative form) a certain possibility or course of action is discouraged but not
prohibited. May and need not indicate a course of action permissible within the limits of
the standard. Can and cannot are used for statements of possibility and capability,
whether material, physical, or causal.
50
51
52
53
All fields that are marked as Reserved shall be filled with zeros by the sender of that field,
and shall be ignored by the receiver of that field.
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
1.3
References
1
2
3
4
1.3.1
Normative References
This section provides references to other specifications and standards that are necessary to
implement this document.
7
8
9
10
The following standards contain provisions which, through reference in this text, constitute
provisions of this Standard. At the time of publication, the editions indicated were valid. All
standards are subject to revision, and parties to agreements based on this Standard are
encouraged to investigate the possibility of applying the most recent editions of the standards
indicated below.
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
11
12
13
14
15
16
3GPP2: A.S0008-C v4.0: Interoperability Specification (IOS) for High Rate Packet
Data (HRPD) Radio Access Network Interfaces with Session Control in the Access
Network, April 2011. (HRPD IOS)
17
3GPP2: A.S0009-C v4.0: Interoperability Specification (IOS) for High Rate Packet
Data (HRPD) Radio Access Network Interfaces with Session Control in the Packet
Control Function, April 2011. (HRPD IOS)
21
18
19
20
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
39
[8]
3GPP2: X.S0060-0 v1.0: HRPD Support for Emergency Services, July 2008.
42
[9]
[6]
[7]
[10]
3GPP2: C.S0024-B v3.0: cdma2000 High Rate Packet Data Air Interface
Specification, June 2012.
37
38
40
41
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
[11]
[12]
[13]
3GPP2: C.S0054-A v1.0: cdma2000 High Rate Broadcast-Multicast Packet Data Air
Interface Specification, March 2006.
51
54
3GPP2: C.S0063-B v1.0: cdma2000 High Rate Packet Data Supplemental Services,
May 2010.
57
52
53
55
56
58
59
60
[14]
3GPP2: C.S0067-A v1.0: Generic Key Exchange Protocol for cdma2000 High Rate
Packet Data Air Interface, February 2009.
[15]
[16]
[17]
[18]
3GPP: TS 22.278: Service requirements for the Evolved Packet System (EPS),
(Release 10).
[19]
[20]
3GPP: TS 23.060: General Packet Radio Service (GPRS); Service description; Stage
2, (Release 10).
[21]
[22]
[23]
3GPP: TS 23.261: IP flow mobility and seamless Wireless Local Area Network
(WLAN) offload; Stage 2, (Release 10).
[24]
[25]
[26]
[27]
3GPP: TS 24.301: Non-access Stratum (NAS) Protocol for Evolved Packet System
(EPS), Stage 3, (Release 10).
[28]
3GPP: TS 24.302: Access to the 3GPP Evolved Packet Core (EPC) via non-3GPP
access networks; Stage 3, (Release 10).
[29]
3GPP: TS 29.060: GPRS Tunnelling Protocol (GTP) across the Gn and Gp interface,
(Release 10).
[30]
3GPP: TS 29.061: Interworking between the Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN)
supporting packet-based services and Packet Data Networks (PDN), (Release 10).
[31]
3GPP: TS 29.212: Policy and charging control over Gx reference point, (Release
10).
[32]
3GPP: TS 29.213: Policy and Charging Control signalling flows and QoS parameter
mapping, (Release 10).
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
[33]
[34]
3GPP: TS 29.214: Policy and charging control over Rx reference point, (Release
10).
3GPP: TS 29.229: Cx and Dx Interfaces based on the Diameter Protocol; Protocol
Details, (Release 10).
1
2
3
4
5
6
[36]
11
[37]
3GPP: TS 29.275: Proxy Mobile IPv6 (PMIPv6) based Mobility and Tunnelling
protocols; Stage 3, (Release 10).
13
[35]
[38]
[39]
[40]
3GPP: TS 29.276: Optimized Handover Procedures and Protocols Between EUTRAN Access and cdma2000 HRPD Access Stage 3, (Release 10).
3GPP: TS 32.240: Charging Management; Charging Architecture and Principles,
(Release 10).
3GPP: TS 32.251: Charging Management; Packet Switched (PS) domain charging,
(Release 10).
8
9
10
12
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
[41]
26
[42]
3GPP: TS 32.422: Subscriber and equipment trace; Trace control and configuration
management, (Release 10).
29
[43]
32
[44]
[45]
[46]
27
28
30
31
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
IETF: RFC 1332: McGregor, The PPP Internet Protocol Control Protocol (IPCP),
May 1992.
43
[48]
IETF: RFC 1661: Simpson, The Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP), July 1994.
46
[49]
IETF: RFC 1962: Rand, The PPP Compression Control Protocol (CCP), June
1996.
48
[47]
[50]
IETF: RFC 2131: Dorms, Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol, March 1997.
[51]
[52]
44
45
47
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
[53]
IETF: RFC 2460: Deering, et. al., Internet Protocol, Version 6 (IPv6)
Specification, December 1998.
[54]
IETF: RFC 2461: Narten, et. al., Neighbor Discovery for IP Version 6 (IPv6),
December 1998.
[55]
IETF: RFC 2462: Thomson, et. al., IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration,
December 1998.
[56]
IETF: RFC 2463: Conta, et. al., Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMPv6) for
the Internet Protocol Version 6 (IPv6) Specification, December 1998.
[57]
IETF: RFC 2784: Farinacci, et al., Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE), March
2000.
[58]
IETF: RFC 2890: Dommety, Key and Sequence Number Extensions to GRE,
September 2000.
[59]
IETF: RFC 3041: Narten, et al., Privacy Extensions for Stateless Address
Autoconfiguration in IPv6, December 2001.
[60]
[61]
IETF: RFC 3241: Bormann, Robust Header Compression (ROHC) over PPP,
April 2002.
[62]
IETF: RFC 3315: Droms, et. al., Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol for IPv6
(DHCPv6), July 2003.
[63]
IETF: RFC 3513: Hinden, et al., Internet Protocol Version 6 (IPv6) Addressing
Architecture, April 2003.
[64]
IETF: RFC 3587: Hinden, et al., IPv6 Global Unicast Address Format, August
2003.
[65]
IETF: RFC 3588: Calhoun, et al., Diameter Base Protocol, September 2003.
[66]
IETF: RFC 3633: Troan, et al., IPv6 Prefix Options for Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol (DHCP) version 6, December 2003.
[67]
IETF: RFC 3736: Droms, Stateless Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)
Service for IPv6, April 2004.
[68]
IETF: RFC 3748: Aboba, et al., Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP), June
2004.
[69]
IETF: RFC 3772: Carlson, et al., PPP Vendor Protocol, May 2004.
[70]
[71]
IETF: RFC 4005: Calhoun, et al., Diameter Network Access Server Application,
August 2005.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
[72]
[73]
1
2
3
4
5
6
[74]
[75]
[76]
[77]
[78]
[79]
IETF: RFC 4039: Park, et al., Rapid Commit Option for the Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol version 4 (DHCPv4), March 2005.
10
IETF: RFC 4187: Arkko, et al., Extensible Authentication Protocol Method for 3rd
Generation Authentication and Key Agreement (EAP-AKA), January 2006.
13
8
9
11
12
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
[80]
IETF: RFC 5213: Gundavelli, et al., Proxy Mobile IPv6, August 2008.
26
[81]
28
31
[82]
[83]
[84]
IETF RFC 5555: Soliman, Editor, Mobile IPv6 Support for Dual Stack Hosts and
Routers, June 2009.
IETF RFC 5648: Wakikawa et al., Multiple Care-of Addresses Registration,
October 2009.
27
29
30
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
[85]
[86]
[87]
[88]
[89]
IETF RFC 5795: Sandlund et al., The RObust Header Compression (ROHC)
Framework, March, 2010.
42
IETF: RFC 5844: Wakikawa, R. and Gundavelli, S., IPv4 Support for Proxy
Mobile IPv6, May 2010.
45
IETF: RFC 5845: Muhanna, et. al., Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE) Key
Option for Proxy Mobile IPv6, June 2010.
48
IETF: RFC 5846, Muhanna, et. al.: Binding Revocation for IPv6 Mobility, June
2010.
IETF: RFC 5949, Yokota, et. al.: Fast Handovers for Mobile IPv6, September
2010.
43
44
46
47
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
[90]
IETF: RFC 6089: Tsirtsis et al.: Flow Bindings in Mobile IPv6 and Network
Mobility (NEMO) Basic Support, January 2011.
[91]
IETF: RFC 6603: Korhonen et al.: Prefix Exclude Option for DHCPv6-based
Prefix Delegation, May 2012.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
1
2
3
4
5
6
2.1
Definitions
8
9
10
APN
11
12
13
14
eAN/ePCF
15
16
eAN/ePCF includes a logical entity in the Radio Access Network (RAN) used for radio
communications with the UE and an evolved Packet Control Function entity (ePCF) that
manages the relay of packets between the eAN and the HSGW.
17
18
19
20
21
eHRPD
22
Evolved HRPD (eHRPD): The eHRPD network supports attachment to the EPC (evolved
packet core) of 3GPP. The eHRPD network optionally supports seamless handoffs between
E-UTRAN and evolved HRPD with single-radio terminals.
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
INACTIVE/NULL State
In the Inactive/Null State, there is no physical traffic channel between the UE and the eAN,
no connection exists between the eAN and the ePCF, no connection exists between the ePCF
and the HSGW, and there is no PPP link between the UE and the HSGW (ref. A.S0008/9-C
section 1.12.1 [1] and [2]). The UE may have a Universal Access Terminal Identifier (UATI)
that has been assigned by an eHRPD eAN.
DORMANT State
In the Dormant State, no physical traffic channel exists between the UE and the eAN and no
connection exists between the eAN and the ePCF. However a connection exists between the
ePCF and the HSGW and there is a PPP link between the UE and the HSGW (ref. A.S0008/9C section 1.12.1 [1]and [2]).
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
ACTIVE/CONNECTED State
In the Active/Connected State, a physical traffic channel exists between the UE and the eAN
over which data may be sent. A connection exists between the eAN and the ePCF, and
between the ePCF and the HSGW, and there is a PPP link between the UE and the HSGW.
(See A.S0008/9-C section 1.12.1 [1] and [2]).
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
Emergency Attached
A UE is defined to be Emergency Attached to the network, if the UE is connected to an
emergency PDN and has not successfully performed EAP access authentication.
Emergency Bearer Services
Emergency bearer services are provided to support IMS emergency sessions. Emergency
bearer services are functionalities provided by the serving eHRPD access network when the
network is configured to support emergency services. Emergency bearer services are provided
to normal attached UEs and depending on local regulation, to UEs that are in limited service
state.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
EPC
The evolved packet core: The EPC domain name is defined in TS 23.003 [19]. The EPC
architecture is defined in TS 23.401 [24] and TS 23.402 [25].
EPS
The evolved packet system is defined in TS 23.003 [19], TS 23.401 [24], and TS 23.402 [25].
It consists of the EPC plus the E-UTRAN.
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
EPS Bearer
An EPS bearer is a logical aggregate of one or more Service Data Flows (SDFs), for a PDN
connection, receiving the same QoS treatment, carried over a service connection between a
UE and a HSGW. A service connection is defined by X.S0011 [6] as the concatenation of a
forward/reverse RLP flow and an A8/A10 tunnel.
Handoff/Handover
In this specification, the terms handoff and handover are synonymous and used
interchangeably.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
Handover Attach
When performing an inter-technology handoff/handover between E-UTRAN and eHRPD, the
UE sends an Attach Type parameter of handoff when re-attaching to packet data networks
on the target technology in order to distinguish from the Initial Attach scenario.
HSGW
The HSGW is the HRPD Serving Gateway that connects the evolved HRPD access network
with the evolved packet core (EPC) as a trusted non-3GPP access network. The HSGW
provides the PMIPv6 mobile access gateway (MAG) function to support layer 3 mobility with
the P-GW (LMA).
56
57
58
59
60
IFOM capable UE
A UE that is capable of routing different IP flows to the same PDN connection through
different access networks simultaneously.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Legacy AT
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Legacy PDSN
26
A legacy PDSN is defined as a PDSN that is compliant with X.S0011 [6]. Within this
specification, the use of PDSN implies a legacy PDSN.
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
MAPCON capable UE
37
38
39
40
41
Non-Optimized Handoff/Handover
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
Optimized Handoff/Handover
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
10
signaling to the target access network to pre-register through the source access network, i.e.,
to create both a radio and an IP context on the target system. After pre-registration, the UE
performs a radio-level handoff/handover to the target technology per specified procedures.
Optimized Handoff/Handover applies to both Active and Idle (dormant) UEs.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Service Connection
A logical connection between a UE and HSGW used to transport user data and signaling for
the UE. There are two types of service connections: main and auxiliary. Each service
connection is comprised of two parts: UE to RAN and RAN to HSGW.
8
9
10
11
12
SMI
13
14
15
16
17
Tunnel Mode
18
19
The UE operating in tunnel mode means that there is an S101 interface between MME and
eAN/ePCF across which signaling is passed in both directions while the UE is operating on EUTRAN.
20
21
22
23
24
UE
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
2.1.1
60
11
CCP
CDR
CMIP
CSIM
DHCP
DL
eAN
EAP
eHRPD
eNB
EPC
ePCF
EPS
E-UTRAN
FQDN
GBR
GRE
HRPD
HSGW
HSS
IANA
IETF
IFOM
IMSI
IP
IP-CAN
LCP
LMA
MAC
MAG
MAPCON
MBR
MEID
MME
MN NAI
MRU
MSID
MSK
MUPSAP
NAI
OUI
P-GW
PBA
PBU
PCC
PCEF
PCO
PCRF
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
12
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
PDN
PDN-ID
PDSN
PMIP
PPP
QCI
QoS
RA
RAN
RAT
RK
ROHC
RS
RSVP
S-GW
SDF
SK
SLAAC
TK
TNL
TFT
TLV
UATI
UE
UE-AMBR
UL
VSA
VSNCP
VSNP
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
13
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
3.1
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
S101: the signaling interface between the EPC Mobility Management Entity (MME) and
the evolved HRPD Access Network (eAN/ePCF) (ref. TS 29.276 [38]). Note that the
eAN/ePCF functions are defined in A.S0022 [4],
17
18
19
20
21
S103: the bearer interface between the Evolved Packet Core (EPC) Serving Gateway (SGW) and the HSGW (ref. TS 29.276 [38]).
22
23
24
25
HSS
LTE-Uu
UE
eNodeB
X2
E-UTRAN/
EPC
MME
S1-U
S101
Gx
S11
S103
29
PCRF
Gxc
Serving
Gateway
27
28
S6a
S1-MME
26
SWx
S5
PDN
Gateway
Rx
30
31
Gxa
SGi
32
Operators IP
Services (e.g, IMS,
PSS, etc.)
S6b
S2a
33
34
35
3GPP AAA
Server
STa
36
37
38
39
40
eHRPD
HSGW
H1/H2
Pi*
3GPP2 AAA
Proxy
42
43
A10/A11
eAN/ePCF
41
44
A12
A13/A16
AN-AAA
45
46
47
HRPD BTS
HRPD Air
Interface
UE
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
Figure 1
56
57
58
59
60
14
1
2
3
4
3.2
5
6
8
9
10
11
HSS
12
SWx
13
14
hPCRF
15
S6a
16
Gx
17
Operators IP
Services (e.g, IMS,
PSS, etc.)
SGi
18
PDN
Gateway
19
20
21
HPLMN
22
24
25
26
27
28
UE
eNodeB
X2
MME
S1-U
29
E-UTRAN/
EPC
30
eHRPD
31
Serving
Gateway
33
A12
S2a
Gxa
HSGW
Pi*
A13/
A16
38
3GPP2 AAA
Proxy
A10/A11
eAN/ePCF
37
STa
S103
35
36
3GPP AAA
Server
3GPP AAA
Proxy
vPCRF
Gxc
H1/H2
34
AN-AAA
SWd
S8
S11
S101
32
S6b
S9
VPLMN
S1-MME
LTE-Uu
23
Rx
A12
AN-AAA
Proxy
HRPD BTS
39
40
HRPD Air
Interface
41
42
UE
43
44
45
46
47
Figure 2
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
15
3.3
1
2
3
Figure 3 illustrates the E-UTRAN eHRPD interworking architecture for local breakout
traffic. In this case the anchor point (i.e., the P-GW) is located in the visited network.
4
5
6
7
8
HSS
SWx
hPCRF
10
11
Rx
12
13
S6a
Operators IP Services
(e.g, IMS, PSS, etc.)
S9
14
AN-AAA
16
3GPP AAA
Server
HPLMN
17
18
19
VPLMN
vPCRF
S1-MME
LTE-Uu
UE
MME
eNodeB
X2
E-UTRAN/
EPC
15
S1-U
Gxc
Gx
S11
Serving
Gateway
S5
PDN
Gateway
Gxa
SGi
20
Rx
Visited Network
IP Services or proxies to
home network services or
PDN
S6b
21
SWd
A12
22
23
24
3GPP AAA
Proxy
25
26
27
28
S101
S2a
S103
29
STa
30
eHRPD
HSGW
H1/H2
Pi*
31
3GPP2 AAA
Proxy
32
33
A10/A11
eAN/ePCF
A12
A13/
A16
AN-AAA
Proxy
34
35
36
37
38
HRPD BTS
HRPD Air
Interface
UE
39
40
41
42
43
Figure 3
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
16
1
2
3.4
As shown in Figure 1 through Figure 3, for the interworking between E-UTRAN and eHRPD,
the following reference points are defined:
4
5
6
7
8
Reference Points
3.4.1
9
10
11
12
The H2 reference point carries user traffic, both uplink and downlink, from a source HSGW
(S-HSGW) to a target HSGW (T-HSGW) for optimized inter-HSGW handoff.
13
14
15
16
17
3.4.2
18
19
20
21
Detailed requirements and operation of this interface is defined in TS 23.203 [21], TS 29.212
[31] and TS 29.213 [32].
22
23
24
25
26
3.4.3
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
3.4.4
35
36
37
38
39
The detailed operation of this interface is defined in TS23.402 [25] and TS 29.276 [38].
40
41
42
43
3.4.5
44
45
46
47
48
Detailed requirements and operation of this interface is defined in TS 23.402 [25] and TS
29.276 [38].
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
3.4.6
58
59
60
17
Detailed requirements and operation of this interface is defined in TS 23.402 [25], TS 29.275
[37], and Section 5.
1
2
3
3.4.7
4
5
The STa reference point connects the AAA server/proxy in the 3GPP EPC to the AAA proxy
in the 3GPP2 eHRPD network. This reference point is used to authenticate and authorize the
UE and carries PMIPv6 mode related Diameter parameters between the 3GPP AAA
server/proxy and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
6
7
8
9
10
11
Detailed requirements and operation of this interface is defined in TS 23.402 [25] and TS
29.273 [36].
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
18
1
2
3.5
3
4
5
For octet stream connections (SO64, SO59) user plane traffic between the HSGW and the UE
is encapsulated in HDLC-like framing between the UE and the HSGW. For packet stream
connections (SO72 and SO67) user plane traffic through the eAN is transported directly over
the RLP and A10 connections. In the case of service connections shared between different
PDNs (SO59, SO64, SO72), user traffic is encapsulated with a PDN identifier. Otherwise, the
PDN of each user packet is identified via the A10 connection that is associated with the upper
four bits of the Reservation Label (Flow ID) that is associated with the A10.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
3.5.1
User Plane
The figures in this section provide the protocol stacks for user plane bearers.
17
18
19
20
3.5.1.1
21
The protocol stack in Figure 4 indicates that traffic for multiple PDNs may share the same
auxiliary service connection using SO72. In particular, a BE auxiliary service connection
with Flow ID 0xFE and using SO72 can be established during HRPD session configuration.
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
IPv4/IPv6
29
30
GRE
31
32
33
34
35
37
39
PDN-ID +
IPv4/IPv6
GRE
A10
A10
(SO72)
IPv4/IPv6
L2
L2
L2
L1
L1
L1
PDN-ID +
IPv4/IPv6
36
38
eHRPD
40
41
eHRPD
42
43
UE
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
eAN / ePCF
44
45
46
L2
L1
P-GW 1
(LMA)
IPv4/IPv6
GRE
IPv4/IPv6
L2
L1
47
48
P-GW 2
(LMA)
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
19
3.5.1.2
Figure 5 illustrates the use of an auxiliary service connection that is dedicated to one or more
IP flows with similar QoS characteristics for a single PDN. This type of auxiliary service
connection uses SO67 and does not involve use of the PDN-ID for multiplexing. For the
HSGW, the PDN of each uplink user packet is identified via the A10 connection that is
associated with the upper four bits of the Reseravation Label (Flow ID). For the UE, the PDN
of each downlink user packet is identified by the RLP that it is received on. Such a service
connection may be used for, for example, VoIP traffic or streaming video. Header
compression is optional and may be configured for an SO67 auxiliary service connection.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
(HDR
Compression)
eHRPD
UE
GRE
GRE
A10
A10
(SO67)
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
L2
L2
L2
L2
L1
L1
L1
L1
(HDR
Compression)
eHRPD
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
eAN /ePCF
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
P-GW
(LMA)
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
20
3.5.1.3
User Plane Traffic via VSNP on the Main Service Connection using
Service Option 59 (SO59)
2
3
The protocol stack in Figure 6 indicates that traffic for different PDNs may share the main
service connection. Packets are separated with a PDN identifier (PDN-ID) within VSNP.
This protocol stack also serves to carry RSVP packets between the UE and HSGW as shown
in section 3.5.2.
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
IPv4/IPv6
12
13
14
GRE
IPv4/IPv6
15
IPv4/IPv6
16
17
PPP:VSNP
GRE
A10
A10
(SO59)
IPv4/IPv6
L2
L2
L2
L1
L1
L1
PPP:VSNP
18
19
20
21
eHRPD
eHRPD
22
23
25
27
P-GW 1
(LMA)
IPv4/IPv6
GRE
24
26
L2
L1
UE
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
eAN /ePCF
28
29
IPv4/IPv6
L2
L1
P-GW 2
(LMA)
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
21
3.5.1.4
The protocol stack in Figure 7 indicates that traffic for different PDNs may share an auxiliary
service connection configured with SO64. Packets are separated with a PDN identifier (PDNID) within VSNP to provide multiplexing of traffic for multiple PDNs.
2
3
4
5
6
7
IPv4/IPv6
8
9
GRE
10
11
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
12
13
PPP:VSNP
A10
eHRPD
eHRPD
L2/L1
PPP:VSNP
GRE
L2/L1
A10
(SO64)
IPv4/IPv6
P-GW 1
(LMA)
L2/L1
L2/L1
14
15
16
17
18
19
UE
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
eAN /ePCF
IPv4/IPv6
20
21
GRE
22
23
IPv4/IPv6
24
25
L2/L1
26
27
P-GW 2
(LMA)
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
22
1
2
3
4
3.5.2
Control Plane
3.5.2.1
5
6
7
8
9
EAP-AKA
10
11
EAP-AKA
EAP
12
13
PPP
Diameter
Diameter
Diameter
A10
A10
(SO59)
(SCTP or
TCP) / IP
(SCTP or
TCP) / IP
(SCTP or
TCP) / IP
L2
L2
L2
L2
L2
L1
L1
L1
L1
L1
3GPP AAA
PPP
14
15
16
17
eHRPD
18
eHRPD
19
20
21
22
UE
23
EAP
EAP
eAN /ePCF
24
25
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
26
Figure 8
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
3.5.2.2
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
PPP:
VSNCP
PPP:
VSNCP
41
42
43
44
eHRPD
eHRPD
45
46
A10
A10
(SO59)
L2
L2
L1
L1
47
48
49
50
UE
eAN /ePCF
51
52
53
54
Figure 9
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
55
56
57
58
59
60
23
3.5.2.3
RSVP signaling is carried as IP traffic within the user plane via VSNP. See Figure 10. The
PDN-ID is used to specify the PDN to which the RSVP message applies (ref section 9.1.5).
2
3
4
5
6
RSVP
RSVP
UDP
UDP
7
8
9
10
11
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
PPP:VSNP
PPP:VSNP
12
13
14
eHRPD
UE
15
16
eHRPD
A10
A10
(SO59)
17
L2
L2
20
L1
L1
eAN / ePCF
18
19
21
22
23
HSGW
Trusted Non-3GPP
IP Access
(MAG)
24
25
26
27
28
29
Figure 10
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
3.6
H1 interface signaling procedures between the S-HSGW and the T-HSGW are based
on the reactive handover procedures in RFC 5949 [89].
H2 interface supports Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE) RFC 2784 [57] including
the Key Field extension RFC 2890 [58]. The Key field value of each GRE packet
header identifies the uplink or downlink traffic flow for a given UE.
For the downlink traffic, the H2 interface carries user IPv4/IPv6 packets identified by
the associated PDN-ID, over either an IPv4 or an IPv6 transport network.
For uplink traffic, the H2 interface carries PDN-Mux or dedicated service connection
traffic, identified by the associated service connection SR-ID, over either an IPv4 or
IPv6 transport network.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
The protocol stack in Figure 11 below illustrates the H1 interface control signaling stack
between the S-HSGW and the T-HSGW.
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
H1
Signaling
H1
Signaling
UDP
UDP
IPv4/
IPv6
IPv4/
IPv6
L2
L2
L1
L1
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
S-HSGW
45
H1
T-HSGW
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
25
Figure 12 illustrates the protocol stack for the flow of downlink user traffic from the S-HSGW
to the T-HSGW. Each user IPv4/IPv6 packet, encapsulated by the S-HSGW with the PDN-ID
of the PDN from which it is received, is sent over the transport network between the S-HSGW
and the T-HSGW using the downlink GRE key assigned by the use of H1 signaling.
1
2
3
4
5
6
PDN-ID +
IPv4/IPv6
Traffic
PDN-ID +
IPv4/IPv6
Traffic
7
8
9
10
11
GRE
GRE
12
13
14
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
15
16
17
L2
L2
18
L1
L1
20
T-HSGW
22
S-HSGW
H2
19
21
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
26
Figure 13 illustrates the protocol stack for the flow of uplink user traffic from the S-HSGW to
the T-HSGW. Each A10 payload received over the service connection(s) identified by the
associated service connection SR-ID is sent over the transport network between the S-HSGW
and the T-HSGW using the uplink GRE key assigned by the use of H1 signaling.
1
2
3
4
5
6
SR-ID +
Service
Connection
Traffic
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
SR-ID +
Service
Connection
Traffic
GRE
GRE
IPv4/IPv6
IPv4/IPv6
L2
L2
L1
L1
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
S-HSGW
23
H2
24
T-HSGW
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
3.7
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
27
eHRPD Functionality
1
2
eHRPD provides interworking of the UE with the 3GPP EPC architecture and protocols specified
in TS 23.402 [25]. In addition, eHRPD also supports seamless inter-technology mobility with EUTRAN with the following requirements:
3
4
5
6
7
a.
b.
Bearer interruption for an optimized handoff shall be less than the 300 msec
interruption time for the RAT change procedures specified in TS 22.278 [18].
8
9
10
11
12
4.1
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
a.
b.
31
c.
Transport level packet marking in the uplink and the downlink, e.g., setting the
DiffServ Code Point, based on the QCI of the associated EPS bearer.
33
30
32
34
35
d.
Accounting with user and service class granularity for inter-operator charging.
e.
f.
g.
40
h.
Uplink bearer binding verification with packet dropping of uplink traffic that does not
comply with established uplink policy.
42
36
37
38
39
41
43
i.
MAG functions for S2a mobility (i.e., Network-based mobility using PMIPv6).
44
j.
Support for IPv4 address and/or IPv6 prefix delivery during IPv4 address and/or IPv6
prefix assignment procedures.
46
45
47
48
k.
Authenticator function.
l.
49
50
51
52
n.
Support for PPP-based operation (e.g., terminating the PPP signaling protocol over the
main A10 connection with HDLC-like framing).
53
o.
56
p.
54
55
57
58
59
60
28
1
2
3
q.
r.
4
5
6
7
8
4.2
9
10
EPS authentication in this document refers to EPS AKA authentication over E-UTRAN or
EAP-AKA authentication over eHRPD.
11
12
13
14
When eHRPD access is used to connect to the 3GPP EPC and when the eAN/ePCF does not
indicate that the UE is attaching for emergency services, 3GPP-based access authentication is
required across a SWx/STa/Pi* reference point as depicted in section 3. The following
principles shall apply in this case:
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
When eHRPD access is used to connect to the 3GPP EPC and the eAN/ePCF indicates that
the UE is attaching for emergency services, depending on local regulation (ref. TS 33.402
[44]) the HSGW shall do one of the following:
26
27
28
29
30
Bypass the authentication procedures specified in this section, and mark the UE in an
emergency services - unauthenticated limited service state.
Authenticate the UE according to the principles set out in this section for a nonemergency service, and then mark the UE in an emergency services - authenticated
state. If authentication fails, depending on local regulation the attachment for
emergency services may be rejected, or the UE may be placed in an emergency
services unauthenticated limited service state.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
4.2.1
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
Once the UE receives an LCP Configure-Request message from the HSGW that contains the
Authentication-Protocol option that is set to 0xC227, the UE shall respond with LCP
Configure-Ack, indicating to the HSGW the acceptance of EAP-based authentication for PPP
session establishment as described in RFC 3748 [68] and RFC 1661 [48].
If the HSGW receives LCP Configure-Ack from the UE indicating the acceptance of EAPbased authentication, the HSGW shall select EAP as the PPP authentication protocol and
59
60
29
proceed to play the role of EAP authenticator. Otherwise, the HSGW shall follow the
operator defined policy.
1
2
3
4.2.2
UE Requirements
4
5
The UE shall support the EAP-AKA protocol defined in TS 33.402 [44] for Network Access
Authentication.
If the UE supports a Universal Subscriber Identity Module (USIM) for authentication, the UE
shall support EAP-AKA, which relies on AKA authentication defined in TS 33.102 [43]
AKA requires a pre-defined common set of algorithms (consisting of a set of f functions,
i.e., f1, , f5, f1* and f5*) between the UE and the home network.
If the UE does not support USIM for authentication, the UE shall support the following AKA
authentication and algorithm profiles:
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
1. The MILENAGE algorithm f functions (f1, , f5, f1* and f5*) shall be as
defined in TS 35.206 [45].
37
36
38
39
40
41
42
43
4. If OP is used, then OPc shall be derived from OP; otherwise, OPc shall be used
directly.
46
4.2.2.1
19
44
45
47
48
49
50
UE Identity Management
51
The UE shall have a permanent ID that is an IMSI-based NAI as defined in TS 23.003 [19].
The UE shall support temporary identities (pseudonym and fast-reauthentication) as specified
in TS 24.302 [28] and TS 33.402 [44]. Temporary identities are defined in TS 23.003 [19] and
are one time identities.
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
30
Upon receiving the EAP Request / Identity, the UE shall respond with the EAP Response /
Identity carrying its identity complying with Network Access Identifier (NAI) format
specified in TS 23.003 [19]. See TS 24.302 [28] for further information on UE identity
management.
1
2
3
4
5
If upon successful EAP-AKA access authentication (see RFC 5448 [82]), a protected
pseudonym and/or re-authentication identity were received, the UE shall store the temporary
identity(s) for future authentications.
6
7
8
9
10
11
4.2.2.2
Upon receiving the EAP Request / AKA Challenge, the UE shall check whether the AMF
separation bit is set to 1. If this is not the case the UE shall reject the authentication.
Otherwise, the UE shall execute the AKA algorithms on the UE.
12
13
14
15
16
If verification of the AT_AUTN is incorrect per RFC 5448 [82] and TS 33.402 [44], the UE
shall reject the authentication. If the sequence number is out of synch, the UE shall initiate a
synchronization procedure, refer to RFC 5448 [82].
17
18
19
20
If AT_AUTN is correct, the UE shall compute AT_MAC and AT_RES. The UE shall use the
access network name received in AT_KDF_INPUT of the EAP Request/AKA Challenge to
derive IK and CK and send the AT_MAC and AT_RES to the HSGW in the EAP Response
/ AKA Challenge, as specified in RFC 5448 [82].
21
22
23
24
25
26
4.2.2.3
27
28
29
30
31
The UE shall separate the 512 bits of generated MSK into four equal portions of 128 bits
each, i.e., four Sub-MSKs. The UE shall use each Sub-MSK to generate the four PMKs as
follows:
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
where the key label pmk@hrpd.3gpp2 is set to ASCII strings without NULL
termination.
43
44
45
The UE may pre-compute the PMKs and PairwiseMasterKeyID associated with each PMK as
specified in C.S0067 [14]. In addition, the UE may also pre-compute the PMKs and
PairwiseMasterKeyIDs associated with the other Sub-MSKs. This pre computation of PMKs
and PairwiseMasterKeyIDs enables the UE to identify the PMK it needs to use upon receiving
request from the access network to derive session keys for access security.
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
4.2.3
HSGW Requirements
The HSGW shall support the following:
58
59
60
31
RFC 5448 [82], Improved Extensible Authentication Protocol Method for 3rd
Generation Authentication and Key Agreement (EAP-AKA').
The HSGW shall be the EAP authenticator in eHRPD. Therefore, the HSGW is the entity
that receives the MSK from the 3GPP AAA after EAP authentication. The HSGW sends the
serving network identity which is identical to access network identity specified in TS 24.302
[28] to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/3GPP AAA during authentication.
If the HSGW receives an indication in A11-Registration Request message that the PMK is
needed for this session, and if HSGW determines that it has no unused PMKs, the HSGW
shall set Sub-MSK as the 128-bit portion (Sub-MSK) occupying the highest order bit
positions of the unused MSK information, as specified in section 11.3.2. The HSGW shall use
the Sub-MSK for the computation of PMKs using the procedures specified in section 4.2.2.3.
Once the HSGW generates the PMK or determines that the new PMK needs to be sent to the
eAN/ePCF, the HSGW shall send a PMK and its lifetime in seconds to the ePCF using A11Registration Reply or A11-Session Update message [1] if the ePCF has indicated in the A11Registration Request that the PMK is used for this session. The lifetime of the PMK shall not
be more than the remaining value of the MSK lifetime. If the HSGW runs out of PMKs, the
HSGW may use the unused MSK information to generate new PMKs as specified above.
The HSGW (EAP Authenticator) shall initiate EAP re-authentication prior to MSK expiry, if
the HSGW determines that the session needs to be maintained.
If the Diameter protocol is used, the HSGW shall support the following RFCs:
4.2.4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
28
30
27
29
31
32
33
34
35
36
4.2.5
4.2.5.1
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
32
UE
eAN /
ePCF
3GPP
AAA
Server
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSGW
HSS
3
4
5
6
7
8
2. PPP: EAP-RSP /
Identity (NAI)
10
11
12
13
14
15
Conditional Messages
5. PPP: EAP-REQ /
AKA-Identity
6. PPP: EAP-RSP /
AKA-Identity
16
17
18
8. Request
AKA vector
(IMSI)
9. AKA Algorithm
executed,
outputs AKA
vector(s): RAND,
AUTN, XRES
19
20
21
22
23
10. Return
AKA vector(s)
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
Conditional Messages
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
33
0.
1.
2.
The UE responds with EAP-Response / Identity (NAI). If UE uses its permanent NAI, it shall use
the IMSI-based Network Access Identifier (NAI) format specified in TS 23.003 [19].
3.
The HSGW forwards the unmodified NAI received in the EAP-Response/Identity message to the
EAP Server in the 3GPP AAA.
3a: The HSGW, as the authenticator, encapsulates the EAP payload in a AAA message and
forwards it, along with the access type (i.e., RAT type), and NAS-ID = {the FQDN of the HSGW}
to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy. In this message, the HSGW shall also include the serving network
identity (serving network identity is identical to access network identity specified in TS 24.302).
The format of the serving network identity is specified in TS 24.302 [28].
3b.The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy forwards the unmodified contents to the 3GPP AAA Server.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
Steps 4 through 7 are conditional. They will occur if the 3GPP AAA Server decides to send the
EAP-Request / AKA-Identity message.
18
19
20
4.
4a: The 3GPP AAA Server sends the EAP-Request / AKA-Identity to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy (ref.
RFC 4187 [76]).
21
4b. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy forwards the EAP-Request / AKA-Identity to the HSGW.
24
5.
26
6.
The UE sends EAP-Response/ AKA-Identity containing the permanent UE Identity to the HSGW.
7.
7a: The HSGW encapsulates the EAP-Response / AKA-Identity in a AAA message and sends it to
the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
7b. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy forwards the message to the 3GPP AAA Server.
8.
9.
The 3GPP AAA Server will terminate the EAP protocol. If the UE identified itself with the
pseudonym, the 3GPP AAA server determines the real identity of the UE and derives the IMSI
from it. The 3GPP AAA Server checks that it has an unused authentication vector with AMF
separation bit = 1 and the matching access network identifier available for that subscriber. If not, a
set of new authentication vectors is retrieved from HSS using IMSI. The 3GPP AAA server
includes in a message sent to the HSS an indication that the authentication vector is requested for
EAP-AKA', and the serving network identity. The 3GPP AAA Server ensures that the given
access network is authorized to use the claimed serving network identity.
The HSS calculates the AKA vector(s). The HSS then transforms this AKA vector as specified in
TS 33.402 [44].
22
23
25
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
10. The HSS returns the transformed AKA vector(s), including AT_RAND, AT_AUTN, and
AT_RES, IK and CK, to the 3GPP AAA. The 3GPP AAA Server stores the received AKA
vector(s).
45
11. New keying material is derived from IK and CK according to EAP-AKA (see RFC 5448 [82]).
A new pseudonym and/or re-authentication ID may be chosen and if chosen are protected (i.e.,
encrypted and integrity protected) using keying material generated from EAP-AKA.
49
12. The 3GPP AAA Server sends AT_RAND, AT_AUTN, a message authentication code
(AT_MAC), AT_KDF, AT_KDF_INPUT and two user identities (if they are generated): protected
pseudonym and/or protected re-authentication id in EAP Request/AKA-Challenge message. The
sending of the re-authentication ID depends on the operator's policies on whether to allow fast reauthentication processes or not. It implies that, at any time, the 3GPP AAA Server decides (based
on policies set by the operator) whether to include the re-authentication id or not, thus allowing or
46
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
34
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
disallowing the triggering of the fast re-authentication process. The 3GPP AAA Server may use a
protected success indication by including the AT_RESULT_IND attribute in the EAP
Request/AKA-Challenge message, in order to indicate to the UE that it would like result
indications in both successful and unsuccessful cases. The inclusion of the result indications for
the protection of the result messages depends on home operator's policies.
12a: The 3GPP AAA Server sends the EAP-Request / AKA-Challenge and the other parameters
to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
12b. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy forwards the EAP-Request / AKA-Challenge and other parameters
to the HSGW.
13. The HSGW sends the EAP-Request / AKA-Challenge and other parameters to the UE.
14. The UE runs the AKA algorithms on the UE. The UE verifies that AT_AUTN is correct and
thereby authenticates the network. If AT_AUTN is incorrect, the terminal rejects the
authentication (not shown in this example). If the sequence number is out of synch, the terminal
initiates a synchronization procedure (not shown in this example), c.f. RFC 5448 [82]. If
AT_AUTN is correct, the UE computes AT_RES, IK and CK. The UE derives required
additional new keying material, including the key MSK, according to RFC 5448 [82] and TS
24.302 [28] from the new computed IK and CK, and checks the received AT_MAC with the new
derived keying material. If a protected pseudonym and/or re-authentication identity were
received, then the UE stores the temporary identity(s) for future authentications.
15. The UE calculates a new AT_MAC value covering the EAP message with the new keying
material. UE sends EAP Response/AKA-Challenge containing calculated AT_RES and the new
calculated AT_MAC value to the HSGW. The UE includes in this message the result indication if
it supports result indications and if it received the same indication from the 3GPP AAA Server.
Otherwise, the UE omits this indication.
16. The HSGW sends the authentication response to the EAP server.
16a: The HSGW encapsulates the EAP-Response / AKA-Challenge, AT_RES, and AT_MAC in
a AAA message and sends it to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
16b. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy forwards the message to the 3GPP AAA Server.
17. The 3GPP AAA Server checks the received AT_MAC and verifies the AT_RES value to the
XRES value from the AKA vector received in step 10 above. The remainder of this flow assumes
that the comparison succeeds. If the 3GPP AAA Server sent a pseudonym and/or fast reauthentication identity to the UE in the step 12, it now associates these identities with the
permanent identity of the UE.
Steps 18 through 21 are conditional based on the EAP Server and the UE having indicated the use of
protected successful result indications (see steps 11 and 13).
18. If the 3GPP AAA Server requested previously to use protected result indications and received the
same result indications from the UE as in RFC 5448 [82], the 3GPP AAA Server sends the
message EAP Request/AKA-Notification.
18a: The 3GPP AAA Server sends EAP Request/AKA-Notification to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
35
22. The 3GPP AAA Server creates an EAP-Success message that also includes the subscription
profile that has been retrieved from the HSS and the MSK (see RFC 5448 [82]), in the underlying
AAA protocol message (i.e., not at the EAP level).
2
3
22a: The 3GPP AAA Server sends The EAP-Success message and other parameters (e.g., AMBR)
in a AAA message to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
22b. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy forwards the information including the subscription information
elements (defined in TS 29.273 [36]) on to the HSGW.
If the peer indicated that it wants to use protected success indications with AT_RESULT_IND,
then the peer MUST NOT accept EAP-Success after a successful EAP/AKA-Reauthentication
round. In this case, the peer MUST only accept EAP-Success after receiving an EAP-AKA
Notification with the AT_NOTIFICATION code "Success".
5
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
If the peer receives an EAP-AKA Notification that indicates failure, then the peer MUST no
longer accept the EAP-Success packet, even if the server authentication was successfully
completed.
14
23. The HSGW stores the keying material to be used in communication with the authenticated UE as
required. The HSGW also stores the other parameters sent in the AAA message. The HSGW
signals EAP-Success to the UE. If the UE received the pseudonym and/or fast reauthentication
identity in step 13, it now accepts these identities as valid for next authentication attempt.
18
At this point, the EAP-AKA exchange has been successfully completed, and the UE and the
access network share keying material derived during that exchange.
The authentication process may fail at any moment, for example because of unsuccessful
checking of AT_MACs or no response from the UE after a network request. In that case, the
EAP AKA process will be terminated as specified in RFC 5448 [82] and an indication shall
be sent to the HSS.
4.3
15
16
17
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
EAP-AKA Fast Re-Authentication shall be supported per RFC 5448 [82] and as specified in
TS 24.302 [28] and TS 33.402 [44]. Fast re-authentication uses keys derived on the previous
full authentication.
34
The use of fast re-authentication is optional and depends on operator policy. The 3GPP AAA
server indicates fast re-authentication for EAP-AKA to the UE by sending the reauthentication identity to the UE.
38
35
36
37
39
40
41
42
4.4
43
IP Address Allocation
44
45
46
47
4.4.1
48
General
49
The requirements and procedures of this section are per TS 23.401 [24] and TS 23.402 [25].
A UE shall be able to request an IPv4 address and/or IPv6 address/prefix. A UE shall perform
the address allocation procedures for at least one IP address (either IPv4 or IPv6) after
establishing the PDN connection if no IPv4 address is allocated during PDN connection setup.
For IPv4 addressing, the UE shall use one of the following procedures:
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
36
1.
Acquire the IPv4 address and IPv4 parameter configuration via VSNCP
signaling during PDN connection establishment.
2.
Acquire the IPv4 address and IPv4 parameter configuration using DHCPv4 after
the PDN connection establishment.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
1.
Acquire the Interface Identifier via the VSNCP signaling during PDN
connection establishment. The UE configures its link local address using this
Interface Identifier.
2.
Configure the /64 prefix using Router Advertisement from the HSGW (Access
Router) for the PDN connection.
3.
Configure the 128-bits IPv6 address using IPv6 SLAAC (see RFC 4862 [78]).
4.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
The IP address or prefix allocated to the UEs PDN connection shall be used for the UEs
default and dedicated bearers associated with that PDN connection.
Each service connection, i.e., each concatenation of an RLP flow with an A8+A10
connection, between the UE and the HSGW supports both IPv4 and IPv6 packets.
The UE may indicate to the network whether it wants to obtain the IPv4 address during PDN
connection setup procedures or by executing IETF procedures after the PDN connection
setup:
-
If the UE indicates that it prefers to obtain an IPv4 address as part of the PDN
connection setup procedure, the UE relies on the HSGW to provide an IPv4 address
from the P-GW to the UE as part of the PDN connection setup procedure, i.e., using
VSNCP procedures specified in section 9.1.4.
If the UE indicates (e.g., by including the Address Allocation Preference in the PCO)
that it prefers to obtain the IPv4 address after the PDN connection setup by executing
DHCPv4 (see RFC 2131 [50]) procedures, the HSGW may provide the IPv4 address
for the UE as part of procedures used to establish the PDN connection. If the HSGW
receives UEs IP address through PMIP tunnel establishment without the deferred IPv4
address allocation indicator included, the HSGW shall respond to the UE by setting the
PDN Address field to the IP address received from P-GW. Otherwise, after the PDN
connection establishment procedure is completed, the UE initiates the IPv4 address
configuration on its own using DHCPv4. See details in section 4.4.4.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
The HSGW is responsible for delivering the IPv4 address and/or IPv6 prefix to the UE.
The HSGW shall support the following mechanisms:
a.
IPv4 address allocation during PDN connection establishment procedures (per section
7.2.1 and 9.3.1).
b.
IPv4 address allocation after PDN connection establishment procedures (e.g., via
DHCPv4).
55
56
57
58
59
60
37
The eHRPD network shall also support the following mechanisms following the PDN
connection establishment procedures:
a.
/64 IPv6 prefix allocation via IPv6 Stateless Address auto-configuration according to
RFC 4862 [78];
b.
c.
1
2
3
4
5
IPv4 address allocation and IPv4 parameter configuration via DHCPv4 according to
RFC 2131 [50] and RFC 4039 [74]. See call flows in Section 4.4.6.1 and Section
4.4.6.3 for details;
IPv6 parameter configuration via Stateless DHCPv6 according to RFC 3736 [67].
10
During PDN connection establishment, the P-GW sends the IPv6 prefix and Interface
Identifier to the HSGW. If the UE indicates that it prefers to obtain an IPv6 address, the
HSGW shall forward the IPv6 Interface Identifier to the UE using VSNCP message. The
HSGW shall convey the assigned IPv6 prefix to the UE using Router Advertisement.
7
8
9
11
12
13
14
15
16
4.4.1.1
For IPv6 addressing, the UE and the eHRPD network may perform IPv6 address allocation
with IPv6 prefix delegation according to RFC 3633 [66] RFC 6603 [91] using mechanisms
following IPv6 parameter configuration via Stateless DHCPv6.
17
21
This section describes the interactions between the VSNCP protocol and the PMIPv6 protocol
to accomplish IP address allocation on S2a.
23
26
18
19
20
22
24
25
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
4.4.1.1.1
38
4.4.1.1.1.1
Initial Attach
40
There are seven parameters of significance to the IP address allocation process that are sent by
the UE on the VSNCP Configure-Request message for an initial attach:
39
41
42
43
PDN Type
44
PDN Address
46
Protocol Configuration Options (PCO) that may contain an indication that deferred
IPv4 address allocation is desired
45
47
48
49
50
APN
52
53
55
51
54
56
57
58
59
60
38
In the VSNCP Configure-Request message sent from the UE to the HSGW, the PDN Type
option carries information on the UE IP capabilities. It shall be used to indicate to the HSGW
whether the UE supports IPv4, IPv6, or IPv4v6.
1
2
3
4
In the VSNCP Configure-Request, on initial attach the UE shall include PDN Address option
as specified in section 9.1.4.1. However, the HSGW shall ignore the contents of the PDN
Address option.
5
6
7
8
In the VSNCP Configure-Request, the PCO indicates the bearer control mode, and may
contain an indication that deferred IPv4 address allocation is desired. See TS 29.275 [37].
9
10
11
In the VSNCP Configure-Request, the Address Allocation Cause option shall be set to a
value of 0 (Null value).
12
13
14
15
Per section 9.1.4.2, in the VSNCP Configure-Request, the UE shall set the IPv4 Default
Router Address option to value 0.0.0.0 and the HSGW shall ignore the content of this option.
16
17
18
If the UE is attaching for emergency services, the VSNCP Configure-Request shall contain
the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1.
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
4.4.1.1.1.2
Handover Attach
The following parameters of significance to the IP address allocation process are sent by the
UE on the VSNCP Configure-Request message for a handover attach:
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
PDN Type
PDN Address
APN
IPv6 HSGW Link Local Address IID, if PDN Type indicates IPv6 or IPv4v6 and if
the UE is operating in the tunneled mode
In the VSNCP Configure-Request message sent from the UE to the HSGW, the PDN Type
option carries information on the UE IP capabilities. It shall be used to indicate to the HSGW
whether the UE supports IPv4, IPv6, or IPv4v6.
In the VSNCP Configure-Request, on handover attach the PDN Address option will contain
the valid IP address value(s) assigned to the UE for the APN. The PDN type field within the
PDN Address option indicates what values the PDN Address option is carrying. Refer to
section 9.1.4.1.1 for exact coding of the PDN Address option.
In the VSNCP Configure-Request, the PCO indicates the bearer control mode, and may
contain an indication that deferred IPv4 address allocation is desired. See TS 29.275 [37].
In the VSNCP Configure-Request, the Address Allocation Cause option shall be set to a
value of 0 (Null value).
Per section 9.1.4.2, in the VSNCP Configure-Request, if the UE has the currently assigned
IPv4 default router address, the UE shall set the IPv4 Default Router Address option to the
currently assigned IPv4 default router address. Per section 9.1.4.2, in the VSNCP Configure-
58
59
60
39
Request, if the UE does not have the currently assigned IPv4 default router address, the UE
shall set the IPv4 Default Router Address option to 0.0.0.0.
If the UE is handing over and has previously attached to the emergency PDN for emergency
services, the VSNCP Configure-Request for the emergency PDN shall contain the Emergency
Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
4.4.1.1.2
4.4.1.1.2.1
Initial Attach
10
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request message indicating initial attach, it
shall examine the PDN Type option to determine the UEs IP capabilities, and compare this
value to the subscription data for the APN. If the UE indicates support in the PDN Type
option for IPv4v6 but the subscription data only allows IPv4 or IPv6 IP address for this APN,
the HSGW shall set the PDN type to match the subscription limitation. If the resulting PDN
Type option does not indicate support for at least one IP address type allowed by the
subscription data for the APN, a VSNCP Configure-Reject message with error code set to
subscription limitation shall be sent to the UE. See section 9.1.4.5.
If the PDN Type received from the UE includes at least one IP address type allowed by the
subscription data for the APN, the HSGW constructs a Proxy Binding Update (PBU) message
requesting IP address allocation according to the PDN Type by including appropriate options
in the PBU (see TS 29.275 [37]) and sends it to the P-GW. Additionally, the 3GPP VendorSpecific Mobility Option Protocol Configuration Options carries the PCO sent from the
UE in the VSNCP Configure-Request message.
4.4.1.1.2.2
9
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
Handover Attach
29
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request message indicating handover attach,
it shall examine the PDN Address option to determine the IP address(es) already assigned
to the UE and compare this information to the subscription data for the APN. If the UE
indicates IP address(es) that do not match the subscription data for this APN, the HSGW shall
send a VSNCP Configure-Reject message to the UE.
Otherwise, the HSGW constructs a Proxy Binding Update (PBU) message including the
already allocated IP address(es) and sends it to the P-GW.
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
4.4.1.1.3
40
4.4.1.1.3.1
Initial Attach
42
When the P-GW receives the PBU containing an indication for initial attach, it follows the
3GPP EPC procedures for allocation of IP addresses. See TS 23.402 [25] and TS 29.275 [37].
If the P-GW determines that the initial attachment to the APN cannot be completed, it will
indicate that via the Status field in a PBA message. If the HSGW receives a 3GPP2Reconnect-Indication mobility option in the PBA message with a status value of "129
Administratively prohibited" and MO Data set to Reconnect to this APN not allowed, then
the HSGW shall send VSNCP Configure-Reject message to the UE with the error code set to
Reconnect to this APN not allowed.
41
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
Assuming there are no errors, the P-GW returns the assigned IP address(es) in a PBA message
to the HSGW. If the UE requested deferred IPv4 address allocation, and the P-GW supports
deferred IPv4 address allocation, the Vendor-Specific Mobility Option of subtype 3GPP
Vendor-Specific PMIPv6 DHCPv4 Address Allocation Procedure Indication is returned to
the HSGW in the PBA message (see TS 29.275 section 12.1.1.5 [37]).
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
40
If the HSGW had indicated IPv4 and IPv6 capabilities in the PBU, but the P-GW decided to
allocate only IPv4 or IPv6, the P-GW also includes the Vendor-Specific Mobility Option of
subtype 3GPP Vendor-Specific PMIPv6 PDN Type Indication in the PBA message to
indicate the actual allocation and a cause value to indicate the reason for the change.
1
2
3
4
5
6
4.4.1.1.3.2
When the P-GW receives the PBU containing an indication for handover attach, it follows the
3GPP EPC procedures for handover (see TS 23.402 [25] and TS 29.275 [37]). If the P-GW
determines that the handover attachment to the APN cannot be completed, it will indicate that
via the Status field in a PBA message. If the HSGW receives a 3GPP2-Reconnect-Indication
mobility option in the PBA with a status value of 129 Administratively prohibited and the
MO Data is set to Reconnect to this APN not allowed, then the HSGW shall send a VSNCP
Configure-Reject message to the UE with the error code set to Reconnect to this APN not
allowed.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
Handover Attach
4.4.1.1.4
4.4.1.1.4.1
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
If the IPv4 Address Acknowledgment option option is present in the PBA message, the
HSGW shall check whether a Vendor-Specific Mobility Option of subtype "3GPP VendorSpecific PMIPv6 DHCPv4 Address Allocation Procedure Indication" has been received in the
PBA message.
If no such deferred allocation indication was received, the IPv4 home address shall
be copied to the PDN Address option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
If such deferred allocation indication has been received, the IPv4 address 0.0.0.0
shall be inserted in the "PDN Address" option. (NOTE: In this case, the UE has
requested deferred IPv4 address allocation and it may request an IPv4 address via
DHCPv4.)
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
If the IPv6 Home Network Prefix option is present, the IID shall be copied to the PDN
Address option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message. The UE shall use the IPv6 home
network prefix that it receives in the RA message, refer to section 4.4.3.
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
If the UE included the IPv6 HSGW Link Local Address IID option, and if the Attach Type
option is Handoff, and if the Tunnel Mode Indicator is set to 1 in the last received A11Registration Request message for the UE, then the HSGW shall include the IPv6 HSGW Link
Local Address IID option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message and shall set the value to the
interface ID of the HSGW link local address.
The PDN Type in the PDN Address option shall be set to indicate which address(es) is
contained in the PDN Address option.
If the Vendor-Specific Mobility Option of subtype "3GPP Vendor-Specific PMIPv6 PDN
Type Indication" is present in the PBA message, the PDN type value is copied to the PDN
Type option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message and to the PDN type field in the PDN
Address option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
56
57
58
59
60
41
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
If the HSGW changed the PDN Type received from the UE to match a subscription
limitation for the APN, the HSGW shall set the Address Allocation Cause option
to indicate New PDN type due to subscription limitation, see TS 29.275 clause
12.1.1.3 [37].
If the HSGW did not change the PDN Type received from the UE, the HSGW shall
set the Address Allocation Cause option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message to
255 (success).
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
4.4.2
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
When the HSGW receives VSNCP Configure-Request, the HSGW triggers PMIPv6
procedures to the requested P-GW as specified in Section 5 if the UE is authorized to connect
to it. The HSGW shall forward the Protocol Configuration Options (PCO) that are requested
by the UE to the P-GW.
32
The P-GW allocates an IPv4 address during PDN connection establishment. The P-GW sends
the allocated IPv4 address in the PBA message to the HSGW. If the UE indicated that it wants
to obtain the IPv4 address during PDN connection setup procedures, the P-GW does not
include the "3GPP Vendor-Specific PMIPv6 DHCPv4 Address Allocation Procedure
Indication option in the PBA message; therefore, the HSGW shall include the allocated IP
address in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message sent to the UE.
27
28
29
30
31
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
4.4.3
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
42
1
2
3
4
When the HSGW receives VSNCP Configure-Request, the HSGW triggers PMIPv6
procedures to the requested P-GW as specified in Section 5 if the UE is authorized to connect
to it. The HSGW shall forward the Protocol Configuration Options (PCO) that are requested
by the UE to the P-GW.
5
6
7
8
9
The P-GW allocates an IPv6 prefix and the IPv6 interface identifier to the UE during PDN
connection establishment. The P-GW sends the allocated IPv6 prefix and the IPv6 interface
identifier in the PBA message to the HSGW. Upon receiving the PBA message, the HSGW
shall send a VSNCP Configure-Ack message to the UE with the IPv6 interface identifier to
the UE. Subsequently, the HSGW shall send Router Advertisement message to the UE
including the assigned IPv6 prefix received in the PBA message.
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
After the UE has received the Router Advertisement message, it shall construct its full IPv6
address via IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration in accordance with RFC 4862 [78]. For
privacy, RFC 3041 [59], the UE may change the interface identifier used to generate full IPv6
addresses, without involving the network. The UE may use stateless DHCPv6 for additional
parameter configuration. The UE shall configure the HSGW IPv6 link local address using the
Router Advertisement received from the HSGW.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
If the UE is operating in the tunneled mode, the UE receives the interface ID of the HSGW
Link Local Address in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message sent from HSGW to the UE.
25
26
27
The detailed call flow for IPv6 prefix allocation after the PDN connection establishment
procedure is provided in section 4.4.6.4.
28
29
30
Stateless Address Autoconfiguration for IPv6 global and link local addresses are supported by
the UE by default. Stateful address configuration using DHCPv6 is not supported in this
specification per TS 23.402 [25].
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
4.4.4
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
The UE that supports IPv4 shall indicate it by setting the PDN Type option to IPv4 or IPv4v6
in the VSNCP Configure-Request message. The UE shall indicate that it wants deferred IPv4
address allocation using Address Allocation Preference contained in the PCO. If the UE
indicates using the Address Allocation Preference that it wants deferred IPv4 address
allocation, and the P-GW chooses to allow deferred allocation, the P-GW includes the
deferred IPv4 address allocation indicator (i.e., 3GPP Vendor-Specific PMIPv6 DHCPv4
Address Allocation Procedure Indication option) in the Proxy Binding Acknowledgement
message. Upon reception of a Proxy Binding Acknowledgement message with a deferred
IPv4 address allocation indicator included, the HSGW shall set the IPv4 address to 0.0.0.0 in
the VSNCP Configure-Ack message, even if an IPv4 address is assigned by the P-GW. If the
HSGW receives the UEs IP address through PMIP tunnel establishment without the deferred
IPv4 address allocation indicator included, the HSGW shall set the IPv4 address in the
VSNCP Configure-Ack message to the IPv4 address that is received from the P-GW.
If the UE receives an IPv4 address during the PDN connection establishment, the UE shall not
use DHCPv4 for another address allocation to the same PDN connection even if the UE
indicates deferred IP address allocation in PCO.
58
59
60
43
The UE that requested deferred IPv4 address allocation may send the DHCPDISCOVER
message to the HSGW. If the UE supports RFC 4039 [74], the UE shall send the
DHCPDISCOVER message with Rapid Commit option.
If the HSGW receives a DHCPDISCOVER message, the HSGW shall act as a DHCPv4 relay
agent and forward the DHCPv4 message within the PMIPv6 tunnel to the P-GW.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
When the HSGW receives a DHCPDISCOVER message, if the HSGW had previously
received a PBA message with the deferred IPv4 address allocation indicator and no IPv4
Address Acknowledgement option, the HSGW also triggers PMIP procedures as specified in
section 5 to obtain the IPv4 address allocated to the UE, as well as the IPv4 default router
address.
If the UE receives the DHCPACK with Rapid Commit, the UE shall configure its IP address
with the IP address in the yiaddr field. If the UE receives the DHCPACK with Rapid
Commit, the UE shall configure its IP address with the IP address in the yiaddr field, and
shall set the IPv4 Default Router Address to the value of the IPv4 Default Router Address
field.
14
If the UE receives the DHCPOFFER message from the HSGW, the UE shall send the
DHCPREQUEST message to the HSGW. The requested IP address option shall be set to the
value of yiaddr contained in the DHCPOFFER message from the HSGW. When the UE
receives the DHCPACK message from the HSGW, the UE shall configure its IP address with
the IP address in the yiaddr field, and shall set the IPv4 Default Router Address to the value
of the IPv4 Default Router Address field.
9
10
11
12
13
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
4.4.5
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
The address space provided is maintained as an IPv6 address space pool available to the PDN
connection for DHCPv6 IPv6 prefix requests with the exclusion of the IPv6 prefix that is
allocated to the PDN connection during default bearer establishment as defined in clause
4.4.3. The total IPv6 address space available for the PDN connection (UE default bearer
prefix and UE PDN connection IPv6 address space pool) shall be possible to be aggregated
into one IPv6 prefix that will represent all IPv6 addresses that the UE may use. If the UE had
indicated that it supports prefix exclusion and the prefix to be delegated to the UE includes
the /64 prefix that was allocated to the PDN Connection, the P-GW utilizes the prefix
exclusion feature as specified for DHCPv6 Prefix Delegation in RFC 6603 [91].
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
The UE uses DHCPv6 to request additional IPv6 prefixes (i.e., prefixes in addition to the
default prefix) from the P-GW after completing stateless IPv6 address autoconfiguration
procedures. The UE acts as a "Requesting Router" as described in RFC 3633 [66] and inserts
one or more IA_PD option(s) into a DHCPv6 Solicit message sent from the UE to the P-GW
through the HSGW. The P-GW acts as the DHCP server and fulfils the role of a "Delegating
Router" according to RFC 3633 [66]. The UE optionally includes the RAPID_COMMIT
option in the DHCPv6 Solicit message to trigger the two-message DHCPv6 procedure instead
of the four-message DHCPv6 procedure. The UE shall include the OPTION_PD_EXCLUDE
option code in an OPTION_ORO option to indicate support for prefix exclusion. In response
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
44
to the DHCPv6 Solicit message, the UE receives a DHCPv6 Reply message with one or more
IA_PD prefix(es) for every IA_PD option that it sent in the DHCPv6 Solicit message. The PGW delegates a prefix excluding the default prefix with help of OPTION_PD_EXCLUDE.
Prefix exclusion procedures shall follow RFC 3633 [66].
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
4.4.6
Call Flows
This section shows example call flows for IPv4 and IPv6 address allocation. Note that the
PCRF interaction is not shown in the call flows.
9
10
11
12
4.4.6.1
13
Figure 15 illustrates an example call flow for IPv4 address allocation during PDN connection
establishment.
14
15
16
17
18
UE
eAN/ePCF
PDNGW
HSGW
19
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSS/
AAA
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
The UE has performed successful authentication and is attached to the eHRPD access
network.
2.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN Address (IPv4, PDN
Address=0), Protocol Configuration Options, IPv4 Default Router Address, and Attach Type
(Initial Attach). Using the Address Allocation Preference contained in the PCO, the UE
indicates that it wants to perform IPv4 address allocation during the PDN connection
establishment procedure.
3.
Since the Attach Type is set to Initial Attach in this call flow, the HSGW selects a new
P-GW based on APN received from HSS/HAAA (for default PDN connection, if the UE does
not identify a requested APN in step 2) or received from the UE. The HSGW sends a
PMIPv6 Binding Update to the P-GW. See 3GPP 23.402 [25] and 29.275 [37].
4.
The P-GW updates the 3GPP AAA Server/HSS with P-GWs identity (i.e., FQDN, or IP
address). See 3GPP 23.402 [25].
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
45
5.
6.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW. See 3GPP 23.402 [25] and 29.275
[37].
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack message (PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN
Address, IPv4 Default Router Address, PCO, and Attach Type) to the UE over the main
service connection. The PDN Address option contains an IPv4 address received in the PBA
message (step 5).
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
7.
8.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The information in the message includes the PDN-ID configuration option.
This message also includes the APN-AMBR if received from the HSS/AAA.
The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message (PDN-ID). This message also
includes the APN-AMBR configuration option if received from the HSGW in the VSNCP
Configure-Request and if the APN-AMBR is supported by the UE.
13
10
11
12
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
46
4.4.6.2
Figure 16 illustrates an example call flow for IPv4 address allocation using DHCPv4 Rapid
Commit Option (see TS 23.402 [25]). In the example provided the UE sets PDN Type to IPv4
in VSNCP Configure-Request, indicating that it supports IPv4 only. This example also
applies to a UE that indicates IPv4v6 capabilities, but the HSGW limits the PBU to IPv4 only
due to subscription limitation for the APN.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
eAN/
ePCF
UE
10
11
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
P-GW/
DHCP Server
HSS/AAA
12
13
HSGW/DHCP Relay
Agent
23
24
25
26
10. DHCPDISCOVER
with Rapid Commit
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
Figure 16 IPv4 Address Allocation using DHCPv4 with Rapid Commit Option
37
38
39
1.
The UE has performed successful authentication and is attached to the eHRPD access
network.
2.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN Address (IPv4, PDN
Address=0), IPv4 Default Router Address, Protocol Configuration Options, and Attach Type
(Initial Attach). Using the Address Allocation Preference contained in the PCO, the UE
indicates that it wants deferred IPv4 address assignment.
3.
Since the Attach Type is set to Initial Attach in this call flow, the HSGW selects a new
P-GW based on APN received from HSS/HAAA (for default PDN connection, if the UE does
not identify a requested APN in step 2) or received from the UE. The HSGW sends a PBU to
the P-GW. See 3GPP 23.402 [25] and 29.275 [37].
4.
The P-GW updates the 3GPP AAA Server/HSS with P-GWs identity (i.e., FQDN, or IP
address). See 3GPP 23.402 [25].
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
47
5.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW. The P-GW in this scenario includes
3GPP Vendor-Specific PMIPv6 DHCPv4 Address Allocation Procedure Indication option in
the Proxy Binding Acknowledgement message indicating that the UE requested deferred IPv4
address allocation. The P-GW in this case assigns and returns an IPv4 address and an IPv4
default router address to the HSGW as described in section 4.4.1.1.3. See 3GPP 23.402 [25]
and 29.275 [37].
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
6.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack (PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN Address, IPv4
Default Router Address, PCO, and Attach Type) message to the UE over the main service
connection. Note that the PDN address in VSNCP Configure-Ack contains the 0.0.0.0
address since the HSGW received a deferred IPv4 address allocation indicator in the Proxy
Binding Acknowledgement message in step 5. In the case that the UE had indicated IPv4v6
capabilities in step 2, but the HSGW indicated only IPv4 in the PBU in step 3, then the
HSGW sets the Address Allocation Cause option to New PDN type due to subscription
limitation.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
7.
8.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The information in the message includes the PDN-ID configuration option.
This message also includes the APN-AMBR configuration option if received from the
HSS/AAA.
The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message. The information in the message
includes the PDN-ID configuration option. This message also includes the APN-AMBR
configuration option if received from the HSGW in the VSNCP Configure-Request and if the
APN-AMBR is supported by the UE.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
9.
The UE sends a DHCPDISCOVER message with the Rapid Commit option in broadcast to
the network to find available servers.
29
30
31
32
10. Upon receiving the DHCPDISCOVER with Rapid Commit message, the HSGW acting as a
DHCPv4 Relay Agent shall add its address in the GIADDR option and add the assigned UE
IP address (received from P-GW in the PBA message) in the "Address Request" option, and
relay the message in unicast within the PMIPv6 tunnel to the P-GW. The P-GW acts as a
DHCPv4 server.
11. When receiving the DHCPDISCOVER message, the P-GW should verify the GIADDR
option. Then the P-GW uses "Address Request" option to identify the UE binding and update
it with the 'client identifier' and 'chaddr' combination for subsequent DHCPv4 procedure.
The P-GW extends the IP lease offer and sends a DHCPACK message with the Rapid
Commit option to the HSGW. This message is sent through the PMIPv6 tunnel established
between the HSGW/MAG and the P-GW/LMA.
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
12. The HSGW forwards the DHCPACK with the Rapid Commit option to the UE.
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
48
4.4.6.3
Figure 17 illustrates an example call flow for IPv4 address allocation by using DHCPv4
without the DHCPv4 rapid commit option (see TS 23.402 [25]). In the example provided the
UE sets PDN Type to IPv4 in VSNCP Configure-Request, to indicate that it supports IPv4
only. This example also applies to a UE that indicates IPv4v6 capabilities, but the HSGW
limits the PBU to IPv4 only due to subscription limitation for the APN.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
eAN/
ePCF
UE
HSGW/
DHCP Relay Agent
11
12
P-GW/
DHCP Server
HSS/AAA
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
9. DHCPDISCOVER
20
21
10. DHCPDISCOVER
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
16. DHCPACK
(IPv4 Address, IPv4 Default Router Address, etc.)
15. DHCPACK
(IPv4 Address, IPv4 Default
Router Address, etc.)
35
36
37
38
39
40
Figure 17 IPv4 Address Allocation using DHCPv4 without Rapid Commit Option
1.
41
The UE has performed successful authentication and is attached to the eHRPD access
network.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
10. Upon receiving the DHCPDISCOVER message, the HSGW acting as a DHCPv4 Relay Agent
shall add its address in the GIADDR option and add the assigned UE IP address (received
from P-GW in the PBA message) in the "Address Request" option, and relay the message in
unicast within the PMIPv6 tunnel to the P-GW acting as a DHCPv4 server.
11. When receiving the DHCPDISCOVER message, the P-GW should verify the GIADDR
option. Then the P-GW uses "Address Request" option to identify the UE binding and update
it with the 'client identifier' and 'chaddr' combination for subsequent DHCPv4 procedure.
58
59
60
49
After that the P-GW extends an IP lease offer and sends the DHCPOFFER with the assigned
UE IP address.
1
2
3
12. The HSGW acting as DHCPv4 Relay Agent relays the DHCPv4 message to the UE.
13. When the UE receives the lease offer, it sends a DHCPREQUEST message containing the
received IP address.
4
5
6
7
8
9
14. The HSGW acting as DHCPv4 Relay Agent relays the DHCPv4 message to the P-GW.
15. When the P-GW receives the DHCPREQUEST message from the UE, it sends a DHCPACK
message to the UE. This message includes the lease duration and any other configuration
information that the client might have requested.
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
16. The HSGW acting as DHCPv4 relay agent relays the DHCPv4 message to the UE.
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
50
4.4.6.4
3
4
5
6
UE
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSS/
AAA
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
22
23
20
21
24
25
26
9. Router Solicitation
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
1.
The UE and the network has performed successful authentication and is attached to the
eHRPD access network.
2.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN Address (IPv6, PDN
address=0), Protocol Configuration Options, Attach Type (Initial Attach).
3.
Since the Attach Type is set to Initial Attach, the HSGW selects a new P-GW based on
APN received from HSS/HAAA (for the default PDN connection, if the UE does not identify
a requested APN in step 2) or received from the UE. The HSGW sends a PBU to the P-GW.
See 3GPP 23.402 [25] and 29.275 [37].
4.
The P-GW updates the 3GPP AAA Server/HSS with P-GWs identity (i.e., FQDN, or IP
address). See 3GPP 23.402 [25].
5.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW. See 3GPP 23.402 [25] and 29.275
[37].
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
51
6.
7.
8.
9.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack message (PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN
Address, PCO, and Attach Type) to the UE over the main service connection. The PDN
Address Information contains the IPv6 interface ID in this example.
1
2
3
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID configuration option. This message also
includes the APN-AMBR if received from the HSS/AAA.
The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message that contains the PDN-ID
configuration option.
This step is optional. The UE may send a Router Solicitation (RS) message to the HSGW via
the eAN.
5
6
7
9
10
11
12
10. Upon receiving the Route Solicitation message or any time after step 8, the HSGW sends an
IPv6 Router Advertisement message (see RFC 4862 [78]) to the UE which includes the UEs
home network prefix.
13
11. The UE generates an IPv6 global unicast address via IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration
(see RFC 4862 [78]). The UE may use the interface ID received from step 6 to configure its
link local IPv6 address.
17
14
15
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
52
4.4.6.5
Figure 19 shows an example call flow for IPv6 address allocation with IPv6 prefix delegation.
3
4
5
6
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
7
8
9
10
11
12
3. PMIP Binding
Update (Handoff
Indicator, etc.)
14
15
16
17
18
19
21
22
23
24
29
30
31
26
28
25
27
HSS/
AAA
13
20
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
32
33
34
35
36
37
16. Advertise
17. Request
15. Advertise
18.Request
38
39
40
41
42
43
1.
The UE has performed successful authentication with the network and is attached to the
eHRPD access network.
2.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN Address (IPv6, PDN
address=0), Protocol Configuration Options, and Attach Type (Initial Attach).
3.
Since the Attach Type is set to Initial Attach, the HSGW selects a P-GW based on the APN
received from HSS/HAAA (for the default PDN connection, if the UE does not identify a
requested APN in step 2) or received from the UE. The HSGW sends a PBU to the P-GW.
See 3GPP 23.402 [25] and 29.275 [37].
4.
The P-GW updates the 3GPP AAA Server/HSS with P-GWs identity (i.e., FQDN, or IP
address). See 3GPP 23.402 [25].
5.
If the UE is authorized to use IPv6 prefix delegation, the P-GW assigns a network prefix
shorter than the default /64 prefix.
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
53
6.
7.
8.
9.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW with the default prefix. See 3GPP
23.402 [25] and 29.275 [37].
1
2
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack message (PDN-ID, APN, PDN Type, PDN
Address, PCO, and Attach Type) to the UE over the main service connection. The PDN
Address Information contains the IPv6 interface ID in this example.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID configuration option. This message also
includes the APN-AMBR if received from the HSS/AAA.
The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message that contains the PDN-ID
configuration option.
10. This step is optional. The UE may send a Router Solicitation (RS) message to the HSGW via
the eAN.
11. Upon receiving the Router Solicitation message or any time after step 8, the HSGW sends an
IPv6 Router Advertisement message (see RFC 4862 [78]) to the UE which includes the UEs
home network prefix.
12. The UE generates an IPv6 global unicast address via IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration
(see RFC 4862 [78]). The UE may use the interface ID received from step 6 to configure its
link local IPv6 address.
4
5
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
13. The UE which acts as a "Requesting Router" as described in RFC3633 [66] sends DHCPv6
SOLICIT message including one or more IA_PD option(s) to the HSGW to acquire the
delegated prefix(es).
23
14. Upon receiving DHCPv6 SOLICIT, the HSGW, acted as a DHCPv6 Relay Agent as
described in RFC3315 [62] relays the DHCPv6 SOLICIT message to the P-GW (delegation
router). The P-GW inserts one or more IA_PD option(s) including the delegated prefix(es) to
the reply message.
27
24
25
26
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
18. The HSGW relays the DHCPv6 REQUEST message to the P-GW.
40
19. The P-GW responses to the REQUEST from the HSGW using DHCPv6 REPLY message.
42
20. The UE receives one or more IA_PD prefix(es) in the DHCPv6 REPLY message from the
HSGW.
41
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
54
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
4.5
Quality of Service
The HSGW performs a number of Quality of Service related functions that are defined for the
PDSN in X.S0011 [6]. Such functions include the following:
TFT handling
Uplink bearer binding verification with packet dropping of traffic that does not comply
with established uplink policy.
Transport level packet marking in the uplink and the downlink based on the assigned
QCI.
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
The HSGW shall perform bearer establishment procedures, e.g., trigger the creation of link
flows, TFTs, and mapping of downlink flows to A10 connections in accordance with X.S0011
[6] and in accordance with this specification. Bearer establishment procedures may occur
directly over the eHRPD air interface or via S101.
24
25
26
27
28
29
Policy related QoS processing, including uplink packet marking, traffic shaping, etc, are
performed in the P-GW in accordance with TS 23.203 [21] and TS 23.402 [25]. For EUTRAN/eHRPD interworking scenarios, that same paradigm is followed; hence, these
functions are not performed in the HSGW.
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
55
4.5.1
The 3GPP Evolved Packet System (EPS) provides IP connectivity between a UE and an
external packet data network. This is referred to as PDN Connectivity Service. The PDN
Connectivity Service supports the transport of one or more IP flows (also known as Service
Data Flows (SDFs) and is defined in TS 23.401 [24]).
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
UL TFT
PDN-ID* +
RLP-ID (NN)
DL TFT SR_ID +
PDN-ID*
RLP-ID (NN) A8
GRE Key
A8 GRE key
A10 GRE Key
14
15
16
17
DL TFT
18
19
20
21
22
23
UE
Reservation Label
(Flow ID)
SDF
ePCF
BTS / eAN
HRPD Radio Bearer
RLP-ID (NN)
HSGW
A10 Tunnel
(A10 GRE Key)
A8 Tunnel
(A8 GRE Key)
P-GW
UL TFT
SR_ID +
PDN-ID*
TNL QoS +
PMIP GRE Key
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
* PDN-ID is used to multiplex EPS bearers from multiple PDNs. PDN-ID is used on
auxiliary service connections configured with SO72, on HDLC-based framing auxiliary
service connections configured with SO64, and on the main service connection
configured with SO59.
An EPS bearer is mapped to a service connection in one of the two ways: (1) by multiplexing
EPS bearers from multiple PDNs over a single service connection by using the PDN-ID, or
(2) by assigning only one EPS bearer to a dedicated service connection, in which case the
PDN-ID is not used. The choice of mapping approach and the assigned service connection is
communicated to the UE and HSGW by the eAN/ePCF.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
If an eHRPD BE auxiliary service connection has been created, then the BE IP packets
(SDFs) from all PDNs are multiplexed across that BE auxiliary service connection (i.e., using
SO72) by including an extra octet immediately ahead of the IP packet. This extra octet shall
contain the PDN-ID of the PDN that the IP packet is associated with. This is referred to as
PDN multiplexing (PDN-Mux). Otherwise, the BE IP packets from all PDNs shall be
multiplexed across the main service connection. See section 9.1.5 for the stage 3 details on
the use of the main service connection to carry multiplexed IP traffic using VSNP.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
Other auxiliary service connections (i.e., using SO72) may be created to support
multiplexing of traffic with similar QoS from multiple PDNs by including an extra
56
57
58
59
60
56
octet immediately ahead of the IP packet. This extra octet shall contain the PDN-ID of
the PDN that is the source/destination of the IP packet (PDN-Mux).
1
2
3
4
5
Auxiliary service connections that use packet-based framing but do not use
multiplexing of IP packets from multiple PDNs shall use SO67. SO67 shall not be
used for a multiplexed auxiliary service connection.
6
7
8
9
Signaling traffic between the HSGW and UE shall be carried on the main service connection.
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
IP packets (SDFs) from all PDNs shall be multiplexed across the main service connection or
HDLC-based framing auxiliary service connections by the inclusion of a PDN Identifier field
immediately ahead of the IP packet. This PDN Identifier field shall contain the PDN-ID of
the PDN that the IP packet is associated with. See section 9.1.5 for the stage 3 details of the
use of the main service connection to carry multiplexed IP traffic using VSNP.
QoS control between a HSGW and a P-GW is provided at the Transport Network Layer
(TNL).
20
21
22
23
24
Uplink TFTs in the UE bind one or more IP flows (SDFs) to an EPS bearer in the
uplink direction.
Downlink TFTs in the HSGW bind one or more IP flows (SDFs) to an EPS bearer in
the downlink direction.
A radio bearer (RLP link) transports the packets of an EPS bearer between a UE and
an eAN.
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
BE SDFs for all PDNs are mapped to the radio bearer that is configured for
BE flows. Only one radio bearer is used for BE flows.
SDFs for multiple PDNs can also be mapped onto the radio bearer that is
configured as the main service connection.
Packet framed EPS bearers and HDLC framed EPS bearers for multiple
PDNs can be mapped onto a packet-based framing (SO72) and HDLC
framing (SO64) auxiliary service connection, respectively, by the inclusion
of a PDN Identifier field.
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
The UE stores a mapping between an uplink packet filter and a radio bearer to create
the binding between SDFs and a radio bearer in the uplink.
The eAN stores a one-to-one mapping between a radio bearer and an A8 bearer to
create the binding between a radio bearer and an A8 bearer in both the uplink and the
downlink directions.
The ePCF stores a one-to-one mapping between an A8 bearer and an A10 bearer to
create the A8/A10 bearer binding in both the uplink and downlink directions.
An HSGW stores a mapping between downlink packet filters and an A10 bearer to
create the binding between SDFs and an A10 bearer in the downlink.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
57
The PDN Connectivity Service between a UE and an external packet data network is
supported through a concatenation of an EPS Bearer and IP connectivity between HSGW and
P-GW. Over the PMIP-based S2a interface, the transport of IP flows going to the P-GW is
realized as follows:
1
2
3
4
5
A per-UE per PDN tunnel transports the packets of EPS bearers between the HSGW
and a P-GW. There is a many-to-one mapping between EPS bearers and this per-UE,
per PDN tunnel.
In the uplink direction in the case of multiplexed A10 connections, the HSGW shall
use the PDN-ID information associated with the flow to determine the PDN tunnel.
In the case of non-multiplexed A10 connections, the traffic is associated with only a
single PDN; therefore, the A10 context can be used to determine which PDN the
traffic belongs to.
10
7
8
9
11
12
13
14
15
16
4.5.2
4.5.3
4.5.3.1
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
The following diagram illustrates network initiated dedicated resource allocation operations
for eHRPD which are triggered by the PCRF. The procedures shown include PCRF
interactions described in TS 23.402 [25] and eHRPD specific procedures. The bearer to be
established is assumed in this example to be related to a PDN with which the UE has a current
PDN connection.
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
On receiving the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provisioning message from the PCRF, the
HSGW decides that a new bearer needs to be activated, the HSGW uses this QoS policy to
assign the bearer QoS, (i.e., it maps PCC QoS parameters to a set of eHRPD FlowProfileIDs).
The HSGW follows this with the procedure shown in Figure 21 by sending an RSVP Resv
message to the UE.
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
58
Roaming
Scenario
1
2
3
4
UE
P-GW
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
vPCRF
hPCRF
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
2. HSGW maps
informations provided in
PCC Rules to eHRPD
QoS Profile ID(s)
3. VSNP: [PDN-ID] Resv (UL/DL packet filter,
QoS List, Transaction ID = nn)
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
8. Reservation ON
(ReservationLabel)
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
Both the roaming and non-roaming scenarios are depicted in Figure 21. In the roaming case, the
vPCRF acts as an intermediary, sending the QoS Policy Rules from the hPCRF in the hPLMN to
the HSGW in the vPLMN. The vPCRF receives the Acknowledgment from the HSGW and
forwards it to the hPCRF. In the non-roaming case, the vPCRF is not involved.
1.
The PCRF initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Procedure specified in TS
23.203 [21] by sending a message with the QoS rules and Event Trigger information to the
HSGW.
2.
The HSGW uses the received QoS policy information to determine the bearer level QoS
parameters required for the eHRPD bearer. The HSGW maps these parameters to the
appropriate eHRPD FlowProfileID(s) (see C.R1001 [12]).
3.
The HSGW sends an RSVP Resv message transported over the main service connection. As
indicated in section 9, the RSVP Resv message encapsulation includes the PDN-ID of the
PDN for which the bearer is being created. The RSVP Resv message includes the
Uplink/Downlink packet filter, the QoS list, and a Transaction ID. See section 9.1.6.7.1 for
parameter details.
4.
The UE performs the standard QoS establishment procedures defined in C.S0024 [10] and in
C.S0063 [13]. There are two possible sequences that can occur at this step. If a new QoS link
flow connection is needed to carry the new flow over the air interface, then the eAN will
setup a new air interface link flow. If the eAN decides to carry the flow(s) on an existing link
flow, it then reconfigures the parameters of that link flow.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
59
5.
If a new link flow is needed, a new A10 connection is also established. The eAN/ePCF sends
an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the GRE key, the Requested
QoS information, and the Granted QoS information for the flow. The Granted QoS
information includes the FLOW_ID. If a new QoS link flow is not needed, the eAN sends an
A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the GRE key, FLOW_ID, and the
modified Granted QoS information for the existing connection (if required).
3
4
5
6
7
7.
The HSGW acknowledges the delivery of the RSVP Resv message it received in Step 6 by
sending a ResvConf message to the UE.
15
8.
Since by default the Reservation for the newly created bearer is in the Closed state, the UE (or
eAN) may trigger the transition to the open state.
18
9.
Once the air interface reservation is transitioned to the Open state, the eAN will trigger an
A11-Registration Request (Active Start) message to initiate the accounting for this bearer
connection.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
16
17
19
20
21
22
23
10. Any time after Step 6 the HSGW responds to the PCRF indicating its ability to enforce the
rules provisioned to it in Step 1 and thus completing the Gateway Control and QoS Rules
Provision Ack procedure started in step 1.
24
11. The PCRF initiates the PCC Rules Provision Procedure as specified in TS 23.203 [21]. The
PCRF provides updated PCC rules to the PCEF for enforcement by means of a PCC Rules
Provision procedure specified in TS 23.203 [21].
28
NOTE: Step 11 may occur before step 2 or may be performed in parallel with steps 1 and 10 if
acknowledgement of resource allocation is not required to update PCC rules in the PCEF. For
details please refer to TS 23.203 [21].
4.5.3.2.1
The UE sends an RSVP Resv message to the HSGW. The message includes the Flow ID for
the bearer connection, and the same DL/UL TFT and Transaction ID received in step 3. This
message can be sent in parallel with the start of the signaling in Step 4. The Transaction ID is
used to associate the returned Flow ID with the new bearer connection. This message is also
used as an acknowledgement to the RSVP Resv message in Step 3. The HSGW examines the
QoS granted to the UE and compares it to the QoS authorized for the UE in step 2. If there is
a discrepancy, the HSGW applies operator policy.
6.
4.5.3.2
25
26
27
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Network initiated bearer deactivation shall take into account the deactivation of both
dedicated auxiliary service connections and the removal of bearers from a PDN-ID
multiplexed shared service connection. While removing a bearer from a multiplexed shared
service connection, it is necessary to retain the shared service connection for connectivity to
other PDNs. A service connection is removed when the last Reservation associated with the
service connection is removed.
This call flow assumes the PCRF initiated modification or release of an EPS bearer.
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
60
Roaming
Scenario
1
2
3
4
UE
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
vPCRF
P-GW1
hPCRF
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
1.
The PCRF initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Procedure specified in TS
23.203 [21] by sending a message with the QoS rules and Event Trigger information to the
HSGW.
2.
The HSGW sends a Resv message to the UE with OpCode set to Initiate Delete Packet Filter
from Existing TFT indicating the EPS bearer deletion. The message is indexed with the
PDN-ID of the PDN for which the EPS bearer is being deleted.
3.
The UE performs standard HRPD procedures to reconfigure the air interface in order to
remove or modify the requested Reservation(s). If the last Reservation(s) associated with the
link flow is removed, the link flow itself is also removed.
4.
The eAN sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the removed
Flow ID(s). If the last Flow ID associated with the auxiliary A10 is removed, the auxiliary
A10 itself is removed.
5.
The UE sends a Resv message with OpCode set to Initiate Delete Packet Filter from Existing
TFT to indicate to the HSGW which flows have been removed. The TFT IE contains the list
of flow identifiers for which filters have been deleted. The Transaction ID carried in this
message shall be the same as the Transaction ID carried in the Resv message in step 2. This
message is also used as an acknowledgement to the RSVP Resv message in Step 2.
6.
The HSGW acknowledges a successful update of the IP flow mapping information by sending
a ResvConf message to the UE.
7.
The HSGW indicates to the PCRF whether the requested QoS Policy Rules Provision could
be enforced or not by sending a Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Acknowledgment
message.
8.
The PCRF initiates the PCC Rules Provision Procedure as specified in TS 23.203. The PCRF
provides updated PCC rules to the PCEF for enforcement by means of a PCC Rules Provision
procedure specified in TS 23.203 [21].
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
NOTE: Step 8 may occur before step 1 or performed in parallel with steps 1 and 7 if
acknowledgement of resource de-allocation is not required to update PCC rules in the PCEF. For
details please refer to TS 23.203 [21].
1
2
3
4
4.5.4
4.5.4.1
6
7
The UE requested bearer resource allocation and release model for eHRPD shall follow
TS23.203 [21] and TS23.402 [25]. In the PCC model the UE request resources which are in
turn granted and established by the network or modified and deleted depending on the nature
of the UE request.
9
10
11
12
13
14
4.5.4.1.1
15
17
16
18
19
Roaming
Scenario
P-GW1
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
UE
vPCRF
20
21
hPCRF
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
10. Reservation ON
(ReservationLabel)
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
62
1.
The UE sends a Resv message to the HSGW with OpCode set to QoS-Check. The UE
encapsulates the Resv message over the main service connection using VSNP and includes
the PDN-ID to indicate to which PDN the additional bearer resource is linked. The message
contains the UE requested FlowProfileIDs. The Transaction ID is dynamically allocated by
the UE for UE requested bearer resource activation procedure. In the example presented in
the figure, Transaction ID is 1.
2.
The HSGW maps the received FlowProfileID(s) into a single set of QCI/MBR/GBR
parameters.
3.
The HSGW uses Gateway Control and QoS Rules Request/Reply procedures to validate UE
requested QoS with the hPCRF. If the HSGW is deployed in a roaming scenario, the message
including QCI/MBR/GBR(s) and packet filter(s) is sent to the vPCRF and the vPCRF
forwards it to the hPCRF.
4.
The HSGW maps the validated policy rules into appropriate FlowProfileID(s) that are being
requested.
5.
The HSGW sends a ResvConf message to the UE with OpCode set to QoS-Check Conf. The
Resv message is an RSVP message transported over the main service connection. The
ResvConf message contains the authorized FlowProfileIDs, which is the same or a subset of
the UE requested FlowProfileIDs in step 1, and the same Transaction ID as in the Resv
message sent in step 1. This step is used as an acknowledgment of the Resv message sent in
step 1.
6.
The UE performs the standard HRPD QoS establishment procedures defined in C.S0087 [15]
/ C.S0063 [13] using the authorized FlowProfileID list from step 5. There are two possible
sequences that can occur at this step. If a new QoS link flow connection is needed to carry the
new flow over the air interface, then the eAN will setup a new air interface link flow. If the
eAN decides to carry the flow(s) on an existing link flow, it then reconfigures the parameters
of that link flow.
7.
If a new link flow is needed, a new A10 connection is also established. The eAN sends an
A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the GRE key, the Requested QoS
information, and Granted QoS information for the flow. The A11 message includes the
FLOW_ID. If a new QoS link flow is not needed, the eAN sends an A11-Registration Request
message to the HSGW indicating the GRE key, FLOW_ID, and the modified Granted QoS
information for the existing connection (if required).
8.
The UE sends a Resv message to the HSGW to associate the selected Reservation with the
appropriate A10 connection and TFT. The message includes the Flow ID and associated
packet filters for which the FlowProfileID(s) are authorized at step 5. This message can be
sent in parallel with the start of the signalling in Step 6. The Transaction ID is different than
that used in steps 1 and 5 to avoid having the HSGW view this message as a repetition of the
message in step 1. The HSGW examines the QoS granted to the UE and compares it to the
QoS authorized for the UE in step 5. If there is a discrepancy, the HSGW applies operator
policy.
9.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
10. Since by default the Reservation for the newly created bearer is in the Closed state, the UE (or
eAN) may trigger the transition to the open state.
11. Once the air interface reservation is transitioned to the Open state, the eAN will trigger an
A11-Registration Request (Active Start) message to initiate the accounting for this bearer
connection.
12. Upon a successful negotiation of QoS, the HSGW sends the acknowledgement to the PCRF
based on the QoS that was selected in step 2.
13. The IP CAN Session Modification Procedure may occur as the result of the Gateway Control
and QoS Rules Request message, either to forward an Event Report to the P-GW (PCEF) or to
60
63
issue revised PCC Rules and Event Triggers, or both an Event Report and a Rules and
Triggers provision. If an indication that resources have been acquired is not required then this
step may occur any time after step 3, above.
4.5.4.1.1.1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
If the HSGW receives a request from the UE to clean up the packet filter, then the HSGW
triggers UE requested packet filter clean up by sending a Gateway Control and QoS Policy
Rules Request to the PCRF and waits for the response from the PCRF. If instead of
receiving a response to this message, the HSGW receives a Gateway Control and QoS Rules
Provision message for the same packet filter from the PCRF, this is an indication that the
PCRF is initiating a packet filter clean up which results in the race condition, where both UE
and PCRF are trying to clean up the packet filter.
If the HSGW receives a Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision message from the PCRF
for a packet filter and if the HSGW had already sent a Gateway Control and QoS Rules
Request message for the same packet filter, then the HSGW shall omit steps 2 6 in Figure
22 and shall acknowledge the request from the PCRF by sending a Gateway Control and
QoS Policy Rules Provision Ack message.
The PCRF completes the UE requested packet filter clean up procedure by sending the
Gateway Control and QoS Rules Reply message.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
To enable the above behavior, if the HSGW receives a request from the UE to release the
packet filter, then the HSGW shall unbind all the QoS rules that are mapped to the packet
filter and shall set the QoS rules to inactive state. If the QoS rules for a certain packet filter
are in the inactive state, and if the HSGW receives a request from the PCRF to release the
packet filter, then the HSGW shall not trigger a network initiated packet filter deletion.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
64
4.5.4.1.2
The UE requested bearer resource model allows for efficiencies at the eHRPD air interface by
not requiring the deletion of bearers at the radio level and from the eAN/ePCF to the HSGW.
Instead, radio reservations can be placed in the Reservation Off state. An example is shown
in Figure 24.
3
4
5
6
7
8
Roaming
Scenario
9
10
11
UE
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
P-GW1
vPCRF
hPCRF
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
3. A11-RRP
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
5. The UE and the HSGW maintain the TFTs associated with this
bearer.
29
30
31
32
33
1.
Upon completion of the use of a bearer with specific QoS, e.g., a VoIP bearer, the UE sends a
request to the eAN to set the radio reservation for the bearer to the Off state, and the eAN
acknowledges the change to the Off state.
2.
The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW with an Active
Stop indication to inform the HSGW of the idle state of the Flow ID.
3.
4.
The eAN/ePCF and HSGW maintain the A10 connection used for the QoS bearer. This
bearer may be reused later for the same IP flow, e.g., for another VoIP call to the same IP
address on the UE. Such reuse would involve only the setting of the radio reservation state to
the On state, and the sending of Active Start Airlink Records to the HSGW.
5.
The UE and HSGW maintain the TFTs for the QoS Bearer.
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
65
4.6
2
3
This section describes the functions associated with policy and charging which are part of
EPC eHRPD Connectivity and Interworking Architecture (see Figure 25).
Per TS 23.401 [24] and TS 23.402 [25], an EPS needs to support both PCEF and PCRF
functionality to enable dynamic policy and charging control by means of installation of PCC
rules based on user and service dimensions. However, an EPS may only support PCEF
functionality in which case it shall support static policy and charging control.
The procedures defined in this specification assume that deployment of dynamic policy and
charging control (PCC) will be consistent throughout the network.
5
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
All call flows in this specification, unless noted otherwise, assume the use of PCC.
NOTE:The local configuration of PCEF static policy and charging control
functionality is not subject to standardization. The PCEF static policy and control
functionality is not based on subscription information.
The HSGW network element implements the Bearer Binding and Event Reporting Function
(BBERF) needed to interwork EPC with eHRPD (see Figure 25).
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
PCRF
27
28
29
Gxa
30
31
32
33
34
35
Pi*
BBERF
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSGW
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
A10/A11
43
44
45
46
47
48
4.6.1
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
66
1
2
3
4
5
6
4.6.2
7
8
9
10
11
2. Gxa shall support transfer of QoS parameters and related packet filters.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
The service level QoS parameters are conveyed in QoS rules and their definition and usage
are discussed in TS 23.401 [24] and TS 23.402 [25]. The service level QoS parameters consist
of:
QoS Class Identifier (QCI) and Allocation and Retention Priority (ARP) for both
Guaranteed Bit-Rate and non-Guaranteed Bit Rate bearers.
Guaranteed Bit Rate (GBR) and Maximum Bit Rate (MBR) parameters for
Guaranteed Bit Rate bearers.
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
67
4.6.2.1
1
2
3
4
4.6.2.1.1
3GPP2-BSID AVP
The AVP 3GPP2-BSID (Code 5535/9010) is of type UTF8String and the data is formatted
according to the 3GPP2 RADIUS VSA BSID defined in [5].
6
8
9
10
11
12
Table 1
13
14
AVP Code
5535/9010
Value Type
Shall
UTF8String
M,V
May
Should
not
15
Must not
May
Encr.
No
The AVP header bit denoted as M indicates whether support of the AVP is required. The AVP header
bit denoted as V indicates whether the optional Vendor-ID field is present in the AVP header. For
further details, see RFC 3588 [65].
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
4.6.3
26
Charging
27
Accounting functionality is provided by the HSGW and the P-GW. The BBERF function in
the HSGW shall collect accounting information for each UE i.e., the amount of data
transmitted in uplink and downlink directions. The accounting related functionality provided
by the HSGW is aligned with the accounting functionality defined for the S-GW in TS 23.401
[24]. The charging functions in the HSGW, with associated interfaces shall be supported as
specified in TS 32.240 [39]. The behavior of the charging functions in eHRPD EPC domain,
the reporting of the chargeable events, and creation of the CDRs shall be as specified in TS
32.240 [39] and TS 32.251 [40].
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
The P-GW provides charging functionality for each UE according to TS 23.203 [21].
4.6.4
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
4.6.5
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
68
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
4.6.6
26
27
28
29
This QoS mapping capability provides the policy interworking used during session
establishment and E-UTRAN to eHRPD handoffs.
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
69
4.6.7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
4.7
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
4.7.1
The S103 interface shall support the ability to tunnel traffic on a per-UE, per-PDN basis
32
The S103 interface shall support Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE) RFC 2784 [57]
including the Key Field extension RFC 2890 [58]. The Key field value of each GRE
packet header uniquely identifies the PDN connectivity that the GRE packet payload is
associated with.
34
33
35
36
37
38
39
40
See TS 29.276 [38] for details on the protocol stack for the S103 interface.
41
42
43
4.7.2
44
S103 Procedures
45
The S103 interface is established to provide indirect data forwarding from the S-GW to the
HSGW during handoff from E-UTRAN to eHRPD. For stage 3 details, see TS 29.276 [38].
46
During the handoff execution phase from E-UTRAN to eHRPD, the HSGW provides its own
IP address for the eHRPD end of the S103 interface, as well as the GRE key(s) and the APNs
associated with each of those GRE keys(s) for packet forwarding from the S-GW to the
HSGW. This information is passed to the eAN/ePCF across the A11 interface, see section 8.
The eAN/ePCF then forwards that information to the MME across the S101 interface, and the
MME provides it to the S-GW. The S-GW uses the HSGW IP address and GRE key(s) for
packet forwarding from the S-GW to the HSGW.
49
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
70
1
2
4.8
PPP/VSNCP Renegotiation
If a UE that is attached to one or more PDNs receives an LCP-Configure-Request from an
HSGW (e.g., inter-HSGW handoff without context transfer occurs), the UE shall perform
LCP negotiation and EAP-AKA authentication as specified in section 4.2. In addition, the
UE shall also perform Handoff Attach to all the PDNs that it was previously connected to and
wishes to remain connected to.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
4.9
MUPSAP (Multiple PDN Connections to A Single APN) allows the UE to setup more than
one PDN connection with an APN. Each PDN connection is uniquely identified using PDN
Identifier + User Context Identifier. This section defines the additional requirements for the
UE and HSGW to support MUPSAP over eHRPD. See section 12 for MUPSAP support for
handoff from E-UTRAN to eHRPD.
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
4.9.1
If the PDN Type configuration option of VSNCP Configure-Ack message received from
the HSGW is set to IPv4, then the UE should set the PDN Type configuration option of
the new VSNCP Configure-Request message to IPv6.
59
60
71
If the PDN Type configuration option of VSNCP Configure-Ack message received from
the HSGW is set to IPv6, then the UE should set the PDN Type configuration option of
the new VSNCP Configure-Request message to IPv4.
If the HSGW included the APN-AMBR configuration option in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest message for more than one PDN connection connecting to same APN, then the UE
shall use the latest value of the APN-AMBR configuration option for that APN.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
If the HSGW does not support MUPSAP, it shall not include the PDN Connection ID
information element in the Proxy Binding Update message it sends to the P-GW. If the
HSGW does not receive a PDN connection ID value in the Proxy Binding Acknowledge
message sent by the P-GW, it shall not include the User Context Identifier configuration
option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message sent to the UE. In the case of S101 based preregistration, if the HSGW had already included the User Context Identifier configuration
option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message sent to the UE, and if the HSGW determines at
the time of handoff that the P-GW does not support MUPSAP, then the HSGW shall initiate
termination of all PDN connections to that APN by sending VSNCP Terminate Request
message to the UE.
To terminate a specific MUPSAP PDN connection, the UE or HSGW shall include the PDN
Identifier and the User Context Identifier in the VSNCP Terminate-Request message. If the
VSNCP Terminate-Request message does not include a User Context Identifier configuration
option, it implies all PDN connections to the APN shall be removed.When multiple PDN
connections to an APN are setup, and if the VSNP Extend Code is negotiated for the first
PDN connection to that APN, then all subsequent PDN connections to that APN shall use the
same VSNP Extend Code until all the PDN connections to that APN are torn down. If the
VSNP Extend Code is not negotiated for the first PDN connection to that APN, then none of
the subsequent PDN connections to that APN shall negotiate the VSNP Extend Code until all
the PDN connections to that APN are torn down.
For optimized handoff from E-UTRAN to eHRPD, GRE tunnels between the S-GW and
HSGW are established per UE per APN. For MUPSAP, the HSGW will distinguish the
packets for different PDN connections to the same APN using the destination IP address of
the packet.
4.9.2
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
The QoS setup procedure is performed for each of the MUPSAP PDN connections using the
procedures specified in section 4.5.
40
41
42
Each of the service connections, (i.e., each concatenation of an RLP flow with an A8+A10
connection, between the UE and the HSGW) established for an APN may be shared by all the
MUPSAP PDN connections for that APN for the same QoS.
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
4.10
50
51
52
4.10.1
53
Overview
54
This section provides an overview of the functionality for emergency bearer services. The
specific functionality is described in the affected procedures and functions of this
55
56
57
58
59
60
72
1
2
specification. For discrepancies between this overview clause and the detailed procedure and
function descriptions, the latter take precedence.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
Emergency bearer services are provided to support IMS emergency sessions. Emergency
bearer services are functionalities provided by the serving eHRPD access network when the
network is configured to support emergency services. Emergency bearer services are provided
to normal attached UEs and depending on local regulation, to UEs that are in limited service
state. Receiving emergency services in limited service state does not require a subscription.
Depending on local regulation and an operator's policy, the HSGW may allow or reject an
emergency attach request for UEs in limited service state. Four different behaviours of
emergency bearer support have been identified as follows:
a.
Valid UEs only. No limited service state UEs are supported in the network. Only
normal UEs that have a valid subscription, are authenticated and authorized for PS
service in the attached location are allowed. Normal UEs should initiate a normal
attach procedure (if not already attached to the network) and then perform a PDN
Connection Request (ref. section 4.10.8.1) when an IMS emergency session is
detected by the UE.
b.
Only UEs that are authenticated are allowed. These UEs must have a valid IMSI.
These UEs are authenticated and may be in limited service state due to being in a
location that they are restricted from service. A UE that can not be authenticated will
be rejected.
c.
d.
All UEs are allowed. Along with authenticated UEs, this includes UEs with an IMSI
that can not be authenticated and UEs with only an MEID. The MEID is used in the
network to identify the UE.
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
The HSGW shall not allow a UE that is emergency attached to the network to connect to
PDNs other than the emergency PDN.
3GPP2 MEIDs and 3GPP IMEIs are taken from the same name space. Where 3GPP
specifications require IMEI, the MEID of the UE shall be used in attachments to the eHRPD
access network, since the value of the IMEI and the value of the MEID in the UE are exactly
the same (ref. SC.R4002 [17]).
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
To provide emergency bearer services, the HSGW is configured with HSGW Emergency
Configuration Data that are applied to all emergency bearer services that are established by an
HSGW on UE request. The HSGW Emergency Configuration Data contains the emergency
APN which is used to derive a P-GW, or the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data may also
contain the statically configured P-GW for the emergency APN.
UEs that are in limited service state initiate the Attach procedure with indicating that the
attach is to receive emergency services. The network supporting emergency services for UEs
in limited service state provides emergency bearer services to each such UE, regardless
whether the UE can be authenticated, has roaming or mobility restrictions or a valid
subscription, depending on local regulation. The UEs in limited service state determine that
the cell supports emergency services over eHRPD from a broadcast indicator in the
AccessHashingChannelMask (ref. C.S0024 [10]). UEs that camp normally on a cell, i.e.
without any conditions that result in limited service state, initiate the UE Requested PDN
60
73
Connectivity procedure to receive emergency bearer services. The UEs that camp normally on
a cell are informed that the network supports emergency services by means of the VSNCP
Configure-Request sent by the HSGW. Additionally, the eAN indicates emergency support
over eHRPD as specified in C.S0087 [15].
1
2
3
4
5
For a UE that is Emergency Attached, normal network selection principles apply after the
emergency PDN connection is disconnected.
For emergency bearer services any EPC functions, procedures and capabilities are provided
according to TS 23.401 [24] except when specified differently in the following sections.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
For emergency bearer services there is no support of inter-network mobility (i.e., interoperator mobility) in this version of this specification.
When a network supports IMS emergency services, all HSGWs in that network shall have the
same capability to support emergency bearer services.
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
The particular requirements for access to the EPC via an eHRPD access network in support of
emergency accesses and emergency services in the case of handover from E-UTRAN to
eHRPD are specified in TS 23.402 [25].
20
21
22
23
24
4.10.2
4.10.3
4.10.4
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
Where local regulations require supporting calls from an unauthorized caller, the HSGW may
not have subscription data. Additionally, the local network may want to provide IMS
emergency call support differently than what is allowed by a UE subscription. Therefore, the
initial QoS values used for establishing emergency bearer services are configured in the
HSGW in the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data. If PCC is not deployed, the HSGW
uses the ARP value that is reserved for emergency services, which the HSGW bases on the
usage of the emergency APN.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
74
4.10.5
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
All emergency call flows in this specification, unless otherwise specified, assume the use of
PCC.
11
12
13
14
15
4.10.6
Emergency bearer service is provided by the serving network. The UE and network must have
compatible IP address versions in order for the UE to obtain a local emergency PDN
connection. IP address allocation in the serving network is provided per section 4.4 with the
exception that the P-GW associated with the emergency APN shall support PDN type IPv4
and PDN type IPv6.
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
4.10.7
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
Note: MUPSAP for emergency PDN connections is not supported in this version of this
specification.
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
4.10.8
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
75
The UE shall include Mobile Identity configuration option in the VSNCP Configure
Request message sent to the HSGW, with the type of identity set as follows:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Otherwise, the UE shall send the MEID by setting the Type of identity to
010 (IMEI) per section 10.5.1.4 of TS 24.008 [26].
31
In S2a PMIPv6 signaling, the HSGW shall use the identity obtained in the Mobile
Identity configuration option of the VSNCP-Configure Request message from the
UE.
27
28
29
30
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
76
4.10.8.1
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
UE
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
PCRF
1. PPP:VSNCP Configure-Request
(APN, PDN Address, PDN address allocation, PCO, PDN-ID,
Attach Type, Address Allocation Cause,
IPv4 Default Router Address=empty,
Emergency Indicator=1, Mobile Identity(IMSI) )
3. PPP:VSNCP Configure-Ack
(APN, PDN Address, PCO, PDN-ID, Attach Type,
Address Allocation Cause, IPv4 Default Router Address,
Emergency Indicator=1, Mobile Identity(IMSI) )
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
1.
When the UE wants to establish connectivity to an emergency services PDN, it will send the
VSNCP Configure-Request message (APN, PDN Address, PDN Type, Protocol Configuration
Options, PDN-ID, Attach Type, Address Allocation Cause, IPv4 Default Router Address, and
Emergency Indicator=1, Mobile Identity with type of identity set to IMSI). The APN may be
null. The Address Allocation Preference (contained within the Protocol Configuration Options)
indicates whether the UE wants to perform the IPv4 address allocation during the execution of the
procedure and PDN Type indicates that the UE is capable of supporting IPv4 and IPv6. The
HSGW notes the inclusion of the Emergency Indicator with the value 1. If the UE supports NW
Requested Bearer Control, then the UE includes the MS Support of Network Requested Bearer
Control indicator parameter in the Protocol Configuration Options.
2.
The HSGW triggers the procedures for UE requested PDN connectivity described in TS 23.402
Section 6.2.1-1 Steps 4-10 inclusive (ref. TS 23.402 [25]). The Gateway Control Session is
established only with the PCRF in the serving network, using the emergency QoS values in the
HSGW Emergency Configuration Data. The APN supplied by the HSGW to the P-GW in the
PMIP Binding Update shall be the emergency APN in the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data,
and the APN supplied in the VSNCP Configure-Request may be ignored by the HSGW. This
establishes the bindings at the P-GW and it updates the PCRF with the indication of the
emergency services PDN connection.
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
77
3.
4.
After the HSGW receives the indication of the completion of PMIPv6 procedures, it will send the
VSNCP Configure-Ack (APN=null APN, PDN Address, PCO, PDN-ID, Attach Type, Address
Allocation Cause, and IPv4 Default Router Address, Emergency Indicator=1, Mobile Identity with
type of identity set to IMSI) message to the UE. The Protocol Configuration Options parameter
indicates the Selected Bearer Control Mode only if the UE included the MS Support of Network
Requested Bearer Control indicator (BCM) parameter in the corresponding VSNCP ConfigureRequest message.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID and the Emergency Services Supported
Indicator configuration options. This message contains the APN-AMBR, if the APN-AMBR was
received from the HSS/AAA.
5.
6.
IPv4 address allocation may occur at this point using the procedure shown in section 4.4.6.2 steps
9-12 and section 4.4.6.3, steps 9-16, when the IPv4 address allocation is deferred.
7.
IPv6 address allocation may occur at this point using the procedure shown in section 4.4.6.4 steps
9-11.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
78
1
2
4.10.8.2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
UE
eAN/ePCF
AN AAA
HSGW
PCRF
P-GW
11
12
13
14
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
1. Session Establishment
with Emergency Service
indication
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
3. A11-RRQ (Emergency
Service indication, MEID,
[IMSI]) / RRP
6.
Gateway
Control
Session
Setup
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
OPTIONAL PROCEDURE
14. DHCP
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
79
HSS/
AAA
1.
The UE and the eAN initiate eHRPD session establishment. During this procedure, the eAN
determines that it connects with a UE. The UE indicates via radio level signaling that it is
connecting to access emergency services.
The UE is ready to send data.
3.
The ePCF recognizes that no A10 connection associated with the UE is available, and selects an
HSGW. The ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW to set up the main
A10 connection, and optionally set up the Best Effort (BE) or QoS auxiliary connection. The
A11-Registration Request message contains an indication that the UE is attaching to receive
emergency services. The A11-Registration Request is validated and the HSGW accepts the
connection by returning an A11-Registration Reply message.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
2
3
4
2.
4.
The UE and HSGW perform LCP negotiation. The HSGW, noting that the UE is attaching for
emergency services, chooses to skip EAP-AKA authentication based on operator policy.
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
Note: Authentication may be skipped or, if performed, NCP negotiation may proceed if
authentication fails (to support the various levels of regulatory requirements).
15
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, PDN Type, APN, PDN Address with empty
content, Protocol Configuration Options, Attach Type = Initial Attach, Emergency Indicator=1,
and Mobile Identity with type of identity set to IMEI and containing an MEID value. The
Address Allocation Preference option contained in the Protocol Configuration Options indicates
whether the UE wants to perform the IPv4 address allocation during the attach procedure or
deferred IPv4 address allocation. PDN Type indicates the UEs IP capability (IPv4, IPv6 or
IPv4v6). Additional configuration options (e.g., IPv4 Default Router Address) are included
depending upon the PDN Type. If the UE supports NW Requested Bearer Control, then the UE
includes the option in the Protocol Configuration options parameter set to MS/NW mode. The
APN value, if supplied in the VSNCP Configure-Request, shall be ignored by the HSGW.
18
The HSGW performs the Gateway Control Session Establishment procedure with the PCRF. The
HSGW indicates the possible bearer control modes according to the UE capability provided in
step 5 and its own capability. The HSGW includes the emergency APN and the emergency QoS
values from the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data. The PCRF selects the bearer control
mode to be used.
30
The HSGW sends a Proxy Binding Update to the P-GW in order to establish the connection to the
emergency PDN. The HSGW uses an MEID-based NAI to identify the UE. The HSGW will use
the emergency APN from the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data to choose the P-GW, and the
APN supplied in the VSNCP Configure-Request is ignored by the HSGW.
The P-GW performs a PCRF interaction to establish the IP-CAN session.
TS 23.203 [21].
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW see TS 29.275 [37].
10. In case the QoS rules have changed, the PCRF updates the emergency services QoS rules at the
HSGW by the exchange of Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision/Ack messages, as specified
in TS 23.203 [21].
11. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack (PDN-ID, APN=null APN, PDN Address, PCO,
Attach Type, Address Allocation Cause, Emergency Indicator=1, and Mobile Identity with type of
identity set to IMEI and containing an MEID value) message to the UE over the main service
connection. Note that the PDN Address Information may contain an IPv4 address for IPv4 and/or
an IPv6 Interface Identifier for IPv6. Additional configuration options (e.g., IPv4 Default Router
Address) are included if present in the VSNCP Configure-Request. The Protocol Configuration
Options parameter may be included to indicate the Selected Bearer Control Mode, if the Protocol
Configuration Options parameter was included by the UE in the corresponding VSNCP
Configure-Request and indicated support for NW Requested Bearer Control.
16
17
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
80
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID and the Emergency Services Supported
Indicator configuration options.
13. The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
14. (optional) The UE can now issue a DHCPv4 DISCOVER (optionally with rapid commit option)
message on the BE service connection provided the UE requested deferred IP address allocation in
Step 5.
15. 15a. The UE may send a Router solicitation message.
15b. The HSGW shall send a Router Advertisement message if the P-GW sends the IPv6 prefix to
the HSGW.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
4.10.8.3
21
22
23
24
Note that the UE can be implemented with an internal timer that would eventually cause
clearing of the emergency PDN connection, to guard against the small possibility that the
network initiated detach fails in some way, e.g., through undetected message loss.
25
26
27
28
29
30
4.10.8.4
31
32
33
34
35
36
Note that the UE can be implemented with an internal timer that would eventually cause
clearing of the emergency PDN connection, to guard against the small possibility that the
network initiated detach fails in some way, e.g., through undetected message loss.
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
4.10.8.5
45
46
47
48
49
50
If the UE is authenticated, the HSGW will have an STa/Pi* session to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
If that STa/Pi* session is terminated, the HSGW shall continue to maintain any emergency
PDN connections and emergency bearers that the UE may have. The HSGW may delete nonemergency PDN connections.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
81
4.10.8.5.1
This section describes the message flow for the network initiated UE detach due to PCRF
initiated release procedures. The UE is assumed to be attached only for emergency services.
This call-flow depicts the usage of LCP-Terminate to release the PPP session.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
9
10
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
2. LCP Terminate-Request
18
19
3. LCP Terminate-Ack
20
21
4. P-BU
(Lifetime = 0)
9. Air Interface
Procedures
7. A11RegistrationUpdate
8. A11RegistrationAcknowledge
6. P-BA
22
5. PCEF-initiated
IP-CAN Session
Termination Procedure
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
10. A11Registration
Request
( Lifetime = 0)
33
11. A11Registration
Reply
37
34
35
36
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
The PCRF initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the HSGW. The HSGW
no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE for the emergency PDN and removes all
context for the emergency PDN connection.
45
2.
49
3.
The UE sends an LCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to terminate
the PPP session.
4.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration. The MN NAI identifies the UE to deregister from the P-GW. The APN is
needed in order to determine which PDN to deregister the UE from, as some P-GWs may support
multiple PDNs.
1.
46
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
82
5.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
6.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends a PBA
message (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the HSGW.
7.
The HSGW sends an A11-Registration Update message to initiate with the ePCF the release of all A10
connections for the UE. This step may occur immediately after step 3. The HSGW initiates STa session
termination (Not shown in the figure).
8.
9.
The eAN may initiate HRPD session update. The UE may initiate HRPD session update any time after
step 2.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
10. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request with the lifetime value set to zero to release all A10
connections.
11. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply with lifetime zero.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
83
4.10.8.5.2
1
2
3
4
5
6
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
7
8
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
9
10
11
1. BRI
12
13
2. VSNCP Terminate-Request
(PDN-ID)
14
15
16
3. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
(PDN-ID)
17
18
19
20
21
5. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
23
24
25
6.BRA
7. Air Interface
Procedures
22
26
27
28
8. A11Registration
Request
29
30
31
9. A11Registration
Reply
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
1.
2.
The P-GW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Indication (BRI) message to the HSGW as defined in
RFC 5846 [88] indicating a non-handover cause.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE. The request contains the PDN-ID of the
emergency PDN with which the connection is to be terminated.
3.
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to
terminate a connection to the emergency PDN.
4.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE.
5.
6.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
The HSGW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Acknowledgement (BRA) message to the P-GW as
defined in RFC 5846 [88].
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
84
7.
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated exclusively with
the closed emergency PDN connection. The UE may initiate this session configuration procedure any
time after step 2.
8.
The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to update A10 connections mapping info to the
HSGW.
9.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
If the UE or HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then either entity may initiate LCP
termination procedures.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
85
4.10.9
1
2
This section describes the procedures for creation and deletion of emergency bearers.
4.10.9.1
3
4
The call flow in Figure 30 illustrates UE requested emergency bearer activation procedures.
6
7
8
9
Roaming
Scenario
UE
P-GW1
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
vPCRF
10
11
hPCRF
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
10. Reservation ON
(ReservationLabel)
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
The UE sends a Resv message to the HSGW with OpCode set to QoS-Check. The UE encapsulates
the Resv message over the main service connection using VSNP and includes the PDN-ID to indicate to
which PDN the additional bearer resource is linked. In this case, the PDN-ID indicates the emergency
PDN. The message contains the UE requested FlowProfileIDs. The Transaction ID is dynamically
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
86
allocated by the UE for UE requested bearer resource activation procedure. In the example presented in
the figure, Transaction ID is 1.
1
2
3
4
5
2.
The HSGW maps the received FlowProfileID(s) into a single set of QCI/MBR/GBR parameters.
3.
The HSGW uses Gateway Control and QoS Rules Request/Reply procedures to validate UE requested
QoS with the hPCRF. If the HSGW is deployed in a roaming scenario, the message including
QCI/MBR/GBR(s) and packet filter(s) is sent to the vPCRF which does not further pass it to the
hPCRF, since this refers to an emergency bearer.
4.
The HSGW maps the validated policy rules into appropriate FlowProfileID(s) that are being requested.
5.
The HSGW sends a ResvConf message to the UE with OpCode set to QoS-Check Conf. The Resv
message is an RSVP message transported over the main service connection. The ResvConf message
contains the authorized FlowProfileIDs, which is the same or a subset of the UE requested
FlowProfileIDs in step 1, and the same Transaction ID as in the Resv message sent in step 1. This step
is used as an acknowledgment of the Resv message sent is step 1.
6.
The UE performs the standard HRPD QoS establishment procedures defined in C.S0087 [15] / C.S0063
[13] using the authorized FlowProfileID list from step 5. There are two possible sequences that can
occur at this step. If a new QoS link flow connection is needed to carry the new flow over the air
interface, then the eAN will setup a new air interface link flow. If the eAN decides to carry the flow(s)
on an existing link flow, it then reconfigures the parameters of that link flow.
7.
If a new link flow is needed, a new A10 connection is also established. The eAN sends an A11Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the GRE key, the Requested QoS information,
and Granted QoS information for the flow. The A11 message includes the FLOW_ID. If a new QoS
link flow is not needed, the eAN sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating
the GRE key, FLOW_ID, and the modified Granted QoS information for the existing connection (if
required).
8.
The UE sends a Resv message to the HSGW to associate the selected Reservation with the appropriate
A10 connection and TFT. The message includes the Flow ID and associated packet filters for which the
FlowProfileID(s) are authorized at step 5. This message can be sent in parallel with the start of the
signalling in Step 6. The Transaction ID is different than that used in steps 1 and 5 to avoid having the
HSGW view this message as a repetition of the message in step 1. The HSGW examines the QoS
granted to the UE and compares it to the QoS authorized for the UE in step 5. If there is a discrepancy,
the HSGW applies operator policy.
9.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
10. Since by default the Reservation for the newly created bearer is in the Closed state, the UE (or eAN)
may trigger the transition to the open state.
11. Once the air interface reservation is transitioned to the Open state, the eAN will trigger an A11Registration Request (Active Start) message to initiate the accounting for this bearer connection.
12. If the PCRF has indicated at step 3 that a particular priority (ARP value) is to be applied to this bearer,
then anytime after step 8 the HSGW may use the A11-Session Update procedure to change the
FLOW_PRIORITY of the emergency bearer.
13. Upon a successful negotiation of QoS, the HSGW sends the acknowledgement to the PCRF based on
the QoS that was selected in step 2.
14. The IP CAN Session Modification Procedure may occur as the result of the Gateway Control and QoS
Rules Request message, either to forward an Event Report to the P-GW (PCEF) or to issue revised PCC
Rules and Event Triggers, or both an Event Report and a Rules and Triggers provision. If an indication
that resources have been acquired is not required then this step may occur any time after step 3, above.
55
56
57
58
59
60
87
4.10.9.2
The following diagram illustrates network initiated emergency dedicated resource allocation
operations for eHRPD which are triggered by the PCRF. The procedures shown include
PCRF interactions described in TS 23.402 [25] and eHRPD specific procedures. The bearer
to be established is assumed in this example to be related to the emergency PDN with which
the UE has a current PDN connection.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
On receiving the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provisioning message from the PCRF, the
HSGW decides that a new bearer needs to be activated, the HSGW uses this QoS policy to
assign the bearer QoS, (i.e., it maps PCC QoS parameters to a set of eHRPD FlowProfileIDs).
The HSGW follows this with the procedure shown in Figure 31 by sending an RSVP Resv
message to the UE.
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Roaming
Scenario
17
18
vPCRF
P-GW
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
UE
hPCRF
19
20
21
22
23
24
2. HSGW maps
information provided in
PCC Rules to eHRPD
QoS Profile ID(s)
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
8. Reservation ON
(ReservationLabel)
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
1.
Both the roaming and non-roaming scenarios are depicted in Figure 31 . In the roaming case for an
emergency service, the vPCRF does not act as an intermediary with the hPCRF. Instead, the
vPCRF directly sends the QoS Policy Rules to the HSGW in the vPLMN. The vPCRF receives the
Acknowledgment from the HSGW. In the non-roaming case, the vPCRF is not involved.
51
The PCRF initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Procedure specified in TS 23.203
[21] by sending a message with the QoS rules and Event Trigger information to the HSGW.
56
52
53
54
55
57
58
59
60
88
2.
The HSGW uses the received QoS policy information to determine the bearer level QoS parameters
required for the eHRPD bearer. The HSGW maps these parameters to the appropriate eHRPD
FlowProfileID(s) (see C.R1001 [12]).
3.
The HSGW sends an RSVP Resv message transported over the main service connection. As indicated
in section 9, the RSVP Resv message encapsulation includes the PDN-ID of the PDN for which the
bearer is being created. The RSVP Resv message includes the Uplink/Downlink packet filter, the QoS
list, and a Transaction ID. See section 9.1.6.7.1 for parameter details.
4.
The UE performs the standard QoS establishment procedures defined in C.S0024 [10] and in C.S0063
[13]. There are two possible sequences that can occur at this step. If a new QoS link flow connection is
needed to carry the new flow over the air interface, then the eAN will setup a new air interface link
flow. If the eAN decides to carry the flow(s) on an existing link flow, it then reconfigures the
parameters of that link flow.
5.
If a new link flow is needed, a new A10 connection is also established. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the GRE key, the Requested QoS information,
and the Granted QoS information for the flow. The Granted QoS information includes the FLOW_ID. If
a new QoS link flow is not needed, the eAN sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW
indicating the GRE key, FLOW_ID, and the modified Granted QoS information for the existing
connection (if required).
6.
The UE sends an RSVP Resv message to the HSGW. The message includes the Flow ID for the bearer
connection, and the same DL/UL TFT and Transaction ID received in step 3. This message can be sent
in parallel with the start of the signaling in Step 4. The Transaction ID is used to associate the returned
Flow ID with the new bearer connection. This message is also used as an acknowledgement to the
RSVP Resv message in Step 3. The HSGW examines the QoS granted to the UE and compares it to the
QoS authorized for the UE in step 2. If there is a discrepancy, the HSGW applies operator policy.
7.
The HSGW acknowledges the delivery of the RSVP Resv message it received in Step 6 by sending a
ResvConf message to the UE.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
If the HSGW needs to change the priority of the emergency bearer, it can use the A11-Session
Update message to inform the eAN/ePCF of the new Flow_Priority (not shown in the figure).
31
32
33
34
8.
Since by default the Reservation for the newly created bearer is in the Closed state, the UE (or eAN)
may trigger the transition to the open state.
9.
Once the air interface reservation is transitioned to the Open state, the eAN will trigger an A11Registration Request (Active Start) message to initiate the accounting for this bearer connection.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
10. Any time after Step 6 the HSGW responds to the PCRF indicating its ability to enforce the rules
provisioned to it in Step 1 and thus completing the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Ack
procedure started in step 1.
11. The PCRF initiates the PCC Rules Provision Procedure as specified in TS 23.203 [21]. The PCRF
provides updated PCC rules to the PCEF for enforcement by means of a PCC Rules Provision
procedure specified in TS 23.203 [21].
NOTE: Step 11 may occur before step 2 or may be performed in parallel with steps 1 and 10 if
acknowledgement of resource allocation is not required to update PCC rules in the PCEF. For
details please refer to TS 23.203 [21].
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
89
4.10.9.3
2
4
5
Roaming
Scenario
eAN/ePCF
UE
P-GW1
HSGW
vPCRF
6
7
hPCRF
8
9
10
1. Reservation OFF
(ReservationLabel)
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
6. Reservation Removal
22
8. IP-CAN Session
Modification
Procedures
TS23.203 Clause 7.4.2
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
1.
The UE performs the standard HRPD reservation procedures defined in C.S0087 [15] /
C.S0063 [13] to deactivate the Reservation.
2.
The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW with an Active
Stop indication. The A11 message includes the FLOW_ID. The HSGW responds with an
A11-Registration Reply message.
3.
4.
31
32
33
34
35
36
The UE sends a Resv message to the HSGW with OpCode set to Delete Existing TFT. The
UE encapsulates the Resv message over the main service connection using VSNP and
includes the PDN-ID to indicate to which PDN the bearer resource is linked. The Transaction
ID is dynamically allocated by the UE. In the example presented in the figure, the chosen
Transaction ID is 1. Step 3 may occur at the same time as step 1.
37
The HSGW uses Gateway Control and QoS Rules Request/Reply procedures to notify the
vPCRF that the bearer is being removed. The HSGW deletes the context for the emergency
bearer.
43
38
39
40
41
42
44
45
46
5.
The HSGW sends a ResvConf message to the UE to acknowledge the bearer removal.
6.
7.
The eAN/ePCF and the HSGW remove any unneeded A10 connections.
50
8.
The IP CAN Session Modification Procedure may occur as the result of the Gateway Control
and QoS Rules Request message. This step may occur any time after step 4.
52
47
48
49
51
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
90
1
2
4.10.9.4
3
4
5
6
Network initiated emergency bearer deactivation shall take into account the deactivation of
both dedicated auxiliary service connections and the removal of emergency bearers from a
PDN-ID multiplexed shared service connection. While removing an emergency bearer from a
multiplexed shared service connection, it is necessary to retain the shared service connection
for connectivity to other PDNs. A service connection is removed when the last Reservation
associated with the service connection is removed.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
This call flow assumes the PCRF initiated modification or release of an emergency bearer.
15
16
17
Roaming
Scenario
18
19
20
UE
P-GW1
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
vPCRF
hPCRF
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
3. Flow Configuration
Attribute Update Request
A. Legacy
HRPD
Procedures
33
34
35
36
8. PCC Rules
Provision
Procedure
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
1.
The vPCRF initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Procedure specified in TS
23.203 [21] by sending a message with the QoS rules and Event Trigger information to the
HSGW.
2.
The HSGW sends a Resv message to the UE with OpCode set to Initiate Delete Packet Filter
from Existing TFT indicating the EPS bearer deletion. The message is indexed with the
PDN-ID of the PDN for which the EPS bearer is being deleted.
3.
The UE performs standard HRPD procedures to reconfigure the air interface in order to
remove or modify the requested Reservation(s). If the last Reservation(s) associated with the
link flow is removed, the link flow itself is also removed.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
91
4.
The eAN sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW indicating the removed
Flow ID(s). If the last Flow ID associated with the auxiliary A10 is removed, the auxiliary
A10 itself will also be removed.
1
2
3
The UE sends a Resv message with OpCode set to Delete Packet Filter from Existing TFT
to indicate to the HSGW which flows have been removed. The TFT IE contains the list of
flow identifiers for which filters have been deleted. The Transaction ID carried in this
message shall be the same as the Transaction ID carried in the Resv message in step 2. This
message is also used as an acknowledgement to the RSVP Resv message in Step 2.
6.
The HSGW acknowledges a successful update of the IP flow mapping information by sending
a ResvConf message to the UE.
10
7.
The HSGW indicates to the vPCRF whether the requested QoS Policy Rules Provision could
be enforced or not by sending a Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Acknowledgment
message.
5.
5
6
7
8
9
11
12
13
14
15
The vPCRF initiates the PCC Rules Provision Procedure as specified in TS 23.203. The
vPCRF provides updated PCC rules to the PCEF for enforcement by means of a PCC Rules
Provision procedure specified in TS 23.203 [21].
16
NOTE: Step 8 may occur before step 1 or performed in parallel with steps 1 and 7 if
acknowledgement of resource de-allocation is not required to update PCC rules in the PCEF. For
details please refer to TS 23.203 [21].
20
8.
17
18
19
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
92
4.10.10
3
4
In both optimized and non-optimized handoff, the UE will include the Emergency Indicator
set to 1 in the VSNCP Configure-Request for the emergency PDN connection.
5
6
7
8
9
4.10.10.1
10
11
12
13
14
15
Roaming
16
17
18
UE
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
eAN/
ePCF
eNB
Emergenc
yP-GW
HSGW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP
AAA
Proxy
vPCRF
hPCRF
HSS/
AAA
1. Attached to E-UTRAN for Emergency Services (UE has aquired IPv4 address or IPv6 prefix)
2. Decision
to preregister
with
eHRPD
3. eHRPD Session
Establishment
Optional
4. Device
Authentication (A12)
Emergency
Services is noted by
the HSGW
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
At this point, emergency HRPD context and IP context has been established. If changes are necessary in these contexts,
e.g., steps 9 and/or 10 may be executed to perform context updates.
9. HRPD Session
Maintenance
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
93
1.
The UE is initially attached to the E-UTRAN. The UE acquires an IPv4 address and/or IPv6 prefix
for the emergency PDN. Data flows between the UE and the P-GW through the eNodeB and the
S-GW.
1
2
3
2.
Based on a Radio Layer trigger, the UE decides to initiate a pre-registration procedure with
potential target eHRPD access.
3.
4.
5.
6.
through
the
S101
RAN-level authentication is optional. If used, the UE establishes an AN-PPP connection with the
eAN/ePCF and performs RAN-level authentication using the A12 interface. For details refer to
A.S0022 [4]. If the UE does not have a valid A12 NAI, the UE uses the A12 emergency NAI for
the A12 authentication, see X.S0060 [8]. By sending the challenge to the UE and receiving back
the emergency NAI, the eAN will become aware of the emergency nature of the tunnelled
attachment.
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
The eHRPD eAN/ePCF establishes the main A10 connection with the HSGW by exchanging
A11-Registration Request/Registration Reply messages. The A11-Registration Request message
contains the IMSI/MEID, an indication that the access is occurring through the S101 tunnel, and
an indication that the access is for emergency services. For details refer to A.S0022 [4]. This
information is used by the HSGW in step 7 to defer interaction with the P-GW. The UE and
HSGW initiate the PPP connection establishment procedure.
16
6a-b. The UE may perform user authentication and authorization in the eHRPD access
system
using EAP-AKA if required by local regulation or operator policy and a valid IMSI is present.
The EAP-AKA messages are transferred between the UE and HSGW over PPP. The EAP
authenticator resides in the HSGW. The detailed EAP-AKA authentication flows are specified in
Section 4.2. The 3GPP AAA server authenticates and authorizes the UE for access in the eHRPD
system. The 3GPP AAA server queries the HSS and returns the subscription profile, and APN and
P-GW address pair for each PDN connection to the eHRPD system in this step. The 3GPP AAA
server also returns the NAI to be used to identify the UE in Proxy Binding Update message.
23
Note: Authentication may be skipped or, if performed, NCP negotiation may proceed if
authentication fails (to support the various levels of regulatory requirements).
32
6c. If authentication is performed, the HSGW stores the information received from the 3GPP
AAA/HSS server.
7.
17
18
19
20
21
22
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
33
34
35
36
The UE exchanges VSNCP messages with the HSGW for the emergency PDN connection (see
section 5.4.1 for details). The UE sets the Attach Type to handoff in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest message and includes the Mobile Identity configuration option, and the Emergency
Indicator configuration option with the value 1. The APN supplied in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest may be ignored by the HSGW, since the UE indicates emergency.
37
If the UE has additional PDN connections on the E-UTRAN system that it wishes to also maintain
on the eHRPD system, and if the UE has authenticated at step 6 above, then the UE follows the
normal procedures shown in section 12.1.1 to create each of those PDN connections with the
HSGW.
43
NOTE: The HSGW defers interaction with the P-GW until the UE arrives in eHRPD, at which
time it sends a PBU to the P-GW to complete the PDN connection. For an emergency PDN
connection, the HSGW obtains the address of the P-GW supporting the emergency PDN from the
provisioned HSGW Emergency Configuration Data. For a normal PDN connection, the HSGW
obtains the address of the P-GW via the STa/Pi* interface to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy.
8.
The network initiates resource reservation procedures to establish all dedicated bearers.
9.
It may become necessary to modify the eHRPD radio session configuration between the UE and
the eAN/ePCF. For example, this may be necessary as a result of moving under the coverage area
of a new eAN/ePCF. This is accomplished by eHRPD signalling exchanges between the UE and
the eAN/ePCF via S101 tunneling.
38
39
40
41
42
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
94
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
It is also possible that this procedure began as a normal optimized handoff pre-registration, and the
UE then added the emergency PDN connection later. Adding the emergency PDN connection on
eHRPD would be carried out as part of session maintenance, with the VSNCP Configure-Request
carrying the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1. Subsequently,
the emergency bearers would also be added on eHRPD using tunneled signaling over the S101
interface.
10. If any bearer is added, modified, or deleted while the UE is operating on E-UTRAN, similar
changes shall be made in the context between the UE and the HSGW. This is accomplished by
signaling those changes between the UE and HSGW via S101 tunneling. Likewise, if the UE was
authenticated at step 6, then if any PDN connection is added or deleted while the UE is operating
on E-UTRAN, similar changes are made in the HSGW via the use of VSNCP.
Note: If the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request for a PDN connection for which it
does not have a P-GW identity and if the UE was authenticated at step 6, then it obtains that
information via an AAR/AAA exchange with the HSS/AAA. The exchanges of AAR/AAA
messages are not shown in the figure.
11. If not already initiated, PCRF interactions due to session maintenance can be initiated by the
PCRF or the HSGW. The PCRF initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Procedure
specified in TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Policy Rules
Request Procedure as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
95
4.10.10.2
It is assumed that the UE has pre-registered with eHRPD for emergency services, that the PPP
inactivity timer is still running, and that the HSGW has full context for the UE (except for
PMIP binding).
2
3
4
5
6
7
Roaming
UE
eNB
eAN/ePCF
MME
HSGW
P-GW
S-GW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP AAA
Proxy
vPCRF
hPCRF
HSS/
AAA
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
7a. A11-RRQ
(Active Start)
7b. A11RRP
36
37
38
39
40
8d. S101 HO
complete
Indication/Ack
41
42
43
44
45
9. IP Packets Flowing
9. IP Packets Flowing
9. IP Packets Flowing
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
96
1.
3
4
5
1c. The MME sends the P-GW address(es) and the associated APNs and the uplink GRE key(s)
along with the HRPD Connection Request message to the eHRPD access node over the S101
tunnel.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
NOTE: The GRE keys (one for each APN) sent in step 1c are further sent in step 2a to the HSGW, and
the HSGW uses them for uplink traffic towards the P-GW after the HO. The same keys are in use
between the S-GW and P-GW before the HO. Using the same keys assures that the P-GW can
associate the uplink data to the right UE, if the HSGW decides to send uplink data even before the
PBA message is received in step 8b (note that the P-GW as defined in 23.402 [25] is equipped to
receive data with the same GRE key even before updating the binding).
2.
18
19
20
21
23
25
3.
In response to the HRPD Connection Request message received in step 1c, the eHRPD eAN/ePCF
sends the HRPD Traffic Channel Assignment (TCA) message in an S101 message to the MME.
The S101 message also carries the HSGW IP address, GRE key(s) for data forwarding, and
associated APN(s).
4.
4a. The MME configures resources for indirect data forwarding and signals the HSGW IP address
and GRE key(s) to the S-GW. The S-GW confirms data forwarding resources.
26
27
28
29
30
31
4b. The MME forwards the HRPD TCA message embedded in the S101 message to the EUTRAN which forwards it to the UE over the airlink.
32
33
34
35
5.
E-UTRAN may return downlink IP packets back to the S-GW to be sent to the HSGW over the
S103 interface. The HSGW will perform any necessary processing on the IP packets and forward
them over the appropriate A10 connection to the eAN/ePCF.
6.
36
37
38
39
6b. The UE sends a Traffic Channel Completion (TCC) message to the eHRPD eAN/ePCF.
40
41
42
7.
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
2a. The eHRPD eAN/ePCF allocates the requested radio resources and sends an A11-Registration
Request message to the HSGW. In this message the eAN/ePCF includes the P-GW address(es),
the associated uplink GRE key(s) received in step 1c and the indicator that the UE is
communicating via a tunnel (ref. Tunnel Mode indicator in A.S0022 [4]). This A11-Registration
Request includes an emergency indication.
2b. The HSGW responds with an A11-Registration Reply containing a forwarding address (i.e.,
HSGW IP address, GRE key per APN, and associated APN(s) ).
22
24
1a. E-UTRAN receives CDMA measurement reports from the UE and makes a HO decision.
1b. UE sends an HRPD Connection Request message to the E-UTRAN to request an HRPD traffic
channel. This request is forwarded to the MME. See TS 23.402 [25] for details. This Connection
Request message includes an emergency indication.
7a. The eHRPD eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request carrying an Active Start airlink
record and the indicator that the UE is now operating on the eHRPD radio to the HSGW.
7b. The HSGW responds to the eHRPD eAN/ePCF with an A11-Registration Reply.
8.
8a. Triggered by step 7a, the HSGW/MAG sends a PBU(s) to establish a PMIPv6 tunnel(s) with
the P-GW(s) the UE is associated with.
8b. The P-GW processes the PBU and updates the binding cache entry for the UE. The same IP
address(es) or prefix(es) are assigned to the UE. The P-GW/LMA sends a PBA message to the
HSGW/MAG, including the IP address(es)/prefix(es) allocated for the UE. The PMIPv6 tunnel is
now setup.
8c. The P-GW requires configuration for enforcing policy, the P-GW sends a Modify IP-CAN
session message to the hPCRF. The P-GW has requested an IP-CAN session, the hPCRF responds
to the P-GW with a Modify IP-CAN session Ack message. This message includes the Policy and
Charging rules provisioned into the P-GW.
Note: Steps 8a to 8c are repeated for each PDN connection that is to be established.
59
60
97
8d. The eHRPD eAN/ePCF signals handoff completion to the MME to confirm HO completion,
and receives an acknowledgement.
9.
L3 attach is completed and the UE can now send/receive packets to/from the eHRPD access
network.
10. The E-UTRAN system, including eNodeB, MME, S-GW, and P-GW release resources, including
sending a PMIPv6 BRI message from the P-GW to the S-GW as specified in TS 29.275 [37]. See
also TS 23.402 [25].
11. If the UE had not completed PDN connection and bearer addition/deletion while on E-UTRAN,
the UE completes those activities over the eHRPD radio. If the UE has authenticated during the
pre-registration phase, and if any PDN connection is added or deleted while the UE is operating on
E-UTRAN, similar changes are made in the HSGW via the use of VSNCP.
11a. If the UE has authenticated during the pre-registration phase, and if the HSGW receives a
VSNCP Configure-Request for a PDN connection for which it does not have a P-GW identity, it
obtains that information via an AAR/AAA exchange with the HSS/AAA. If the HSGW already
has the corresponding P-GW IP address, or receives it from the HSS/AAA associated with the
VSNCP Configure-Request message, the HSGW exchanges PBU/PBA messages with the P-GW.
The exchanges of AAR/AAA and PBU/PBA messages are not shown in the figure.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
98
1
2
4.10.10.3
3
4
This procedure is used in the case there is no eHRPD session for the UE in the target eHRPD
system. This scenario assumes that the UE is operating initially on E-UTRAN as an
unauthenticated UE.
5
6
7
8
9
10
UE
eAN/ePCF
SGW
HSGW
PCRF
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSS/
AAA
P-GW
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
1. Attached to E-UTRAN for Emergency Services (UE does not use S101 to pre-register)
2. UE
Decision to
perform
Cell reselection
18
19
4. VSNCP Configure-Request
(PDN-ID, Attach Type = handover,
Emergency Indicator=1, )
20
21
22
5.
Gateway
Control
Session
Setup
23
24
25
26
7. PCRF Interaction
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
OPTIONAL PROCEDURE
36
12. DHCP
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
1.
It is assumed that the UE does not have an existing eHRPD session with the eAN/ePCF (thus, the
HSGW has no saved context for the UE). It is also assumed that the UE is operating initially on EUTRAN as an unauthenticated UE.The UE does not use S101 to pre-register with eHRPD. When
the UE attaches to eHRPD, it needs to go through full eHRPD session establishment and establish
complete emergency context with the HSGW.
2.
The UE is in E-UTRAN. Based on some trigger, the UE decides to perform cell re-selection to the
eHRPD eAN. Note: the cell re-selection decision can be made at any time when the UE is attached
in the E-UTRAN network. The eNB may be involved in redirecting the UE to eHRPD.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
99
3.
The UE follows the steps 1 to 4 from the call flow in section 4.10.8.2 to establish an eHRPD
session and a PPP session with the HSGW.
1
2
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, PDN Type, APN, PDN Address, Protocol
Configuration Options, Attach Type = Handover Attach, and Emergency Indicator=1. The APN
supplied in the VSNCP Configure-Request may be ignored by the HSGW, since the UE indicates
emergency.
5.
The HSGW performs the Gateway Control Session Establishment procedure with the PCRF (see
TS 23.203 [21]). As part of this step, the PCRF sends the QoS rules and events to the HSGW.
6.
The HSGW sends a Proxy Binding Update (using the UE identity as described in section 4.10.8)
to the P-GW identified in the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data in order to update the
registration see TS 29.275 [37].
4.
4
5
6
7
8
10
11
12
13
14
7.
The P-GW performs a PCRF interaction to retrieve the QoS policy parameters.
15
8.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW see TS 29.275 [37].
17
9.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack (PDN-ID, APN, PDN Address, PCO, Attach Type,
Mobile Identity configuration option, and and Emergency Indicator=1) message to the UE over
the main service connection. The PCO parameter may indicate the Selected Bearer Control Mode.
NOTE: If dynamic policy is not supported, the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS-only.
10. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID, Emergency Services Supported Indicator=1,
and the IPv4 Default Router Address if an IPv4 address is to be assigned either immediately or
deferred.
11. The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
12. (optional) The UE can now issue a DHCPv4 Request (optionally with rapid commit option)
message on the BE service connection provided the UE requested deferred IP address allocation in
Step 8.
13. 13a. The UE may send a Router solicitation message.
13b. The HSGW shall send a Router Advertisement message if the P-GW sends the IPv6 prefix to
the HSGW.
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
14. Bearers for the emergency PDN connection are re-established on eHRPD based on the Selected
Bearer Control Mode:
40
39
41
a.) If the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS-only, the HSGW assumes that the UE will
establish all bearers. The UE performs UE requested bearer resource allocation section 4.10.9.1
for all bearers.
42
b.) If the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS/NW, the HSGW establishes all bearers. The
HSGW performs network initiated dedicated bearer setup section 4.10.9.2 for all bearers.
46
43
44
45
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
100
1
2
3
4.11
Header Compression
The UE and HSGW may perform header compression using the protocol types specified using
the Compression Parameter configuration option (see section 9.1.4.1). The header
compression for service connections using SO72 is not supported in this version of the
specification. The UE shall not initiate either RAN based or HSGW based header
compression when service option SO72 is used. The HSGW shall not initiate HSGW based
header compression when service option SO72 is used.
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
The header compression protocol types are negotiated independently for forward link and
reverse link. The header compression protocol negotiated via the VSNCP protocol may be
used on the main service connection (SO59), and on any auxiliary service connection using
SO64, when data from that PDN connection is placed on those service connections using the
VSNP extend code capability.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
The header compression for service connections using SO67 is performed according to the
procedures of A.S0008 [1] / A.S0009 [2]. Such compression is independent of the header
compression negotiation done via the VSNCP protocol.
19
20
21
22
The VSNP Extend Code (see section 9.1.5) shall be used when a header compression protocol
is used over SO59 or SO64.
23
24
25
26
27
28
4.11.1
ROHC Support
If the UE and the HSGW support ROHC, the UE and HSGW shall support the RoHC Profile
0x0000 (uncompressed profile) on both forward and reverse links. The UE and HSGW may
support other RoHC profiles as specified in RFC 3095 [60], RFC 3843 [70], RFC 4019 [73],
RFC 4815 [77], RFC 4996 [79], and RFC 5225 [81] independently on the forward and reverse
link. If multiple ROHC profile identifiers corresponding to the same profile type (for
example, RTP profile) are supported by both UE and HSGW, the profile corresponding to the
highest value supported by both UE and HSGW shall be used.
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
4.12
59
60
101
1
2
4.12.1
3
4
The following call flow describes the steps that are performed to establish a UE partial
context. This call flow depicts the steps performed when the UE is directly attached to
eHRPD.
5
6
7
8
9
10
Roaming
eNB
UE
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
HSGW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP
AAA
Proxy
11
vPCRF
hPCRF
HSS/
AAA
12
13
14
1. Decision
to establish
partial
context over
eHRPD
15
16
17
18
19
2. eHRPD Session
Establishment
20
21
3. Device
Authentication (A12)
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
1.
2.
The UE establishes an eHRPD air interface session with the eAN over the eHRPD air interface.
3.
4.
The eHRPD eAN/ePCF establishes the main A10 connection with the HSGW by exchanging A11RRQ/RRP messages. The HSGW initiates LCP and the UE and HSGW perform PPP connection
establishment procedures.
5.
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
5c. The HSGW stores the information received from the 3GPP AAA/HSS server.
49
5d. The UE does not initiate PDN connection establishment. The UE and HSGW maintain the UE
partial context and the HSGW starts a timer.
51
50
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
102
1
2
4.13
3
4
5
6
The UE indicates its ability to handle an error code of APN congested and the APN Backoff Timer configuration option by including the Access Priority configuration option on the
VSNCP Configure-Request message. The Access Priority configuration option may indicate
low access priority.
7
8
9
10
11
When the HSGW detects or is notified that an APN is congested and the UE has included the
Access Priority configuration option on the VSNCP Configure-Request message, the HSGW
may reject a PDN connection to that APN by including the APN Congested error code and the
APN Back-off Timer configuration option on the VSNCP Configure-Reject message. See
sections 9.1.4.1 and 9.1.4.5. If there are multiple P-GWs available to support the requested
APN, the HSGW may attempt to create the PDN connection with another P-GW if another
PDN connection for the same APN does not already exist for the UE, when it is notified by a
P-GW that the APN is congested. After all such P-GWs have been attempted, according to
operator policy, the HSGW may reject the PDN connection as noted above.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
The HSGW may use internal congestion information, congestion information sent to it from
other core network entities, subscription information, and operator policy in deciding whether
to require the UE to wait for the back-off time to expire.
22
23
24
25
The HSGW may store a back-off time when congestion control is active for an APN. The
HSGW may immediately reject any subsequent request from the UE for a PDN connection to
the APN before the stored back-off time has expired.
26
27
28
29
NOTE: The above functionality is to diminish the performance advantage for UEs built
to earlier versions of this specification that do not support the back-off timer compared to
UEs that do support it.
30
31
32
33
The UE shall support a separate back-off timer instance for every APN that the UE is notified
is congested.
34
35
36
NOTE: The APN congestion control specified in this section relates to APN based
Session Management congestion control as described in TS 23.401 section 4.3.7.4.2.2
[24]. APN based Mobility Management congestion control as described in TS 23.401
section 4.3.7.4.2.3 [24] is not applicable to eHRPD, since by design, the HSGW is not
generally aware of UE mobility.
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
4.14
58
59
60
103
fact that the UE may simultaneously have other PDN connections across a different access
network is transparent to the eHRPD access network.
The UE follows the ANDSF procedures defined in 3GPP TS 23.402 [25], section 4.8.2.1.
1
2
3
4
5
4.15
This section describes support provided for 3GPP2 SIPTO (Selected IP Traffic Offload).
8
9
The 3GPP2 SIPTO function enables an operator to offload certain types of traffic at a network
node close to that UE's point of attachment to the access network.
10
13
In order for the operator to allow/prohibit 3GPP2 SIPTO on per user and per APN basis,
subscription data in the HSS is configured to indicate to the HSGW if offload is allowed or
prohibited. The 3GPP2 SIPTO allowed/prohibited information is indicated to the HSGW by
the SIPTO-Permission AVP specified in TS 29.272 [35]. If the 3GPP2 SIPTO
allowed/prohibited information from the HSS conflicts with HSGWs configuration for that
UE, then 3GPP2 SIPTO is not used.
17
If the HSS indicates VPLMN address not allowed, then the VPLMN (i.e. HSGW) shall not
provide SIPTO.
24
In the absence of any SIPTO allowed/prohibited indication from the HSS the HSGW shall not
provide SIPTO.
The HSGW may be configured as to whether or not to use 3GPP2 SIPTO on a per APN basis.
If the UE supports the VSNCP Terminate-Request message with the Reconnection Indication
configuration option value set to Reconnection to this APN requested, then the UE shall
include the SIPTO Support Configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Request message
with the value set to 1.
11
12
14
15
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
As a result of UE mobility (e.g. due to inter-HSGW handoff with context transfer), the
serving HSGW may redirect a PDN connection towards a different P-GW that is
geographically/topologically close to the HSGW. When the HSGW decides upon the need for
P-GW relocation, and if the SIPTO Support Configuration option is set to 1, then the
HSGW deactivates the impacted PDN connection using a VSNCP Terminate-Request
message with the Reconnection Indication configuration option value set to Reconnection to
this APN requested.
36
NOTE: If the above procedures for P-GW relocation are initiated while the UE has active
applications, it may cause disruption of services that are affected if the IP address
changes.
44
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
45
46
47
48
4.16
49
50
3GPP2 IFOM (IP flow mobility) is supported in this release of this specification.
3GPP2 IFOM provides a mechanism for a UE to simultaneously connect to eHRPD and
WLAN and exchange different IP flows belonging to the same PDN connection through
different accesses. The mechanism also enables seamless IP flow mobility, with IP flows
belonging to the same or different applications being moved seamlessly between eHRPD
access and WLAN. The solution allows the operator to indicate how the IP flows are routed
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
104
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
through the available access systems and to selectively offload some traffic (e.g., best effort
traffic) to WLAN while using eHRPD for other traffic (e.g., traffic with specific QoS
requirements). This is usually referred to as WLAN offload. The technical solution is based
on DSMIPv6 (see RFC5555 [83]), multiple CoA binding for DSMIPv6 (see RFC5648 [84]),
and FID option (see RFC 6089 [90]). Since the solution is based on DSMIPv6, IP address
preservation and session continuity is provided when moving IP flows from one access to the
other. The UE and P-GW follows the procedures defined in 3GPP 23.402 [25] and TS 23.261
[23].
When the UE camps on eHRPD access network, in this specification the UE is considered to
be on its home link. UE shall follow the Home link detection procedures as specified in
TS23.402 [25].
In eHRPD, the eAN/ePCF and HSGW are unaware that 3GPP2 IFOM is being used by the
UE. The UE will authenticate on eHRPD and create one or more PDN connections. The fact
that the UE may simultaneously exchange different IP flows belonging to the same PDN
connection through different accesses is transparent to the eHRPD access network.
The UE follows the ANDSF procedures defined in 3GPP TS 23.402 [25], section 4.8.2.1.
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
105
1
2
3
4
5
5.1
Protocol Definition
The HSGW to P-GW interface carries control and bearer traffic between the two network
elements. This interface is based on the 3GPP S2a reference point defined in TS 23.402 [25].
8
9
10
11
5.2
12
HSGW Requirements
13
The HSGW shall act as the Mobile Access Gateway (MAG) as specified in RFC 5213 [80]
and in RFC 5844 [86]. The HSGW shall support Binding Revocation for IPv6 Mobility as
defined in RFC 5846 [88] and GRE Key option for Proxy MIPv6 as RFC 5845 [87].
14
15
16
17
18
The HSGW shall use the NAI received from 3GPP AAA in the Permanent User Identity IE
(Mobile-Node-Identifier AVP) upon successful authentication and authorization to populate
the Mobile Node Identifier option in the PBU.
19
20
21
22
23
5.2.1
PMIPv6 Triggers
24
25
5.2.1.1
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
After the HSGW has determined that the UE is operating on the eHRPD radio, the HSGW
triggers PMIPv6 registration as described below.
-
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request from the UE that requests
PDN connection establishment and the attach type is Initial Attach and the VSNCP
Configure-Request does not include the Emergency Indicator configuration option or
includes the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 0, the
HSGW shall perform P-GW selection as per TS 23.402 [25] and then it shall trigger
PMIPv6 registration for the corresponding PDN.
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request from the UE that requests
PDN connection establishment and the attach type is Initial Attach and the VSNCP
Configure-Request includes the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the
value set to 1, the HSGW shall select the emergency P-GW indicated in the HSGW
Emergency Configuration Data (see section 4.10.1), and then it shall trigger PMIPv6
registration for the emergency PDN.
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request from the UE that requests
PDN connection establishment and the attach type is handover attach and the VSNCP
Configure-Request does not include the Emergency Indicator configuration option or
includes the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 0, the
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
106
HSGW shall select the P-GW for the PDN connection indicated by the current HSS
data (ref. TS 29.273 [36]) and then it shall trigger PMIPv6 registration for the
corresponding PDN.
1
2
3
4
5
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request from the UE that requests
PDN connection establishment and the attach type is handover attach and the
VSNCP Configure-Request includes the Emergency Indicator configuration option
with the value set to 1, the HSGW shall select the emergency P-GW indicated in the
HSGW Emergency Configuration Data (see section 4.10.1), and then it shall trigger
PMIPv6 registration for the emergency PDN.
When the HSGW receives an A11-Registration Request message with an Active Start
airlink record for the UE that has one or more PDN contexts established in the HSGW,
the HSGW shall trigger PMIPv6 registration for each PDN context setup that was
requested by the UE and indicated by the current HSS data as being a current PDN
connection if the PMIPv6 registration does not exist (ref. TS 29.273 [36]).
When the HSGW receives a Hack message with context information TLVs as defined
in Section 11.3.2, the HSGW shall trigger PMIPv6 registration for each PDN
connection that was connected to the source HSGW as indicated in the context
information.
The HSGW shall trigger PMIPv6 re-registration for PDN connection(s) as needed to
prolong the lifetime of existing PMIPv6 session(s).
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
When receiving a PMIPv6 registration rejection from the P-GW with an error code indicating
APN congestion and a "PDN-GW back-off time", the HSGW shall attempt PMIPv6
registration for that PDN connection with any other available P-GWs that support the
requested APN, if another PDN connection for the same APN does not already exist for the
UE. If all attempts to create the PDN connection fail and at least one P-GW has indicated
APN congestion, the HSGW shall do the following:
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
Remember the APN that is congested and the associated back-off time for the UE.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
5.2.1.2
When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Termination Request from the UE that requests
PDN connection teardown, the HSGW shall perform PMIPv6 de-registration for the
corresponding PDN.
When the HSGW receives an indication from the PCRF requesting termination of a
PDN connection, the HSGW shall perform PMIPv6 de-registration for the
corresponding PDN.
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
107
When the HSGW receives a BRI from the P-GW with the revocation trigger set to a
non-handover value, the HSGW shall send VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE. See
section 0.
When the main service connection is removed, the HSGW shall trigger PMIPv6 deregistration from all connected PDNs.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
5.2.2
When the HSGW receives an LCP Terminate-Request from the UE, the HSGW shall
trigger PMIPv6 de-registration from all connected PDNs.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
5.2.3
17
18
Upon receiving a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Indication (BRI) message from the P-GW with
revocation trigger = Inter-MAG Handoff - same Access Types (i.e., inter-HSGW handoff),
the HSGW shall clear all UE session context (including LCP, CCP, Authentication, PDN
context, and TFTs). If the HSGW supports inter-HSGW context transfer, the HSGW shall
defer the UE session context clean up until inter-HSGW handoff is complete (see section
11.1.1). The HSGW responds to the BRI from the P-GW by sending a Binding Revocation
Acknowledgement (BRA).
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
When the HSGW receives PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Indication (BRI) from the P-GW
with revocation trigger = Inter-MAG Handoff - different Access Types (i.e., intertechnology handoff), the HSGW shall delete the PDN context and TFTs associated with the
UE for that PDN connection, and then follow the procedures in section 9.1.8. However, in
this release, the HSGW shall delete all PDN contexts and TFTs associated with the UE and
then follow procedures in section 9.1.7.
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
5.3
36
P-GW Requirements
37
38
39
40
5.4
41
42
43
Call Flows
44
45
46
5.4.1
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
108
UE
eAN/ePCF
AN AAA
HSGW
PCRF
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
P-GW
2
3
4
5
6
1. Session Establishment
2. UE is ready to send data.
7
8
A12 AccessResponse
10
11
12
13
A12 AccessRequest
OPTIONAL
PROCEDURE
Establish flow 0xFF on the
Main A10 as SO59.
Optionally establish flow
0xFE on a PDN-Mux
auxiliary A10 as SO72.
14
5. A11-RRQ/RRP
15
16
17
18
19
20
7. EAP-AKA Authentication
21
22
23
24
25
7. EAP-AKA Authentication
26
27
28
30
31
32
13.14.
PMIP Binding Ack
Gateway
Control and
QoS Rules
Provision/
Ack
33
34
36
37
9. Gateway
Control
Session
Setup
10. PMIP Binding Update
29
35
OPTIONAL
PROCEDURE
12. Update
PDN GW address
38
39
40
OPTIONAL PROCEDURE
41
42
18. DHCP
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
109
HSS/
AAA
1.
The UE and the eAN initiate eHRPD session establishment. During this procedure, the eAN
determines that it connects with a UE.
1
2
3
2.
3.
4.
5.
The ePCF recognizes that no A10 connection associated with the UE is available, and selects
an HSGW. The ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW to set up the
main A10 connection, and optionally set up the Best Effort (BE) auxiliary connection. The
A11-Registration Request is validated and the HSGW accepts the connection by returning an
A11-Registration Reply message.
6.
7.
The UE and HSGW perform LCP negotiation and select EAP-AKA as the authentication
protocol.
The authentication procedures are initiated and performed involving the UE, the HSGW, the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy and the 3GPP AAA Server. In the roaming case, there may be several
AAA proxies involved. The P-GW address is determined at this point. The AAA/HSS sends
subscription data to the HSGW. The Subscription Data contains the list of all APNs that the
UE is permitted to access and an indication about which of those APNs is the Default APN.
The subscription data also contains the NAI to be used to identify the UE in Proxy Binding
Update and Gateway Control Session Establishment messages. This information is cached at
the HSGW on behalf of the attaching UE. If the subscriber profile did not include an absolute
P-GW address a DNS look up may be performed to determine the P-GW address. The
subscription data may contain the SIPTO allowed/prohibited information. If SIPTO is
allowed, the HSGW may use 3GPP2 SIPTO as described in section 4.15. At the end of this
step, the Authentication phase is complete. Also, the HSGW has received the subscription
profile of the UE from the HSS/AAA.
7a. The HSGW may send an A11-Session Update message to the eAN/ePCF to provide the
PMK, if the ePCF set the PMK Indicator to '1' in the A11-Registration Request in step 5.
7b. The eAN/ePCF responds with an A11-Session Update Acknowledge message.
8.
9.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, PDN Type, APN, PDN Address with empty
content, Protocol Configuration Options, and Attach Type = Initial Attach. If the UE wants
to establish a MUPSAP connection to the APN and has not yet been informed that the HSGW
does not support MUPSAP for this APN, the User Context Identifier configuration option is
also included in the VSNCP Configure-Request message. The Address Allocation Preference
option contained in the Protocol Configuration Options indicates whether the UE wants to
perform the IPv4 address allocation during the attach procedure or deferred IPv4 address
allocation. PDN Type indicates the UEs IP capability (IPv4, IPv6 or IPv4v6). Additional
configuration options (e.g., IPv4 Default Router Address) are included depending upon the
PDN Type. If the UE supports NW Requested Bearer Control, then the UE includes the
option in the Protocol Configuration options parameter set to MS/NW mode.
The HSGW may perform Gateway Control Session Establishment procedure with the PCRF.
If performed, the HSGW indicates the possible bearer control modes according to the UE
capability provided in step 8 and its own capability. The PCRF selects the bearer control
mode to be used.
10. The HSGW sends a Proxy Binding Update to the P-GW in order to establish the new
registration see TS 29.275 [37]. The HSGW uses the NAI received in step 7 to identify the
UE. If the VSNCP message in step 8 does not identify a requested APN, the HSGW will use
the default APN acquired from HSS/AAA during Authentication and Authorization
procedures to choose the P-GW. If the VSNCP message in step 8 identifies a requested APN
that is authorized to the user, the HSGW will use that APN to choose the P-GW. If the HSGW
4
5
7
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
110
supports MUPSAP and if the HSGW has received the User Context Identifier configuration
option in the VSNCP Configure-Request message in step 8, the HSGW includes the PDN
Connection ID information element in the Proxy Binding Update message.
1
2
3
4
11. The P-GW performs a PCRF interaction to establish the IP-CAN session. For details, see
TS 23.203 [21].
5
6
12. The selected P-GW informs the 3GPP AAA Server of its PDN GW identity and the APN
corresponding to the UE's PDN Connection.
7
8
9
13. The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW see TS 29.275 [37]. If the P-GW
supports MUPSAP and if the PDN Connection ID information element is included in the
Proxy Binding Update message, it includes PDN Connection ID information element received
in the Proxy Binding Update message.
10
11
12
13
14
14. In case the QoS rules have changed, the PCRF updates the QoS rules at the HSGW by the
exchange of Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision/Ack messages, as specified in TS
23.203 [21].
15
16
17
15. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack (PDN-ID, APN, PDN Address, PCO, Attach
Type, and Address Allocation Cause) message to the UE over the main service connection. If
the PBA message from the P-GW includes the PDN Connection ID information element, the
HSGW includes the corresponding User Context Identifier configuration option in the
VSNCP Configuration-Ack message. Note that the PDN Address Information may contain an
IPv4 address for IPv4 and/or an IPv6 Interface Identifier for IPv6. Additional configuration
options (e.g., IPv4 Default Router Address) are included if present in the Configure-Request.
The Protocol Configuration Options parameter may be included to indicate the Selected
Bearer Control Mode, if the Protocol Configuration Options parameter was included by the
UE in the corresponding VSNCP Configure-Request and indicated support for NW Requested
Bearer Control.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
16. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID configuration option. The message
includes the User Context Identifier configuration also if such configuration option has been
accepted by the HSGW. This message contains the APN-AMBR if received from the
HSS/AAA.
30
31
32
33
34
35
17. The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message. The UE includes APN-AMBR, if it
received APN-AMBR in step 16 and if the UE supports APN-AMBR.
36
37
38
18. (optional) The UE can now issue a DHCPv4 DISCOVER (optionally with rapid commit
option) message on the BE service connection provided the UE requested deferred IP address
allocation in Step 8.
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
Based on information stored at the UE or obtained from the network, the UE can start creating the
required auxiliary connections (needed for the bearer transport) for a particular QoS flow per
PDN. See section 9.3.
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
5.4.2
56
57
58
59
60
111
5.4.3
1
2
3
4
5.4.4
5.4.5
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
112
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
6.1
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
In this version of this specification, the PiLTE Interworking Diameter Application has been
replaced by the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application.
Both the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Servers are required to support the STa
Diameter Application and thus shall advertise support for the STa Diameter Application
during the Diameter Capability Exchange procedure. The peers shall include the VendorSpecific-Application-Id (VSA) in the Diameter Capability Exchange Request with the
Vendor-Id attribute set to the SMI Network Management Private Enterprise Codes assigned to
3GPP (10415) and the Auth-Application-Id set to the STa Diameter Application ID of
16777250 as assigned by IANA.
An HSGW that supports the HSGW relocation procedures or the Subscriber QoS Profile
Configuration Procedure may additionally advertise support for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter
Application during the Diameter Capability Exchange procedure.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
A 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server that supports HSGW relocation procedures or the Subscriber
QoS Profile Configuration Procedure may additionally advertise support for the Pi*3GPP2
Diameter Application during the Diameter Capability Exchange procedure.
The peers shall include the Vendor-Specific-Application-Id VSA in the Diameter Capability
Exchange Request with the Vendor-Id attribute set to the SMI Network Management Private
Enterprise Codes assigned to 3GPP2 (5535) and the Auth-Application-Id set to the assigned
by IANA:
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
In case the STa Diameter Application is used, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy shall proxy the
messages between the HSGW and the 3GPP AAA server.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
113
6.2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy shall remove all attributes that are not supported by the 3GPP AAA
STa Diameter Application before forwarding any 3GPP AAA STa commands to the 3GPP
AAA Server. Specifically:
If received by the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy shall remove the
Supported-Features AVP with Vendor-ID AVP set to the 3GPP2 SMI Network
Management Private Enterprise Codes assigned to 3GPP2 (5535).
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Upon receiving 3GPP AAA STa Diameter Application commands, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy
may modify the commands to align them with Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application.
22
23
24
25
6.3
26
27
The Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application extends the STa Diameter Application by introducing
the following commands (request/answer pairs) and AVPs required to support the interHSGW handoff procedure and Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration Procedure defined in
this specification. The following table lists the commands and associated command codes:
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
8388626
8388627
8388630
35
36
37
38
39
The Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application reuses the remaining commands and AVPs of the 3GPP
AAA STa Diameter Application as defined in this specification and in TS 29.273 [36].
40
41
42
43
44
45
The Update Location Request/Answer (ULR/ULA) and the Query Profile Request/Answer
(QPR/QPA) command pair are implemented by using a set of features, with each feature
being specified by the use of Supported-Features AVP. Unique settings of the Feature-List-ID
and Feature-List sub AVP pair are used to indicate support for a specific feature, with each bit
in the Feature-List sub AVP being independent of the others. All command pairs are specified
in the ABNF format. The following features are specified for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter
Application:
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
114
1
2
3
4
Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application is defined between the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server as the peer entities. An operator may choose to extend Pi*3GPP2 Diameter
Application between the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy in the home domain. In the latter
case, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall act as a proxy agent as specified in RFC3588 [65].
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
The Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application utilizes the Supported-Features AVP in QPR/QPA and
ULR/ULA request/answer pairs as follows:
The Vendor-Id sub AVP shall be set to the 3GPP2 SMI Network Management
Private Enterprise Code assigned to 3GPP2 (5535).
13
14
15
16
17
The Feature-List sub AVP shall have the bits set as specified in Table 2 below:
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
115
Table 2
Feature
bit
Feature
M/O
SubQoSConfig
Description
Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration Procedure.
This feature allows the configuration of Subscriber QoS Profile in the
eHRPD system. The Subscriber QoS Profile is obtained from the 3GPP2
AAA Proxy/Server in the home domain.
If both the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server support the
Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application, the HSGW initiates obtaining Subscriber
QoS Profile information from the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server in the home
domain by sending the Query Profile Request (QPR) command. If the
HSGW does not already know if the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server supports
the SubQoSConfig feature, the HSGW includes the Supported-Features
AVP in the QPR command with Feature-List sub AVP bit 0 set to 1
indicating support for SubQoSConfig feature. The 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server responds with Query Profile Answer (QPA) command that
includes the complete set of features supported by it in the SupportedFeatures AVP. If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server supports the Subscriber
QoS Profile Configuration procedure and has the Subscriber QoS Profile
available, on successful processing of the QPR command, the 3GPP2
AAA Proxy/Server returns the Subscriber QoS Profile information also in
the QPA command with the DIAMETER_SUCCESS result code.
HSGWReloc
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
This feature allows the HSGW to update ATs location information at the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server. The procedure is invoked by the HSGW and is
used to inform the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server about the identity of the
HSGW currently serving the user.
28
If both the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server support the
Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application, the HSGW initiates HSGW Relocation
procedure by sending the Update Location Request (ULR) command. If
the HSGW does not already know if the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server
supports the HSGWReloc feature, the HSGW includes the SupportedFeatures AVP in the ULR command with Feature-List sub AVP bit 1 set
to 1 indicating support for HSGWReloc feature. The 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server responds with Update Locaion Answer (ULA) command that
includes the complete set of features supported by it in the SupportedFeatures AVP. If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server supports the HSGW
Relocation procedure, on successful processing of the ULR command it
updates the identity of the HSGW currently serving the AT. The 3GPP2
AAA Proxy/Server then initiates Cancel Locaion Request/Answer
(CLR/CLA) procedures with the previously serving HSGW and returns
Update Location Answer (ULA) command to the serving HSGW.
2-31
Reserved
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Feature bit: The number of the bit within the Supported-Features AVP, set to "1" if the corresponding feature
is supported.
Feature: A short name that can be used to refer to the bit and to the feature.
M/O: Defines if the implementation of the feature is mandatory ("M") or optional ("O") by the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server.
Description: A textual description of the feature.
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
116
6.3.1
3
4
5
6
6.3.1.1
7
8
9
10
Message Format
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
6.3.1.2
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
< -Update Location Answer> ::=< Diameter Header: 8388626, PXY, 16777298 >
< Session-Id >
{Auth-Application-Id}
[ Result-Code ]
[ Experimental-Result ]
{ Auth-Session-State }
{ Origin-Host }
{ Origin-Realm }
* [ Supported-Features ]
* [ AVP ]
* [ Failed-AVP ]
* [ Proxy-Info ]
* [ Route-Record ]
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
117
6.3.1.3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Message Format
< Cancel Location Request> ::= < Diameter Header: 8388627, REQ, PXY,
16777298 >
< Session-Id >
{ Auth-Application-Id }
{ Origin-Host }
{ Origin-Realm }
{ Destination-Host }
{ Destination-Realm }
{ User-Name }
{ 3GPP2-Cancellation-Type }
* [ AVP ]
* [ Proxy-Info ]
* [ Route-Record ]
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
6.3.1.4
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
< Cancel Location Answer> ::= < Diameter Header: 8388627, PXY, 16777298 >
< Session-Id >
{ Auth-Application-Id }
[ Result-Code ]
[ Experimental-Result ]
{ Origin-Host }
{ Origin-Realm }
* [ AVP ]
* [ Failed-AVP ]
* [ Proxy-Info ]
* [ Route-Record ]
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
118
6.3.1.5
3
4
5
3GPP2-Cancellation-Type
5535/56
7
8
9
10
11
6.3.1.5.1
3GPP2-Cancellation-Type
The 3GPP2-Cancellation-Type AVP is of type Enumerated and indicates the type of
cancellation. The following values are defined:
12
13
14
15
16
17
This value is used when the Cancel Location Request is sent to the source HSGW due to a
received Update Location Request message from the target HSGW.
18
19
20
21
22
6.3.2
The following commands are used for the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration procedure.
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
6.3.2.1
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Message Format
< Query Profile Request> ::= < Diameter Header:
8388630, REQ, PXY, 16777298>
< Session-Id >
{Vendor-Specific-Application-Id}
{Auth-Session-State}
{Origin-Host}
{Origin-Realm}
{Destination-Host}
{Destination-Realm}
{User-Name}
*[Supported-Features]
* [AVP]
* [Proxy-Info]
* [Route-Record]
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
119
6.3.2.2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Message Format
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
120
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
7.1
Protocol Definition
The HSGW to PCRF interface exchanges policy information between the two network
elements. This interface is based on the 3GPP Gxa reference point defined in TS 23.402 [25].
10
11
12
The Gxa interface is based on an evolution of the Gx application specified in 3GPP 29.212
[31].
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
7.2
Stage 2 Flows
The protocol supported on the Gxa interface shall be Diameter. The Stage 2 procedures are
specified in TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW shall implement the following procedures from TS
23.203 [21]:
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
121
7.2.1
The HSGW and P-GW access the PCRF to obtain the policy rules associated with the
subscriber. The sample call flow diagram illustrates the procedure for obtaining policy rules
when the UE powers-on in an eHRPD access and attaches to the EPS via the S2a interface.
This procedure is based on similar procedure described in TS 23.402 [25].
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Roaming
Scenario
UE
eAN/ PCF
PDN
GW
HSGW
HSS/
AAA
vPCRF
hPCRF
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
PMIP 6Tunnel
PMIPv
Tunnel
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
The operational interaction steps between the gateways and the PCRF in the procedure in Figure
39 only occur if dynamic policy provisioning is deployed. Otherwise policy rules may be
statically configured with the gateways.
33
34
35
36
37
1.
The S2a attach procedure per section 5.4.1, steps 1-8 is executed.
2.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Establishment Procedure with the hPCRF,
as specified in TS 23.203 [21] by sending a Gateway Control Session Establishment message
to the hPCRF. The HSGW provides the information to the hPCRF to correctly associate it
with the IP-CAN session being established and also to convey subscription related parameters
to the hPCRF. The HSGW also indicates the possible bearer control modes to the hPCRF
according to the UE capability and its own capability. See TS 23.203 [21] for details on the
parameters sent with this message.
39
The hPCRF sends an Acknowledge Gateway Control Session Establishment to the HSGW.
The hPCRF may include the following information: QoS Rules, Event Triggers, and selected
bearer control mode. The QoS policy rules are employed by the HSGW to perform Bearer
Binding. The Event Triggers indicate events that require the HSGW to report to the hPCRF.
See TS 23.203 [21] for more details.
47
3.
4.
The S2a attach procedure per section 5.4.1, steps 10-13 is executed.
5.
In case the QoS rules have changed, the hPCRF updates the QoS rules at the HSGW by
sending a Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision message to the HSGW. This message
will include QoS Rules and Event Triggers. See TS 23.203 [21] for more details.
38
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
122
6.
The HSGW sends a Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Ack (Result) message to the
hPCRF. The Result information element indicates whether the indicated QoS Rules could be
implemented.
7.
The S2a attach procedure per section 5.4.1, steps 15-20 is executed.
2
3
4
5
This procedure applies to the non-roaming, roaming, and local breakout cases. For the roaming
and local breakout cases, the vPCRF forwards messages between the HSGW and the hPCRF.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
7.3
Provisioning, update and removal of QoS rules from the PCRF to the BBERF.
Transmission of events reported by the PCEF (P-GW) to the BBERF via the PCRF.
The stage 3 information for the Gxa reference point is defined in TS 29.212 [31].
Signaling flows related to the Gxa interface are specified in TS 29.213 [32].
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
123
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
A message flow illustrating the use of A11 messages for pre-registration as used for EUTRAN to eHRPD handoff is shown in section 12.1.
A message flow illustrating the use of A11 messages for handoff as used for E-UTRAN to
eHRPD handoff is shown in section 12.1.2.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
Flows showing the use of A11 messages for the initial attachment are found in A.S0022 [4].
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
124
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
The main service connection is used to provide a direct path between the UE and the HSGW
for the exchange of connection management messages, EAP-AKA messages for access
authentication, the exchange of bearer flow mapping information and the creation of per-PDN
connections. The Initial Attach and Detach signaling take place using the PPP protocol
(VSNCP) over the main service connection. The main service connection also supports IP
traffic multiplexed from multiple PDNs.
When the UE attaches to the eHRPD eAN/ePCF, whether directly on the eHRPD radio
interface or via S101 tunneling, and completes radio interface session configuration, the main
service connection is established by the network for that UE. A BE auxiliary service
connection may also be established.
The main service connection is mapped over RLP-0 (see C.R1001 [12], C.S0063
[13] and C.S0087 [15]). This is done without the need for the UE to send a
reservation request air interface message to the eAN/ePCF. The service option type
used for setting up the main A10 connection is SO59. The HSGW shall discover the
service option type from an extension received from the eAN/ePCF at the time
service connection is established.
The default auxiliary service connection for best effort bearer traffic may be
configured (see C.R1001 [12], C.S0063 [13] and C.S0087 [15]). This is done
without the need for the UE to send a reservation request air interface message to the
eAN/ePCF.
This default auxiliary best effort service connection, when
established, is signaled to the HSGW on an A11-Registration Request message
indicating service option 72 (IP packet framing, PDN multiplexing).
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
The 8-bit ReservationLabel (see C.S0063 [13]) is divided into two fields except for the 0xFF
and 0xFE Reservations. The upper four bits identify the PDN. The lower four bits identify the
IP flow uniquely for a certain PDN. The PDN identifier is selected by the UE for each
additional PDN with which the UE chooses to connect, and is signaled to the HSGW at the
time of PDN connection establishment.
The eAN uses the PDN-ID field of the ReservationLabel (Flow-ID) to determine whether the
new reservation being requested can be added to an existing RLP flow. The eAN can only
configure one auxiliary service connection of packet-based framing with the PDN-Mux
protocol ID and uses it for BE traffic. The eAN may also configure auxiliary service
connections that support HDLC-like framing (SO64) and packet framing (SO72) with PDN-
59
60
125
Mux. IP traffic from multiple PDNs with similar QoS can be multiplexed on auxiliary service
connections of packet-based framing. The eAN is permitted to map IP traffic from multiple
PDNs onto the main service connection. The eAN/ePCF signals the mapping of multiple
Flow-IDs to the main service connection to the HSGW using the A11-Registration Request
message, and the packets for those multiple Flow-IDs are differentiated using the PDN-ID
within the VSNP header (see section 9.1.5). The eAN can map reservations with similar QoS
from different PDNs onto the same auxiliary service connection of octet-based framing, and
the packets for those multiple Flow-IDs are differentiated using the PDN-ID within the VSNP
header (see section 9.1.5). The eAN can map reservations with similar QoS from different
PDNs onto the same auxiliary service connection of packet-based framing, and the packets for
those multiple Flow-IDs are differentiated using the PDN-ID inserted just prior to the first
octet of the IP packet.
After the UE moves from legacy HRPD to eHRPD, or vice versa, and when the data session is
established, then the UE shall renegotiate PPP.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
9.1
18
19
20
21
22
23
9.1.1
24
25
In the evolved HRPD system the main service connection is configured to use octet-based
HDLC-like framing. A PPP connection is established between the UE and the HSGW. The
PPP-based main service connection provides a framework for subscription authentication,
PDN connection configuration, IP packet transport, and QoS management.
26
During eHRPD session configuration, the eAN/ePCF will have determined that the UE will
be operating in evolved mode, as defined in C.S0087 [15]. Upon subsequent connection
establishment after successful HRPD session negotiation, eAN/ePCF will attach the UE to an
HSGW. The HSGW and UE will then begin eHRPD procedures over PPP.
31
27
28
29
30
32
33
34
35
36
9.1.2
37
38
The messages which need to be exchanged across the main service connection include:
39
41
40
42
43
44
45
RSVP signaling messages over VSNP for establishment of TFTs and QoS
User IP packets are also carried over the main service connection per section 9.1.5
46
47
48
49
50
The encapsulation format for messages sent over the main service connection is provided in
RFC 3748 [68] with the exceptions discussed in sections 9.1.4 and 9.1.5.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
126
9.1.3
3
4
5
6
7
8
The messages supported in the VSNCP application are described in section 9.1.4.
9
10
The messages supported in the RSVP application are described in section 9.1.6.
11
12
13
Note: The default MRU value is 1500 octets; however, since the VSNP protocol adds an extra
octet, an MRU value of at least 1501 can be considered to avoid fragmentation.
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
9.1.4
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
Table 3
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Code
Identifier
Length
OUI
34
Data
35
36
Data
37
38
39
40
Code
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
Identifier
Length
OUI
0xCF0002
Data
58
59
60
127
9.1.4.1
Configuration options shall be encoded as specified in RFC 1661 [48]. Table 4 lists all the
configuration options required for 3GPP2 VSNCP. A received configuration option that is
unrecognized shall be ignored. The UE and the HSGW shall not encrypt any of the
Configuration Options included in the VSNCP signaling.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Table 4
Configuration
Option
PDN Identifier
PDN Type
PDN address
Protocol
configuration options
Error Code
Attach Type
Type
Configuration
(decimal)
Option
Length
(octets)
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
2-102
3-15
3-253
Value
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
21
16
17
18
19
20
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
49
46
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
128
1
2
Configuration
Option
3
4
5
6
7
Type
Configuration
(decimal)
Option
Length
(octets)
APN-AMBR
10
4-8
11
10
12
Emergency Indicator
13
Emergency Services
Supported Indicator
14
15
Compression
Parameters
16
>=4
Default APN
Indication
17
Reconnect Indication
18
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
Value
60
129
Configuration
Option
Type
Configuration
(decimal)
Option
Length
(octets)
Mobile Identity
19
3-11
20
Access Priority
SIPTO Support
21
22
3
3
Value
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Table 5
25
26
Explanation of Use
0 - General Error
1 - Unauthorized APN
3 - No P-GW Available
4 - P-GW Unreachable
36
5 - P-GW Reject
38
6 - Insufficient Parameters
7 - Resource Unavailable
8 - Admin Prohibited
10 - Subscription Limitation
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
37
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
130
1
2
3
Explanation of Use
14 APN congested
4
5
6
7
8
Table 6
9
10
11
12
Value
(decimal)
Description
00
15
255
Success.
16
xx
13
14
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
131
9.1.4.1.1
This section specifies the data format for the VSNCP Configuration Options specified in
Table 4.
2
3
4
5
Table 7
0
8
Type
Length
24
31
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Length: = This field shall contain the length in octets for the VSNCP Configuration Option
including the Type and Length fields.
17
20
18
19
21
22
23
9.1.4.2
24
The UE shall send this message to the HSGW to initiate a new PDN connection. When the
UE sends this message, the following configuration options are mandatory.
26
25
27
28
29
30
31
PDN Type
33
32
PDN Address
34
Attach Type
36
35
37
The following additional configuration options are mandatory when the UE sends this
message to setup multiple PDN connections with an APN.
38
39
40
41
42
43
The PDN Address configuration option shall have a value 0, if the Attach Type is Initial
Attach. If the Attach Type is Handoff, IP address(es) assigned for the PDN shall be set in
the value field.
44
For default APN connection setup, if the default APN is not known to the UE, then the UE
shall set the APN using a zero length APN Network Identifier as the APN name (see TS
23.003 [19]). When the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request message indicating a
zero length APN, then the HSGW shall set the APN in the PBU message to the default APN
value that is contained in the subscription data for the user, unless the HSGW also receives
the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1. If the HSGW receives a
VSNCP Configure-Request message with the Emergency Indicator configuration option with
the value set to 1, then the HSGW shall set the APN in the PBU message to the emergency
APN value contained in the HSGW Emergency Configuration Data, and the APN supplied in
the VSNCP Configure-Request is ignored by the HSGW.
48
45
46
47
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
132
1
2
3
4
5
6
A UE shall indicate its supported bearer control mode capabilities in the PCO of the VSNCP
Configure-Request message when it attaches to an APN; see TS 24.008 [26]. The HSGW
forwards the BCM value to the PCRF along with the HSGW capabilities, and the PCRF
decides what BCM will be used, i.e., MS-only, or MS/NW, based on the capabilities of
the UE and the HSGW. The HSGW shall indicate the result in the VSNCP Configure-Ack
message. The UE shall use the BCM value returned to it.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
If the UE supports Network initiated QoS, then the UE shall include the MS Support of
Network Requested Bearer Control indicator (BCM) parameter in the additional parameter list
(TS 24.008 [26]) of the PCO option, when sent in the VSNCP Configure-Request from the
UE to the HSGW. Otherwise the UE shall not include the MS Support of Network Requested
Bearer Control indicator (BCM) parameter in the additional parameter list (TS 24.008 [26]) of
the PCO option, when sent in the VSNCP Configure-Request message from the UE to the
HSGW. In addition the UE may also include other parameters defined in the Protocol
Configuration Options (TS 24.008 [26]), for example, username and password for
authentication with an external AAA server may be included.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
If the PDN Type is IPv4 or IPv4v6, the UE shall include the IPv4 Default Router Address
Configuration Option. If the Attach Type is Initial, the value shall be set to 0.0.0.0. If the
Attach Type is Handoff and the UE has the currently assigned IPv4 default router address, the
value shall be set to the IPv4 address currently assigned as the IPv4 default router address. If
the Attach Type is Handoff and the UE does not have the currently assigned IPv4 default
router address, the IPv4 default router address shall be set to 0.0.0.0. If the PDN Type is IPv6
or IPv4v6, and if the Attach Type option is Handoff, and if the UE is operating in the
tunneled mode, then the UE shall include the IPv6 HSGW Link Local Address IID option and
shall set the value to all zeros.
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
The HSGW sets the Handoff Indicator value in the PBU message as follows:
In all cases of re-registration, the HSGW shall set the Handoff Indicator to 5, otherwise:
37
38
39
40
41
If the Attach Type received from the UE is Initial Attach, the HSGW shall set the
Handoff Indicator to 1.
If Attach Type received from the UE is handover and if context transfer occurs for
the UE using the H1 interface, the serving HSGW shall set the Handoff Indicator to
3.
If Attach Type received from the UE is handover and if context transfer does not
occur using the H1 interface, the serving HSGW shall set the Handoff Indicator to
either 2 or 3.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
If the UE is creating this PDN connection to access emergency services, then the UE shall
include the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1. In addition, the
UE shall also include Mobile Identity configuration option in the VSNCP Configure Request
message. If the UE is not creating this PDN connection to access emergency services, then the
UE may include the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 0.
If the UE wants to use the VSNP Extend Code capability in the reverse link, it shall include
the VSNP Extend Code Support configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Request with
the data field set to 0x01.
53
54
55
56
57
If the UE includes the VSNP Extend Code Support option, the UE may include an instance of
the Compression Parameters option for each compression protocol type it wants to use in the
reverse link.
58
59
60
133
If the UE is capable of supporting the Access Priority configuration option, and if the UE is
willing to accept a lower priority for the PDN connection being requested, then the UE shall
include the Access Priority configuration option with a value of Low Priority.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
If the HSGW supports Default APN Configuration option, and if the PDN connection
requested by the UE corresponds to the default APN, then the HSGW shall include the
Default APN Configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Request message sent by the
HSGW with the value set to 1.
If the UE had included User Context Identifier configuration option in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest message, and if the HSGW had accepted the User Context Identifier configuration
option sent by the UE, the following additional fields are mandatory when the HSGW sends
VSNCP Configure-Request message to the UE
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
User Context Identifier (This value is copied from the corresponding VSNCP
Configure-Request from the UE.)
If the HSGW supports emergency services, then the HSGW shall include the Emergency
Service Support Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1. If the HSGW does not
support emergency services, then the HSGW shall either not include the Emergency Service
Support Indicator configuration option, or shall include the Emergency Service Support
Indicator configuration option with the value set to 0.
If the HSGW wants to use the VSNP Extend Code capability in the forward link, it shall
include the VSNP Extend Code Support configuration option in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest with the data field set to 0x01.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
If the HSGW includes the VSNP Extend Code Support option, the HSGW may include an
instance of the Compression Parameters option for each compression protocol type it wants to
use in the forward link.
If the UE included the Access Priority configuration option with a value of Low Priority in
the associated VSNCP Configure-Request, the HSGW shall forward the low access priority
indication in the PBU message to the P-GW.
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
The UE/HSGW shall ignore unrecognized configuration options present in the VSNCP
Configure-Request. The VSNCP Configure-Reject message shall not be sent for such
requests, if the UE/HSGW can proceed with the PDN connection attempt with available
configuration options in the request. The UE/HSGW shall not include those unrecognized
55
56
57
58
59
60
134
parameters in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message sent in response to the VSNCP ConfigureRequest. The configuration options that are sent by the UE/HSGW in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest and not received back in the VSNCP Configure-Ack shall be considered not
supported by the other side.
1
2
3
4
5
If the HSGW or the UE wants to change any values in the configuration options that are
received in VSNCP Configure-Request, then the HSGW or UE shall send VSNCP ConfigureAck with the modified value in the configuration option.
6
7
8
9
10
Note: In this version of this specification, there are no configuration options that the UE is
allowed to change.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
9.1.4.3
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
If the HSGW successfully connects to the default APN, it shall include the APN name of the
default APN in the Access Point Name configuration option, unless the HSGW also receives
the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set to 1. If the HSGW receives a
VSNCP Configure-Request message with the Emergency Indicator configuration option with
the value set to 1, then the HSGW shall set the APN configuration option in the VSNCP
Configure-Ack to the null APN. If the HSGW successfully connects to the emergency APN,
then the HSGW shall include the Emergency Indicator configuration option with the value set
to 1 in the VSNCP-Configure-Ack message.
If the UE included the VSNP Extend Code Support option in the VSNCP Configure-Request,
and if the HSGW accepts the use of VSNP Extend Code in the reverse link, then the HSGW
shall include the VSNP Extend Code Support option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message
with the data field of the option set to 1. Otherwise the HSGW shall either not include the
VSNP Extend Code configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message, or shall
include the VSNP Extend Code configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message
with the value set to 0.
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
If the UE included one or more instances of the Compression Parameters option in the
VSNCP Configure-Request for the reverse link, and if the HSGW supports compression on
the reverse link, then the HSGW shall include corresponding instances of the Compression
Parameters option for all compression types that it accepts for the reverse link in the VSNCP
Configure-Ack message. Otherwise, the HSGW shall not include the Compression Parameters
configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
If the UE included the IPv4 Default Router Address Configuration Option in the VSNCP
Configure-Request message and if deferred IPv4 address allocation is used, the HSGW shall
set the value of the IPv4 Default Router Address Configuration Option to 0.0.0.0. If the P-GW
returned an IPv4 default router address, the HSGW shall set the value of the IPv4 Default
Router Address Configuration Option to the returned address.
59
60
135
If the UE included the IPv4 Default Router Address Configuration Option set to 0.0.0.0 in the
VSNCP Configure-Request message with Attach Type = Handover and the UE is performing
pre-registration over the S101 tunnel, the HSGW shall set the value of the IPv4 Default
Router Address Configuration Option to the pre-configured value in the HSGW.
1
2
3
4
5
If the UE included the IPv6 HSGW Link Local Address IID option and if the Attach Type
option is Handoff, and if the Tunnel Mode Indicator is set to 1 in the last received A11Registration Request message for the UE, then the HSGW shall include the IPv6 HSGW Link
Local Address IID option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message and shall set the value to the
interface ID of the HSGW link local address.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
If the UE included the User Context Identifier configuration option in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest, and if the network supports MUPSAP, then the HSGW shall include the User
Context Identifier configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message. Otherwise the
HSGW shall not include User Context Identifier configuration option in the VSNCP
Configure-Ack message.
The HSGW shall fill in the requested parameters in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message
based on the PBA message received from the P-GW. The HSGW shall indicate the bearer
control mode selected by the PCRF using the Selected Bearer Control Mode in the PCO
option only if the UE included the MS Support of Network Requested Bearer Control
indicator in the PCO option in the corresponding VSNCP Configure-Request message.
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Since the HSGW does not send a PBU message to the P-GW during pre-registration
procedures over S101, if the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request message from the
UE over the S101 interface with the Attach Type set to Handoff, the HSGW shall include
in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message parameters based on the communication with the
PCRF and based on local configuration. Upon receiving the VSNCP Configure-Ack
message, the UE shall only update parameters for which new values are received and keep
other parameters unchanged.
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
If the HSGW included the VSNP Extend Code Support option in the VSNCP ConfigureRequest, and if the UE accepts the use of VSNP Extend Code in the forward link, then the UE
shall include the VSNP Extend Code Support option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message
with the data field of the option set to 1.
If the HSGW included one or more instances of the Compression Parameters option in the
VSNCP Configure-Request for the forward link, and if the UE supports compression on the
forward link, then the UE shall include corresponding instances of the Compression
Parameters option for all compression types that it accepts for the forward link in the VSNCP
Configure-Ack message. Otherwise, the UE shall not include the Compression Parameters
configuration option in the VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
The UE/HSGW shall validate the Configuration Option values received in the VSNCP
Configure-Ack message. If the UE/HSGW finds the values not acceptable for the PDN
connection, it may decide to terminate the PDN connection.
48
49
50
51
52
9.1.4.4
53
To reduce the number of messages required for PDN connection setup, this message is not
used in the 3GPP2 VSNCP procedure. Neither the UE nor the HSGW shall send this message
to the other.
55
54
56
57
58
59
60
136
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
9.1.4.5
16
Error Code
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
The HSGW may use all error codes specified in Table 5. The UE may use error codes 0 and 6
as specified in Table 5.
Receipt of a VSNCP Configure-Reject message by the UE is an indication to the UE from the
HSGW that the PDN connection was never created, or in the case of a modification request,
has been deleted.
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
The HSGW receives a PBA message from the P-GW indicating APN congestion and
containing a back-off time.
The HSGW is aware that the APN being requested is congested and the back-off
time has not yet expired for the UE.
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
If the UE has included the Access Priority configuration option in the associated
VSNCP Configure-Request message, then the HSGW shall include an error code of
APN congested and the APN Back-off Timer configuration option in the VSNCP
Configure-Reject message. If the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request
message indicating a zero length APN, the HSGW may include either the default
APN value that is contained in the subscription data for the user, or include a zero
length APN in the VSNCP Configure-Reject message.
Otherwise, the HSGW shall include an error code of No P-GW Available, and
shall not include the APN Back-off Timer configuration option in the VSNCP
Configure-Reject message.
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
If the UE receives a VSNCP Configure-Reject message with the error code set to APN
congested, the UE shall use the back-off timer value specified in the APN Back-off Timer
configuration option to start an internal back-off timer relative to that APN. The UE is not
required to remember a back-off timer after a power cycle. The UE shall not attempt to create
or modify a PDN connection for the congested APN, except for releasing the PDN connection
60
137
setup earlier (e.g., sending a VSNCP Terminate-Request message), prior to the expiration of
the back-off timer specified by the VSNCP Configure-Reject message. The UE may initiate
PDN connection procedures for other APNs.
1
2
3
4
9.1.4.6
The UE and the HSGW use this message to initiate explicit PDN Connection release. The
following configuration options are mandatory. If, while processing a VSNCP ConfigureRequest, the HSGW receives a PBA message from the P-GW with a Status field value
indicating failure to complete the request PDN attach, the HSGW shall send a VSNCP
Configure-Reject to the UE.
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
PDN Identifier
14
15
16
17
If the HSGW receives a PBA message from the P-GW with a Status field value indicating
failure to extend the lifetime of the PMIP tunnel for an existing PDN connection, the HSGW
shall send a VSNCP Terminate-Request message to the UE for this PDN connection. Upon
sending or receiving the VSNCP Terminate-Request message requesting release of a PDN
connection, the HSGW shall trigger PMIPv6 procedures to release the binding, if the binding
exists. The UE and the HSGW shall release all the resources including TFTs associated with
the PDN matching the PDN-ID in the message when this message is sent or received.
If the HSGW receives a 3GPP2-Reconnect-Indication mobility option in a BRI, the HSGW
shall include a Reconnect Indication configuration option in the corresponding VSNCP
Terminate-Request it sends to the UE. The HSGW shall set the value in the Reconnect
Indication configuration option to match the reconnect indication received in the 3GPP2Reconnect-Indication mobility option.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
9.1.4.7
45
The UE and the HSGW shall use this message to respond to a VSNCP Terminate-Request
message. The following configuration options are mandatory.
47
46
48
49
50
PDN Identifier
51
52
53
54
9.1.4.8
55
This message is used as specified in RFC 1661 [48]. The following configuration options are
mandatory.
57
56
58
59
60
138
PDN Identifier
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
9.1.5
10
11
12
13
The VSNP packet format without the VSNP extend code shall be supported as shown in Table
8.
14
Table 8
15
16
17
18
19
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Protocol
PDN Identifier
Data
20
21
Data
22
23
24
25
26
27
Protocol
PDN Identifier
PDN Identifier of the PDN for which the user data is sent. The high order 4
bits of this field shall be set to 0000. The low order 4 bits of this field
shall contain the PDN-ID.
Data
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
The VSNP packet format using the VSNP extend code is shown in Table 9. Support of this
format is optional. The UE shall send packets using the format specified in Table 9, if the
VSNP extend code is negotiated (see section 9.1.4) for the reverse link. The HSGW shall send
packets using the format specified in Table 9, if the VSNP extend code is negotiated (see
section 9.1.4) for the forward link.
37
38
Table 9
39
40
41
42
43
44
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Protocol
Extend
PDN-ID
Data
Code
45
46
Data
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
Protocol
Extend Code
This field shall be set to one of the values given in table Table 10.
54
55
56
57
If PPP PFC is negotiated (ref. RFC 1661 [48]), then only the least significant octet (0x5b) is
sent.
58
59
60
139
Table 10
Binary
Description
2
3
4
5
0000
0011
All others
Reserved
7
8
10
11
12
13
PDN-ID
PDN Identifier of the PDN for which the user data is sent.
Data
The format specified in Table 9 applies to both the main service connection (SO59) and
auxiliary service connections using SO64.
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
9.1.6
21
RSVP Protocol
22
The following RSVP messages (see RFC 2205 [52]) shall be used between the UE and the
HSGW to support QoS establishment:
1.
Resv message
2.
ResvConf message
3.
ResvErr message.
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
RSVP messages shall be carried over the main service connection using the VSNP protocol
(see section 9.1.5) by setting the Protocol field to 0x005b (see RFC 3772 [69]). RSVP Resv
messages shall contain the TFT Information Element that includes Packet Filter List and the
QoS List (as required).
32
33
34
35
36
37
RSVP messages are associated with a PDN based upon the PDN Identifier contained in the
VSNP header. In addition, the upper 4 bits of the Flow Identifier in this document form a
field that identifies the PDN-ID. This convention does not apply for the Flow-IDs 0xFF and
0xFE flows which are defined in detail in C.S0087 [15].
When generating a new Transaction ID value to be used in an RSVP message, the HSGW
shall set the most significant bit of this field to 1. When generating a new Transaction ID
value, the UE shall set the most significant bit of this field to 0.
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
All the RSVP messages used in this specification are sent over UDP with the Protocol ID of
17 with registered port number of 3455. All the messages (i.e., Resv, ResvErr, and ResvConf)
shall be sent using the destination port of 3455 by both the HSGW and the UE. All the source
port numbers may be set to any value.
48
49
50
51
52
53
For IPv6, the UE shall send the RSVP message to the Link Local IPv6 address of the HSGW
and the HSGW shall send the RSVP message to the Link Local IPv6 address of the UE. The
Link Local IPv6 address of the HSGW is the source address of the Router Advertisement
message sent by the HSGWs (MAGs). The Link Local Address of the HSGW is set by the P-
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
140
GW and does not change while the PDN connection is established, as per section 6.8 and 9.3
of RFC 5213 [80].
1
2
3
For IPv4, the UE shall use the IPv4 default router address obtained during the PDN
connection setup as the destination address of the RSVP packets for that PDN. The HSGW
sends the RSVP packets to the IPv4 address of the UE. The IPv4 default router address is set
by the P-GW in the IPv4 Default-Router Address Option in the corresponding PBA message
for a given UE (see RFC 5213 [80]), and it does not change while the PDN connection is
established. The HSGW shall set its address to the IPv4 default router address received in the
PBA message.
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
A UE that receives both an IPv4 address and an IPv6 address for a given PDN may choose
either the IPv4 default router address or the Link Local IPv6 address of the HSGW as the
destination address for RSVP signaling.
13
14
15
16
17
18
9.1.6.1
9.1.6.1.1
HSGW Requirements
19
20
21
22
23
During an inter-HSGW handoff with context transfer, if the QoS policy received from the SHSGW during the context transfer does not match with the QoS policy obtained from the
PCRF, and if the selected Bearer Control Mode is MS/NW, then the T-HSGW shall
perform the network initiated QoS setup procedures to update the QoS flows for unmatched
flows based on the QoS policy received from the PCRF.
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
After a successful PPP renegotiation, if the selected Bearer Control Mode is MS/NW, then
the HSGW shall perform the network initiated QoS setup procedures to setup the QoS flows
for all the established flows based on the QoS policy received from the PCRF.
31
32
33
34
During handoff from E-UTRAN to eHRPD, including pre-registration, if the selected Bearer
Control Mode is MS/NW, then the HSGW shall perform the network initiated QoS setup
procedures to establish QoS flows based on the QoS policy received from the PCRF using the
network initiated the QoS setup procedure described in section 9.1.6.3.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
9.1.6.1.2
42
UE Requirements
Upon a successful PPP renegotiation, if the selected Bearer Control Mode is set to MS only
mode, then the UE shall setup the QoS for all the flows that were active prior to the PPP
renegotiation and the UE wishes to maintain as active.
43
44
45
46
47
During handoff from E-UTRAN to eHRPD, including pre-registration, if the selected Bearer
Control Mode is set to MS only mode, then the UE should establish the QoS for all the
flows are established on E-UTRAN using UE initiated the QoS setup procedure described in
section 9.1.6.2.
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
9.1.6.2
57
58
59
60
141
The UE shall send a Resv message to the HSGW containing the requested QoS List and
associated packet filters with the Operation Code set to QoS-Check in the TFT. If the HSGW
can not parse the TFT for any reason, e.g., poorly formatted TFT, invalid PDN-ID, or an
unauthorized IPv4 address/IPv6 Prefix is included in the TFT, the HSGW shall send a
ResvErr message as specified in Chapter 4 B.3 in X.S0011 [6].
1
2
3
4
5
6
If the UE receives a ResvErr message (ref. section 9.1.6.6) from the HSGW with the error
code set to NW initiated QoS in progress for all the flows, then the UE shall wait for the
Network to set up the QoS for all the flows in the TFT. If the UE receives a ResvErr message
from the HSGW with the error code set to a value other than NW initiated QoS in progress
for all the flows, then the UE shall assume that processing of all requested IE Data contained
in the 3GPP2 Object was unsuccessful. When the X bit in the TFT Error IE is set, it
indicates the inclusion of index of the Flow Identifier that caused the failure.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
If the Resv message received from the UE is valid, for each IP flow included in the Resv
message the HSGW shall convert the FlowProfileID(s) to a single set of 3GPP QoS
parameters and perform authorization of the requested QoS per TS 29.212 [31]. If there are
multiple FlowProfileIDs sent by the UE, the HSGW shall consider the first in the list as the
one most preferred by the UE. If the network is setting up the QoS for all the flows in the TFT
that the UE is requesting to setup, then the HSGW shall send a ResvErr message (ref. section
9.1.6.6) with the error code set to NW initiated QoS in progress for all the flows.
Once the HSGW has received authorization for the QoS per the PCC mechanisms, it shall
respond to the UE request by sending a ResvConf message using the same Transaction ID as
received in the Resv message, and the Operation Code set to QoS-Check Confirm. The
ResvConf message shall include a set (one or more) of authorized FlowProfileIDs (based on
operator determined charging rules, etc.) and associated packet filters for each authorized
Flow Identifier in the QoS list. The authorized FlowProfileIDs in the QoS List shall be the
same or a subset of the FlowProfileIDs in the Resv message sent by the UE. If UE Initiated
QoS for the flow is not authorized, the HSGW shall set the R_QoS_SUB_BLOB_LEN for
that Flow Identifier to zero and shall set the Result Code to the value UE Initiated QoS is not
authorized. If the network decides to modify the evaluation precedence value of one or more
packet filters that are sent by the UE in the Resv message with the Operation Code set to
QoS Check, then the HSGW shall include those packet filters with the modified evaluation
precedence values in the ResvConf message with the Operation Code set to QoS Check
Confirm. In the ResvConf message with the Operation Code set to QoS Check Confirm,
the HSGW should not modify the packet filters that were requested by the UE in the Resv
message with the Operation Code set to QoS Check 1.If the network is setting up the QoS
for a flow in the TFT that the UE is also requesting to setup, then the HSGW shall set the
R_QoS_SUB_BLOB_LEN for that Flow Identifier to zero and shall set the Result Code to the
value NW initiated QoS in progress for this flow. The UE shall not include this flow in the
subsequent Resv message.
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
The UE may send the Resv message a configurable number of times until a ResvConf or
ResvErr message is received from the HSGW with the same Transaction ID, or until expiry of
a configurable timer. The Resv and ResvConf message format is the same as the Resv and
ResvConf message formats specified in Annex B in X.S0011 [6] except for 3GPP2 Object as
specified in this section.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
E-UTRAN allows the network to modify the requested packet filters; however, such
modification of packet filters is not supported in this version of this specification.
56
57
58
59
60
142
Upon receiving the ResvConf message from the HSGW, for each Flow Identifier that has a
non-empty FlowProfileID list associated with it, the UE shall use the authorized
FLOW_PRIORITY, associated packet filters and FlowProfileID list to start UE initiated QoS
procedures as specified in C.S0063 [13]. The UE shall then set up the TFTs as specified in
Annex B in X.S0011 [6] using the same Flow ID(s) with the modified evaluation precedence
in QoS-Check procedures and a different Transaction ID on the Resv message.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
After the TFT has been created, if the QoS list and/or associated packet filters are to be
modified (i.e., add or replace), then the UE shall send a Resv message to the HSGW
containing the modified QoS list and associated packet filters with the Operation Code set to
QoS-Check in the TFT. After the QoS-Check procedure is successfully completed, the UE
shall modify the TFTs as specified in Annex B in X.S0011 [6] using the same Flow ID(s)
used in the QoS-Check procedures and a different Transaction ID on the Resv message. For
each Flow ID that has been modified with a different FlowProfileID(s), the UE shall request
modification by the eAN with the new FlowProfileID(s) as specified in C.S0063 [13].
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
9.1.6.3
28
29
30
31
32
1.
2.
Initiate the deletion of all packet filters for TFTs specified in the list of flow
identifiers.
3.
Initiate the modifications of packet filters/QoS for TFTs specified in the list of flow
identifiers.
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
For network initiated flow request, the HSGW shall send an RSVP Resv message with the
Initiate Flow Request operation code to the UE. Upon successfully receiving such a Resv
message the UE shall respond with a Resv message with the same Transaction ID and same
packet filters as received from the HSGW and set the operation code to Add packet filters to
existing TFT if the TFT already exists; otherwise the UE shall send Create New TFT, as
specified in X.S0011 [6]. For successful operation, the HSGW shall respond with a ResvConf
message.
For network initiated delete of all packet filters, the HSGW shall send an RSVP Resv
message with Initiate Delete Packet Filters from Existing TFT operation code to the UE.
Upon successfully receiving such a Resv message the UE shall respond with a Resv message
with the same Transaction ID and operation code set to Delete Packet Filters from Existing
TFT, as specified in X.S0011 [6]. For successful operation, the HSGW shall respond with a
ResvConf message.
54
55
56
57
58
For network initiated modifications of packet filters/QoS, the HSGW shall send Initiate
Replace packet filters in existing TFT operation code to the UE. Upon successfully receiving
such a Resv message the UE shall respond with a Resv message with the same Transaction ID
59
60
143
and same packet filters as received form the HSGW and set operation code to Replace packet
filters in existing TFT, as specified in X.S0011 [6]. For successful operation, the HSGW
shall respond with a ResvConf message.
1
2
3
4
For network initiated flow request or network modifications of packet filters/QoS, if the UE
supports one or more FlowProfileIDs associated with a Flow Identifier, the UE shall include
the Flow Identifier and associated packet filters in the Resv message. The UE may use a
subset of QoS FlowProfileIDs specified in the QoS list to request QoS Setup or modifications.
Upon receiving a Resv message from the HSGW, if the UE can not parse the TFT for any
reason, e.g., poorly formatted TFT, or if the HSGW includes an invalid IPv4 address/IPv6
Prefix in the TFT, or if the UE supports none of QoS FlowProfileIDs specified in the QoS
List (if included) the UE shall send a ResvErr message.
If the HSGW receives a ResvErr message from the UE, the HSGW shall assume that
processing of all requested IE Data contained in the 3GPP2 Object was unsuccessful. When
the X bit in the TFT Error IE is set, it indicates inclusion of the index of the Flow Identifier
that caused the failure.
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Error handling of the Resv messages by the UE and the HSGW is as specified for other
operation codes in this specification.
The HSGW may send the Resv message a configurable number of times until a Resv message
or ResvErr message is received from the UE with the same Transaction ID, or until expiry of
a configurable timer. Upon receiving the Resv message from the UE, the HSGW shall send
either a ResvConf or a ResvErr message to the UE.
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
9.1.6.4
9.1.6.5
Resv Message
31
Resv message is specified in Annex B.1 of X.S0011-004 [6]. The 3GPP2 OBJECT in Resv
messages sent from the HSGW to the UE for network initiated QoS and from the UE to the
HSGW for UE initiated QoS-Check operation is specified in the section 9.1.6.7.1.
33
32
34
35
36
37
ResvConf Message
38
39
The format of the ResvConf Message shall follow Annex B.2 of X.S0011-004 [6] except for
the UE initiated QoS-Check operation. The format of the ResvConf Message for the UE
initiated QoS containing the QoS-Check Confirm operation code shall be the same as the
Resv Message. The 3GPP2 OBJECT in ResvConf messages sent from the HSGW to the UE
for UE initiated QoS-Check confirm operation is specified in the section 9.1.6.7.1.
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
144
1
2
3
9.1.6.6
ResvErr Message
ResvErr message is specified in Annex B.3 of X.S0011-004 [6].
4
5
6
7
The TFT Error Code values defined in Table 11 shall be supported in addition to those
defined in Annex B.3 of X.S0011-004 [6].
Table 11
9
10
11
12
13
TFT Error
Code
Description
Reason
10000000
Unsuccessful TFT
processing
10000001
Invalid IP address
10000010
FlowProfileIDs not
supported by the UE
10000011
10000100
QoS-Check procedure
needs to be performed
10000101
NW initiated QoS in
progress for all the
flows
10000110
Evaluation precedence
contention for NW
initiated QoS
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
145
9.1.6.7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
9.1.6.7.1
3GPP2 OBJECT
10
The 3GPP2 OBJECT shall appear in Resv messages sent between the HSGW and the UE and
shall appear in ResvConf messages sent from the HSGW to the UE for the QoS-Check
confirm operation. The 3GPP2 OBJECT shall contain the following information element:
12
11
13
14
15
16
TFT
17
18
The HSGW or UE shall include at least one TFT Information Elements (IE) into the 3GPP2
OBJECT; the IEs may be repeated. The 3GPP2 OBJECT shall be formatted per the IANA
assigned numbering scheme. The format of the 3GPP2 OBJECT is shown in Table 12:
19
20
21
22
23
Table 12
3GPP2 OBJECT
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Length
3GPP2 Class
C-Type
Transaction ID
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
IE List
32
33
Padding as necessary
Length:
Length of the 3GPP2 OBJECT includes all octets, including the Length
field. Length in octets and shall always be a multiple of 4 octets.
34
35
36
37
38
39
3GPP2 Class:
231
C-Type:
Transaction ID:
This field shall be set in Resv messages to a 32 bit unique number which is
used for matching a Resv message with the response (i.e., Resv message,
ResvConf message, or ResvErr message).
40
41
This field shall be set in Resv, ResvConf and ResvErr messages to the
same value that was received in the Resv message for which the Resv,
ResvConf or ResvErr message is a response.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
146
IE List:
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Length
IE Type #
IE Data
9
10
11
12
IE Data
Padding
13
14
15
16
17
Length:
Length is the length in octets of the IE Data (including the length and IE
Type fields), and shall always be a multiple of two octets.
IE Type #:
18
19
Table 14
20
21
IE Type #
24
TFTIPv4
IE Type#
value
0
25
TFTIPv6
22
23
26
27
28
29
30
IE Data:
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
147
9.1.6.7.1.1
The HSGW shall set the value of the IP address (Destination IP address/Prefix if the D field is
set to 00or the source IP address/Prefix if the D field is set to 01) in the packet filter list to
be the same as the value of UE IPv4 address field or the UE IPv6 address field if the UEs IP
address/prefix is included in the packet filter list. When comparing IPv6 addresses, only the
prefix shall be compared.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
The IE Data field is sent in the Resv message (for network initiated QoS or for the UE
initiated QoS-Check operation) or the ResvConf message (for the UE initiated QoS-Check
confirm operation) and has the following format:
9
10
11
12
13
Table 15
14
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
UE IPv4 address
D
Reser
ved
N SR_ID
S
Number of packet
filters with modified
precedence
Reserved
Number of Packet
filters
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
QoS List
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
Table 16
32
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
UE IPv6 address
Reserved
40
Number of Packet
filters
36
39
UE IPv6 address
N SR_ID
S
35
38
UE IPv6 address
Reser
ved
34
37
UE IPv6 address
33
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
The TFT is coded with the following fields. When the HSGW includes a TFT in a ResvConf
message in response to a UE initiated QoS-Check procedure, the HSGW shall set each field in
the TFT to be the same as the UE requested in the Resv message except for the TFT
Operation Code field which is set to the value QoS-Check Confirm and number of packet
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
148
1
2
filters is set to 0. The Result Code field (in QoS List) shall be present only in the ResvConf
message that has the TFT Operation Code field set to the value QoS-Check Confirm.
3
4
5
UE IP Address:
6
7
8
9
For IPv6, the 64 most significant bits shall be set to the UEs prefix and
the 64 least significant bits shall be set to all zeros.
10
11
12
D:
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
When the NS bit is set to '1', the SR_ID field shall be set to '000'. This is
always the case for eHRPD.
P:
The P (Persistency) bit is set to '1' to indicate that the HSGW will keep the
TFT even if the A10 connection is not established or disconnected at the
HSGW or flow ID to A10 connection mapping information is not yet
received at the HSGW from the RAN. For eHRPD this bit shall always be
set to '1'.
23
27
SR_ID:
22
26
21
25
NS:
20
24
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
149
Table 17
TFT OpCodes
OpCode
Action
Description
00000110
QoS-Check
10000000
10000001
10000010
10000011
Initiate Flow
Request
QoS-Check
Confirm
Initiate Delete
Packet Filter from
Existing TFT
Initiate Replace
packet filters in
existing TFT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
20
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
Number of Packet Filters: The HSGW shall set this field to zero in the ResvConf message
when the TFT Operation Code is QoS-Check Confirm. Otherwise, the
field shall be set as defined in X.S0011-004 [6].
Packet Filter List: The packet filter list contains a variable number of packet filters. It shall be
encoded same as defined in X.S0011-004 [6] except as defined below:
For QoS-Check Confirm operations, the packet filter list shall be empty.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
For Initiate Delete Packet Filter from Existing TFT, the packet filter list
shall contain a variable number of Flow Identifiers given in the number of
packet filters field. In this case, the packet filter evaluation precedence,
length, and contents are not included, only the Flow Identifiers are
included. See Figure B-6, X.S0011-004 [6].
43
For Initiate Flow request and Initiate Replace Packet Filters in Existing
TFT Replace Packet Filters in Existing TFT the packet filter list shall
contain a variable number of Flow Identifiers, along with the packet filter
contents. See Figure B-7, X.S0011-004 [6].
49
44
45
46
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
150
2
3
The upper 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall include the PDN-ID. The
lower 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall identify each reservation that is
requested to be added or deleted.
4
5
6
7
For the TFT operation code set to Initiate Flow Request, the lower 4
bits of Flow Identifier shall be set to a unique temporary flow
identifier associated with the Transaction ID. The UE shall replace
the temporary flow identifier with a unique flow identifier in the
remainder of the network initiated QoS procedure. The same
FLOW_ID value may be used in the forward and reverse directions.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
For the TFT operation code set to Initiate Delete Packet Filter from
Existing TFT and Initiate Replace Packet Filter in Existing TFT,
the lower 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall be set to the flow identifier
associated with the flow for which packet filter are to be deleted or
modified respectively.
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
QoS List:
QoS List shall not be included in IE Data field for the Initiate Delete
Packet Filter from Existing TFT operation code. QoS List shall only be
included in IE Data field for the QoS-Check, QoS-Check Confirm,
Initiate Flow Request, and Initiate Replace Packet Filters in Existing
TFT operation codes.
The QoS List, if present, shall contain a variable number of Flow
Identifiers and associated R_QOS_SUB_BLOB fields. Table 18 shows the
format of the QoS List.
29
Table 18
30
31
32
33
34
35
0
MSB
36
37
Flow Identifier 1
38
R_QOS_SUB_BLOB_LEN 1
39
R_QOS_SUB_BLOB 1
40
41
42
Result Code 1
43
Flow Identifier 2
44
45
46
47
R_QOS_SUB_BLOB_LEN 2
R_QOS_SUB_BLOB 2
Result Code 2
48
49
50
Flow Identifier N
51
52
53
54
55
R_QOS_SUB_BLOB_LEN N
R_QOS_SUB_BLOB N
Result Code N
56
57
58
59
60
151
7
LSB
Each QoS List is of variable length and consists of the following fields:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
10
11
12
13
14
The upper 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall include the PDN-ID. The
lower 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall identify each reservation that is
requested to be added or deleted.
15
For the TFT operation code set to QoS-Check, the UE shall set the
lower 4 bits of Flow Identifier to a flow identifier associated with the
Transaction ID. In the resulting ResvConf message with operation
QoS-Check Confirm, the HSGW shall return the same Flow
Identifier value as received from the UE.
19
For TFT operation code set to Initiate Flow Request, the HSGW
shall set the Flow Identifier to a unique temporary value associated
with the Flow Identifier in the packet filter list. This temporary Flow
Identifier shall be set to the same value as used in the Packet Filter
List.
For TFT operation code set to Initiate Replace Packet Filters in
Existing TFT, the HSGW shall set the Flow Identifier to the flow
identifier associated with the flow for which packet filters are to be
replaced. This Flow Identifier shall be set to the same value as used in
the Packet Filter List.
R_QoS_SUB_BLOB_LEN (1 octet):
This field shall be set to the length, in octets, of the R_QoS_SUB_BLOB
field.
R_QoS_SUB_BLOB (multiple octets):
This field shall be set according to Annex E.1 of X.S0011-004 [6]. The
VERBOSE field shall be set to 0. The FlowProfileIDs are listed in this
parameter in descending order of precedence.
QoS_ATTRIBUTE_SET_ID shall not be set to 0000000.
QoS_ATTRIBUTE_SET_IDs in the ResvConf message with operation
code set to QoS-Check Confirm shall be set independently from the
QoS_ATTRIBUTE_SET_IDs in the Resv message with the Operation
Code set to QoS Check.
The HSGW shall set FLOW_PRIORITY based on local policy (e.g.,
persistent value).
16
17
18
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
152
requested by the UE was successful. The result codes, descriptions and the
reasons are described in Table 19.
1
2
3
Table 19
Result
Code
5
6
Description
Reason
7
8
9
00000000
Successful
00000001
UE Initiated QoS is
not authorized
00000010
NW initiated QoS
in progress for this
flow
The Network is setting up the QoS for this flow that the
UE is trying to setup.
00000011
Requested
FlowProfileIDs
failed mapping
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Others
27
Reserved
28
29
Number of packet filters with modified precedence: If the network modifies the precedence
value of one or more packet filters that are requested by the UE in the Resv
message with the TFT Operation Code set to QoS Check, then the
HSGW shall set this field to the number of packet filters that have a
modified precedence in the ResvConf message when the TFT Operation
Code is QoS-Check Confirm. Otherwise, the HSGW shall set this field
to 0.
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
The upper 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall include the PDN-ID. The
lower 4 bits of Flow Identifier shall identify each reservation.
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
9.1.7
56
57
58
59
60
153
9.1.7.1
9.1.7.2
9.1.8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
This section specifies how the UE and the HSGW determine the status of the PPP link and
maintain the PPP session when the UE is connected to the HSGW directly over the eHRPD
air interface or indirectly via the S101 interface.
21
22
23
24
25
9.1.8.1
26
For each PPP session, the HSGW shall support a PPP inactivity timer. The HSGW shall not
implement a PPP session timer.
28
The PPP inactivity timer is a 4-octet unsigned integer which is locally provisioned in the
HSGW. The value of this timer represents the maximum number of consecutive seconds that
a PPP session can remain idle before the HSGW starts performing the PPP link status
determination.
31
The HSGW shall set the default value of 86,400 seconds (24 hours) for the PPP inactivity
timer for all PPP sessions. The HSGW may set the PPP inactivity timer to a non default value.
After entering the LCP Opened state, the HSGW shall send the 3GPP2 vendor specific MAX
PPP Inactivity Timer packet (see RFC 2153 [51]) to the UE over the main service connection.
The format of the 3GPP2 vendor specific MAX PPP Inactivity Timer packet shall be as
defined in section 3.2.1.10 of X.S0011-002 [6]. The MAX PPP Inactivity Timer value shall be
equal to
27
29
30
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
for the PPP session. If the HSGW has determined that the UE is an Always On UE, the
HSGW should resend the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer packet a configurable number of times
if no response from the UE is received. If the HSGW has determined that the UE is a nonAlways On UE, the HSGW need not resend the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer packet.
48
If the HSGW determines that the value in the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer packet previously
sent to the UE should be changed, the HSGW shall send a revised 3GPP2 vendor specific
MAX PPP Inactivity Timer packet as described in the preceding paragraph.
47
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
154
If the PPP inactivity timer is not running, then the HSGW shall start the PPP inactivity timer
for the PPP session upon entering the VSNCP Opened state for a PDN connection. While the
PPP inactivity timer is running, if the HSGW sends or receives any packet to or from the UE,
the HSGW shall reset the PPP inactivity timer to its full value.
1
2
3
4
5
If the PPP inactivity timer expires, the HSGW shall perform the following:
6
7
8
If the HSGW has determined that the UE is an Always On UE, the HSGW shall
perform the PPP Link Status Determination procedure as specified in section
9.1.8.3.
If the HSGW has determined that the UE is a non-Always On UE, then the
HSGW shall not perform the PPP Link Status Determination procedure. Instead,
the HSGW shall perform the following:
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
If the HSGW received a MAX PPP Inactivity response packet from the UE,
the HSGW shall perform context maintenance as described in section 9.1.9.
Otherwise, the HSGW shall release all context(s) and all A10/A11
resources associated with the UE.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
9.1.8.2
Send the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer response packet to the HSGW. The format
of the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer response packet is defined in section 3.2.1.10
of X.S0011-002 [6].
Set its MAX PPP Inactivity Timer to the value in the MAX PPP Inactivity
Timer packet.
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
Send the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer response packet to the HSGW. The format
of the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer response packet is defined in section 3.2.1.10
in X.S0011-002 [6].
Set its MAX PPP Inactivity Timer to the value in the MAX PPP Inactivity
Timer packet.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
If the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer is not running and if the UE supports Max PPP Inactivity
Timer, then the UE shall start the MAX PPP Inactivity Timer for the PPP session upon
entering the VSNCP Opened state for a PDN connection. While the MAX PPP Inactivity
Timer is running, if the UE sends or receives an LCP Echo-Request or any other packet to or
from the HSGW, the UE shall reset its MAX PPP Inactivity Timer to its full value.
Upon the expiry of MAX PPP Inactivity Timer, the UE shall release all the VSNCP contexts
and maintain partial context (which includes the LCP, CCP, and authentication context).
56
57
58
59
60
155
9.1.8.3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Upon receipt of an LCP Echo-Reply message, an LCP Code-Reject (see RFC 1661 [48]), or
any other packet, the HSGW shall stop and reset the Echo-Reply-Timeout timer, reset the
Echo-Request-Retries counter, and reset the PPP inactivity timer to its full value.
13
17
If the HSGW has received a MAX PPP Inactivity Timer response packet from
the UE, the HSGW shall perform context maintenance as described in section
9.1.9.
14
15
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
9.1.9
Otherwise, the HSGW shall release all context(s) and all A10/A11 resources
associated with the UE.
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
If the UE Context Maintenance timer has a value other than 0, and if any of the following
conditions is met, the HSGW shall release all context(s) associated with the UE except for the
LCP, CCP, A10/A11, and authentication contexts and the HSGW shall start the UE Context
Maintenance timer:
44
49
When the HSGW starts the UE Context Maintenance timer, it shall stop the PPP inactivity
timer.
45
46
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
156
If the HSGW receives a request for one or more PDN Connection(s) from the UE (using
VSNCP Configure-Request) directly over the eHRPD air interface or indirectly via the S101
interface and if the UE Context Maintenance timer is running, then the HSGW shall stop the
UE Context Maintenance timer and re-start the PPP inactivity timer.
1
2
3
4
5
If the UE context maintenance timer expires or if the authentication context becomes invalid
due to e.g., MSK lifetime expiration, the HSGW shall release all context(s) and all A10/A11
resources associated with the UE.
6
7
8
9
10
11
9.1.10
Version Indication
12
The UE and the HSGW should send the 3GPP2 vendor specific Version/Capability packet, as
per X.S0011-002-D [6]. If the 3GPP2 vendor specific Version/Capability packet is not
exchanged, then the UE and the HSGW shall assume the X.S0011 features and functions used
in this specification operate according to X.S0011-D [6].
13
14
15
16
17
Note: In the future it may be necessary to introduce a way to refer to different versions of
X.S0057 when new features are introduced in X.S0057 based on the same version of
X.S0011.
18
19
20
21
22
23
9.1.11
Capability Indication
24
The UE and HSGW shall use the 3GPP2 vendor specific Version/Capability packet, as per
X.S0011-002 [6] to indicate the capabilities listed in the table below. The 3GPP2 vendor
specific Version/Capability packet is specified in section 8 of X.S0011-002 [6].
25
26
27
28
Table 20 and Table 21 are extensions of Table 8 and Table 9 of X.S0011 [6].
29
30
Table 20
31
32
Bit
33
34
35
36
37
38
List of MS Capabilities
MS Capability
Description
C8
C9
C10 to C23
Reserved
39
40
Table 21
41
42
Bit
43
44
45
46
PDSN Capability
C10
C11 to C23
Reserved
Description
Set to 1 if PDSN supports Stale PDN Handling
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
9.1.12
IPCP Handling
IPCP messages (ref. RFC 1332 [47]), when included, are contained in the PCO element in
VSNCP messages between the UE and the HSGW. The PCO is transferred to/from the Proxy
Binding Update/Acknowledgement messages that are sent between the HSGW and the P-GW
on the S2a interface.
To avoid two round-trip IPCP message exchanges, if the UE sets bit C9 (IPCP Nak Handling)
in the MS Capabilities in the 3GPP2 vendor specific Version/Capability packet, the HSGW
may not convert IPCP Configure-Nak messages to IPCP Configure-Ack messages for the UE.
59
60
157
Otherwise, the HSGW should convert the IPCP Configure-Nak to an IPCP Configure-Ack
when, for example, a DNS address is included in the IPCP Configure-Nak.
1
2
3
9.2
In the evolved HRPD system multiple auxiliary service connections may be used for:
1.
2.
Carrying BE traffic - In this case, BE traffic from all PDNs shall be multiplexed
across that auxiliary service connection using PDN-Mux.
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
3.
4.
Carrying multiplexed non-BE traffic over an SO64 service connection using VSNP.
5.
Carrying multiplexed non-BE traffic over an SO72 service connection using PDNMux.
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
6.
In the reverse direction, IP flows are mapped by the UE onto the appropriate link flows for
forwarding to the eAN. If a BE auxiliary service connection is established, the BE IP flows
for all PDNs shall be combined onto the same link flow that is associated with the BE
auxiliary service connection in the reverse direction, and will include a PDN identifier that
identifies the PDN that is the final destination for the traffic. The PDN identifier is inserted
by PDN-Mux that is served by the link flow that carries BE traffic. The PDN Mux is
associated to the link flow by a successful negotiation of protocol ID 0x08 between a UE and
an eAN. This default auxiliary A10 best effort service connection is signaled to the HSGW
on an A11-Registration Request message indicating service option 72 (IP packet framing,
PDN multiplexing). Similarly in the forward direction the HSGW shall combine BE traffic
from all PDNs onto the BE auxiliary service connection, if one is established using a PDN
identifier to identify the source PDN. Otherwise, if a BE auxiliary service connection is not
established, the main service connection is used to carry BE traffic using the VSNP protocol.
The auxiliary service connections are illustrated in Figure 40.
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
In the legacy HRPD system multiple service connections between the PDSN and AT are
established to satisfy the QoS characteristics of different IP flows.
56
57
58
59
60
158
PMIP
PDN2
PMIP
PDN1
2
3
4
HSGW
TFT-3
TFT-1
PMIP
PDN3
TFT-5
TFT-4
TFT-2
6
7
9
IP Flow 3
DSCP (AF)
IP Flow 2
DSCP (BE)
IP Flow 1
DSCP (BE)
8
10
11
12
Link-to-PDN Mapping
IP Flow 4
DSCP (EF)
IP Flow 5
DSCP (AFxx)
ROHC
ROHC
Link-to-PDN Mapping
Link-to-PDN Mapping
13
A10-4
A10-3
A10-2
17
16
A10-1
15
14
eAN/
ePCF
18
21
22
23
20
19
ROHC
ROHC
24
25
UE
26
27
28
IP Flow 2
DSCP (BE)
IP Flow 3
DSCP (AF)
IP Flow 4
DSCP (EF)
IP Flow 5
DSCP (AFxx)
Application 1
PDN-1
Application-2
PDN-2
Application-3
PDN-1
Application (VoIP)
PDN-2
Application (VoIP)
PDN-3
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
Figure 40 provides an illustrative example of a UE connecting to three different PDNs. IP flows 1 and
2 are combined over a single link flow and separated by a PDN identifier header that indicates to
which PDN each flow corresponds. IP flow #3 is shown as being mapped to a dedicated link flow
which is associated by the HSGW with PDN-1. Similarly IP Flows #4 and #5 are associated with
PDN-2 and PDN-3 respectively and are used for the transport of different grades of VoIP traffic.
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
9.2.1
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
159
9.3
1
2
3
4
9.3.1
The UE requested PDN connectivity procedure for eHRPD is depicted in Figure 41. The
procedure allows the UE to request connectivity to a new PDN. The default bearer for the
new PDN shall reuse the best effort service connection. The new PDN will also be assigned a
new and unique PDN-ID by the UE. In this procedure, the UE is assumed to be in active
mode via the eHRPD radio. Proxy Mobile IP is used on the PMIP-based S2a interface.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
UE
HSGW
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
PCRF
15
16
1. PPP:VSNCP Configure-Request
(APN, PDN Address, PDN address allocation, PCO, PDN-ID,
Attach Type, Address Allocation Cause,
IPv4 Default Router Address=empty)
17
18
19
20
3. PPP:VSNCP Configure-Ack
(APN, PDN Address, PCO, PDN-ID, Attach Type,
Address Allocation Cause, IPv4 Default Router Address)
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
1.
2.
3.
When the UE wants to establish connectivity to a PDN, it will send the VSNCP Configure-Request
message (APN, PDN Address, PDN Type, Protocol Configuration Options, Attach Type, Address
Allocation Cause, and IPv4 Default Router Address). The Address Allocation Preference (contained
within the Protocol Configuration Options) indicates whether the UE wants to perform the IPv4 address
allocation during the execution of the procedure and PDN Type indicates that the UE is capable of
supporting IPv4 and IPv6. The HSGW verifies that the APN provided by UE is allowed by
subscription. If the UE supports NW Requested Bearer Control, then the UE includes the MS Support
of Network Requested Bearer Control indicator parameter in the Protocol Configuration Options.
The HSGW triggers the procedures for UE requested PDN connectivity described in TS 23.402 Section
6.2.1-1 Steps 4-10 inclusive (ref. TS 23.402 [25]). This establishes the bindings at the new P-GW and it
updates the PCRF with the indication of the new connection.
After the HSGW receives the indication of the completion of PMIPv6 procedures, it will send the
VSNCP Configure-Ack (APN, PDN Address, PCO, PDN-ID, Attach Type, Address Allocation Cause,
and IPv4 Default Router Address) message to the UE. The Protocol Configuration Options parameter
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
160
indicates the Selected Bearer Control Mode only if the UE included the MS Support of Network
Requested Bearer Control indicator (BCM) parameter in the corresponding VSNCP Configure-Request
message.
1
2
3
4
5
4.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in RFC
3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID configuration option. This message contains the APNAMBR, if the the APN-AMBR was received from the HSS/AAA.
5.
The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message. The UE includes APN-AMBR, if it received
APN-AMBR in step 4, and if the UE supports APN-AMBR.
6.
IPv4 address allocation may occur at this point using the procedure shown in section 4.4.6.2 steps 9-12
and section 4.4.6.3, steps 9-16, when the IPv4 address allocation is deferred.
7.
IPv6 address allocation may occur at this point using the procedure shown in section 4.4.6.4 steps 9-11.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
9.4
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
9.5
46
47
48
49
50
If the receiver has one or more active PDN connection(s) that is/are not included in
the 3GPP2 Vendor Specific Extension of LCP Echo-Request packet with the
information element identifier set to 00000001 (Active VSNCP Context
Identifiers), then the receiver shall release the corresponding VSNCP context.
If the receiver does not have a PDN connection associated with one or more PDN
Identifier(s) included in the 3GPP2 Vendor Specific Extension of LCP Echo-Request
packet with the information element identifier set to 00000001 (Active VSNCP
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
161
Context Identifiers), then the receiver shall send a 3GPP2 Vendor Specific Extension
of the LCP-Echo-Request packet with the information element identifier set to
00000001 (Active VSNCP Context Identifiers), as specified in section 9.6.
1
2
3
4
If the UE has gone out of coverage for a period of time, then the UE may send a 3GPP2
Vendor Specific Extension of the LCP-Echo-Request packet with the information element
identifier set to 00000001 (Active VSNCP Context Identifiers) after returning to service
coverage.
5
6
7
8
9
10
9.6
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Code
Identifier
Length
22
Magic-Number
26
23
24
25
27
Data
28
29
30
31
Code
Identifier
Length
Magic-Number
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
Data
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
162
1
2
3
4
5
9.6.1
6
7
Table 23
8
9
0
MSB
10
11
7
LSB
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
The sender sets this field to the type of 3GPP2 Vendor Specific
Information Element Structure in LCP Echo-Request packet:
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
Table 24
Information Element
Identifier
Description
31
32
33
34
00000001
Others
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
163
1
2
3
This section provides the message flows for the different session release scenarios.
4
5
10.1
7
8
9
10
10.1.1
11
12
The procedures for UE-requested PDN disconnect are based on the procedures in Clause 6.4.1
in TS23.402 [25]. The eHRPD radio specific portion of this procedure is described in
C.S0087 [15].
13
14
15
16
17
18
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
19
20
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
21
22
23
1. VSNCP Terminate-Request
(PDN-ID)
24
2. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
(PDN-ID)
26
25
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
9. Air Interface
Procedures
10. A11-RRQ
(Active Stop,
Lifetime = 0)
7. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
8. P-BA
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
11. A11-RRP
41
42
43
44
45
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the HSGW. The request contains the PDN-ID of
the PDN with which the UE is closing the connection.
46
47
48
49
50
2.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the UE to indicate that it received the request to
terminate a connection to a PDN.
51
3.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as
specified in TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for the
associated PDN for this UE.
54
52
53
55
56
57
58
59
60
164
4.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration. The MN NAI identifies the UE to deregister from the P-GW. The APN
is needed in order to determine which PDN to deregister the UE from, as some P-GWs may
support multiple PDNs.
5.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN
corresponding to the UE's PDN connection in a Session Termination Request message.
6.
7.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP
CAN Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
8.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends PBA
message (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the HSGW.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
If all PDN connections with the UE are terminated, the HSGW initiates STa session termination (Not
shown in the figure).
9.
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated exclusively
with the terminated PDN connections.
10. If the radio interface is modified by step 9, the eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to
update A10 connections mapping info to the HSGW.
11. If step 10 occurs, the HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply.
If the UE or HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then either entity may initiate
detach procedures.
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
165
10.1.2
This section describes the message flows for the UE initiated detach procedure. The UE can
initiate the detach procedure, for example, when the associated PPP session is terminated.
This call-flow depicts the usage of LCP Terminate-Request/Ack to release the PPP session.
The eHRPD radio specific portion of this procedure is described in C.S0087 [15].
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
10
11
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
12
13
14
1. LCP Terminate-Request
15
16
17
2. LCP Terminate-Ack
3. Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure
4. P-BU
(Lifetime = 0)
18
19
20
21
22
24
23
25
26
8. P-BA
7. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
27
28
29
30
31
32
13.Air Interface
Procedures
33
34
11. A11RegistrationUpdate
12. A11RegistrationAcknowledge
14. A11Registration
Request
( Lifetime = 0)
15. A11Registration
Reply
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
1.
2.
The HSGW sends an LCP Terminate-Ack to the UE to indicate that it received the request to terminate
the PPP session.
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
166
Steps 3 to 8 are repeated for each APN to which the UE is attached and which is to be
disconnected.
1
2
3
4
5
6
3.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE.
4.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration. The MN NAI identifies the UE to deregister from the P-GW. The APN is
needed in order to determine which PDN to deregister the UE from, as some P-GWs may support
multiple PDNs.
5.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to
the UE's PDN connection by sending a Session Termination Request.
6.
7.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
8.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends a PBA
message (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the MAG.
9.
The HSGW sends Session Termination Request to 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server for releasing the Pi* and
STa Diameter Sessions.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
10. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server responds with a Session Termination Answer.
Note: The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server forwards the Session Termination Request to the 3GPP HSS/AAA
and responds to the HSGW with Session Termination Answer on receiving the response from the 3GPP
HSS/AAA.
11. The HSGW sends an A11-Registration Update message to initiate with the ePCF the release of all A10
connections for the UE. This step may occur immediately after Step 3.
12. The ePCF responds with an A11-Registration Acknowledge message.
13. The UE/eAN may initiate HRPD session update.
14. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request with the lifetime value set to zero to release all A10
connections.
15. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply with lifetime zero.
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
167
10.2
1
2
This section describes the message flows for the network initiated UE detach procedures.
3
4
10.2.1
This section describes the message flows for the network initiated UE detach due to HSS or
AAA initiated release procedures. The HSS can initiate the network initiated detach
procedure, for example, when the user's subscription is removed. The 3GPP AAA Server can
initiate the procedure, for example, upon instruction from OA&M or when the timer for reauthentication/re-authorization has expired. This call flow depicts the usage of the LCP
Terminate-Request procedure to release the PPP session.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
17
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
3. LCP Terminate-Ack
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
10. A11RegistrationUpdate
11. A11RegistrationAcknowledge
33
34
35
9. P-BA
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
13. A11-RRQ
(Lifetime = 0)
43
44
14. A11RegistrationReply
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
168
1.
The HSS/AAA sends an Abort Session Request (ASR) message to the HSGW to detach the UE from
the network.
2.
3.
The UE sends an LCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to terminate
the PPP session.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Steps 4 to 9 are repeated for each APN to which the UE is attached and which is to be
disconnected.
8
9
10
11
4.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE for the
associated PDN.
5.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration. The MN NAI identifies the UE to deregister from the P-GW. The APN is
needed in order to determine which PDN to deregister the UE from, as some P-GWs may support
multiple PDNs.
6.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to
the UE's PDN connection by sending a Session Termination Request.
7.
8.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
9.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends a PBA
message (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the HSGW.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
10. The HSGW sends an A11-Registration Update message to initiate with the ePCF the release of all A10
connections for the UE. This step may occur immediately after Step 3.
11. The ePCF responds with an A11-Registration Acknowledge message.
12. The eAN may initiate HRPD session update. The UE may initiate HRPD session update any time after
step 3.
13. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request with the lifetime value set to zero to release all A10
connections.
14. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply with lifetime zero.
15. The HSGW sends an Abort Session Answer (ASA) to the HSS/AAA.
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
169
10.2.2
This section describes the message flow for the network initiated UE detach due to HSGW
initiated release procedures. The HSGW can initiate the network initiated detach procedure,
for example, when the associated PPP session is terminated. This call-flow depicts the usage
of LCP Terminate-Request/Ack to release the PPP session.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
HSGW
V-PCRF
10
11
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
12
13
14
15
1. LCP Terminate-Request
16
17
18
2. LCP Terminate-Ack
19
20
21
22
4. P-BU
(Lifetime = 0)
23
24
25
26
27
28
7. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
29
30
31
32
33
34
8. P-BA
9. Session Termination Request
10. Session Termination Answer
35
36
37
38
39
40
11. A11RegistrationUpdate
41
42
43
12. A11RegistrationAcknowledge
44
45
46
47
14. A11-RRQ
(Lifetime = 0)
48
49
15. A11RegistrationReply
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
170
1
2
3
1.
2.
The UE sends an LCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to terminate
the PPP session.
Steps 3 to 8 are repeated for each APN to which the UE is attached and which is to be
disconnected.
5
6
7
8
3.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE for the
associated PDN.
4.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration. The MN NAI identifies the UE to deregister from the P-GW. The APN is
needed in order to determine which PDN to deregister the UE from, as some P-GWs may support
multiple PDNs.
5.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to
the UE's PDN connection by sending a Session Termination Request.
6.
7.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
8.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends a PBA
message (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the HSGW.
9.
The HSGW sends a Session Termination Request to 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server for releasing the Pi*
and STa Diameter Sessions.
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
10. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server responds with a Session Termination Answer.
Note: The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server forwards the Session Termination Request to the 3GPP HSS/AAA
and responds to the HSGW with Session Termination Answer on receiving the response from the 3GPP
HSS/AAA.
11. The HSGW sends an A11-Registration Update message to initiate with the ePCF the release of all A10
connections for the UE. This step may occur immediately after step 3. The HSGW initiates STa session
termination (not shown in the figure).
12. The ePCF responds with an A11-Registration Acknowledge message.
13. The eAN may initiate HRPD session update. The UE may initiate HRPD session update any time after
step 2.
14. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request with the lifetime value set to zero to release all A10
connections.
15. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply with lifetime zero.
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
171
10.3
1
2
This section describes the message flows for the network initiated PDN disconnection
procedure.
10.3.1
3
4
5
6
The HSS/AAA, e.g. to support users subscription update, can indicate to a P-GW to remove
one or several PDN connections previously activated by the UE. This section describes the
network initiated PDN disconnection procedure as per the HSS/AAA indication.
8
9
10
11
12
13
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
14
15
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
23
24
25
26
7.BRA
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
10. A11Registration
Request
35
36
37
38
11. A11Registration
Reply
39
40
41
3.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE. The request contains the PDN-ID of the
PDN with which the connection is to be terminated.
4.
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to
terminate a connection to a PDN.
5.
19
22
4. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
(PDN-ID)
2.
18
21
3. VSNCP Terminate-Request
(PDN-ID)
1.
17
20
2. BRI
9. Air Interface
Procedures
16
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
172
6.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
7.
The HSGW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Acknowledgement (BRA) message to the HSGW as
RFC 5846 [88].
8.
9.
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated exclusively with
the terminated PDN connections.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
10. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to update A10 connections mapping info to the
HSGW.
11. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply.
If the UE or HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then either entity may initiate LCP
termination procedures. If the HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then the HSGW
initiates STa session termination (not shown in the figure).
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
173
10.3.2
This section describes the network initiated PDN disconnection procedure as per the P-GW
indication or request.
2
3
4
5
6
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
HSGW
V-PCRF
7
8
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
9
10
11
1. BRI
12
13
2. VSNCP Terminate-Request
(PDN-ID)
3. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
(PDN-ID)
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
5. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
6.BRA
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
9. Air Interface
Procedures
31
32
10. A11Registration
Request
33
34
35
36
11. A11Registration
Reply
37
38
39
40
41
42
The P-GW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Indication (BRI) message to the HSGW as defined in
RFC 5846 [88] indicating a non-handover cause.
2.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE. The request contains the PDN-ID of the
PDN with which the connection is to be terminated.
3.
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to
terminate a connection to a PDN.
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
4.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE.
53
5.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
56
54
55
57
58
59
60
174
6.
The HSGW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Acknowledgement (BRA) message to the HSGW as
defined in RFC 5846 [88].
7.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to
the UE's PDN connection in a Session Termination Request message.
8.
9.
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated exclusively with
the closed PDN connection.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
10. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to update A10 connections mapping info to the
HSGW.
11. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply.
If the UE or HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then either entity may initiate LCP
termination procedures. If the HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then the HSGW
initiates STa session termination (not shown in the figure).
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
175
10.3.3
This section describes the network initiated PDN disconnection procedure as per the HSGW
indication or request
3
4
5
6
7
8
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
9
10
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
11
12
13
1. VSNCP Terminate-Request
(PDN-ID)
14
15
16
17
2. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
(PDN-ID)
18
19
20
21
22
4. P-BU
(Lifetime=0)
23
24
5. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
25
26
27
28
29
6.P-BA
30
31
32
33
34
35
10. A11Registration
Request
36
11. A11Registration
Reply
40
37
38
39
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
1.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE. The request contains the PDN-ID of the
PDN with which the connection is to be terminated.
2.
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to
terminate a connection to a PDN.
49
50
51
52
53
3.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE.
54
4.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration.
57
55
56
58
59
60
176
5.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
6.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends PBA message
(MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the HSGW.
7.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to
the UE's PDN connection in a Session Termination Request message.
8.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated exclusively with
the terminated PDN connection.
10. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to update A10 connections mapping info to the
HSGW.
11. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply.
If the UE or HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then either entity may initiate LCP
termination procedures. If the HSGW finds that all PDN connections have been deleted, then the HSGW
initiates STa session termination (not shown in the figure).
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
177
10.3.4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Roaming
Scenarios
UE
eAN/ePCF
P-GW
HSGW
V-PCRF
11
12
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
13
14
1. VSNCP Terminate-Request
(Reconnect Indication =
Reconnect to this APN
requested)
15
2. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
19
16
17
18
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
7. PCEF-initiated IP-CAN
Session
Termination Procedure
29
30
31
32
8. P-BA
33
34
35
36
9. Air Interface
Procedures
37
10. A11Registration
Request
38
39
40
41
11. A11Registration
Reply
42
43
44
45
46
12. The UE initiates reconnection to the APN per the procedure of section 9.3.1, and the
HSGW selects the geographically or topologically close P-GW for the reconnection.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
1.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE with the Reconnect Indication set to
Reconnection to this APN requested.
57
58
59
60
178
2.
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to
terminate the PDN connection.
3.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE for the
associated PDN connection.
4.
The HSGW sends a PBU (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the P-GW with lifetime value set to zero,
indicating de-registration. The MN NAI identifies the UE to deregister from the P-GW. The APN is
needed in order to determine which PDN to deregister the UE from, as some P-GWs may support
multiple PDNs.
5.
The P-GW informs the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to
the UE's PDN connection by sending a Session Termination Request.
6.
7.
The P-GW deletes the IP CAN session associated with the UE and executes a PCEF-Initiated IP CAN
Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in TS 23.203 [21].
8.
The P-GW deletes existing entries implied in the PBU from its Binding Cache and sends a PBA
message (MN NAI, APN, lifetime=0) to the HSGW.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated exclusively with
the terminated PDN connection.
10. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to update A10 connections mapping info to the
HSGW.
11. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply.
12. The UE uses the procedure of section 9.3.1 to reconnect to the APN, and the HSGW uses subscription
information, operator policy, and knowledge of the location of the HSGW to which the UE is attached
to select a P-GW that is geographically or topologically close to the UE.
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
10.3.5
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
179
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
Roaming
Scenarios
V-PCRF
1
2
H-PCRF
HSS/AAA
0. IP-CAN Session
Modificaiton/Termination
3
4
5
6
7
1. BRI
(PDN-ID)
10
3. VSNCP Terminate-Ack
(PDN-ID)
11
12
13
14
15
5.BRA
6. Session Termination Request
16
17
8. Air
Interface
Procedures
18
19
20
9. A11Registration
Request
10. A11Registration
Reply
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
0.
1.
2.
31
The P-GW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Indication (BRI) message to the HSGW as defined in
RFC 5846 [88]. The BRI indicates the cause of disconnection, such as due to IP-CAN session
modification/termination, or a handover cause resulting from UE handover from eHRPD to E-UTRAN.
34
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Terminate-Request to the UE. The request contains the PDN-ID of the
PDN with which the connection is to be terminated.
32
33
35
36
37
38
39
3.
The UE sends a VSNCP Terminate-Ack to the HSGW to indicate that it received the request to
terminate a connection to a PDN.
40
4.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW no longer applies QoS policy to service data flows for this UE.
43
5.
The HSGW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Acknowledgement (BRA) message to the HSGW as
defined in RFC 5846 [88].
41
42
44
45
46
47
For the case of PDN connection termination due to IP-CAN session modification, the P-GW informs
the HSS/AAA to remove the P-GW identity information and APN corresponding to the UE's PDN
connection in a Session Termination Request message. For the case of handover from eHRPD to EUTRAN, IP-CAN session in the P-GW is maintained and this step and the next step (step 7) are not
performed.
48
7.
54
8.
The UE initiates session configuration procedure to delete any reservations associated with the closed
PDN connection. This can happen anytime after step 3.
56
6.
49
50
51
52
53
55
57
58
59
60
180
9.
2
3
4
5
6
7
The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to update A10 connections mapping info to the
HSGW.
8
9
10
11
10.4
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
The following describes 3GPP2 Mobile IPv6 Mobility Options that carry information from
the P-GW to the HSGW in the BRI or PBA message.
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
10.4.1
3GPP2-Reconnect-Indication
The 3GPP2-Reconnect-Indication IPv6 Mobility Option carries information to assist the UE
in deciding whether to reconnect to the APN associated with this PDN connection. The
format of the 3GPP2-Reconnect-Indication follows.
28
29
30
31
1
2
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
Type
32
3GPP2 Vendor/Organization ID
33
34
35
Length
MO Sub-Type = 2
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
Type:
19
Length:
8 octets.
Vendor/Org-ID:
5535
MO Sub-Type
MO Data:
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
181
2
3
This section defines inter-HSGW mobility procedures for eHRPD. A diagram of an eHRPD
network during inter-HSGW context transfer is shown in Figure 51.
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
P-GW
(LMA)
11
12
13
14
15
IPv
PM
PM
IPv
6(
S2
)
2a
(S
16
17
18
a)
19
20
21
S-HSGW
(MAG)
H1 (signaling)
A10/A11
H2 (bearer)
T-HSGW
(MAG)
22
23
24
25
A10/A11
26
27
28
29
S-eAN/
ePCF
T-eAN/
ePCF
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
When the UE moves to the serving area of a new eAN/ePCF and the eHRPD session is
successfully transferred from the Source eAN/ePCF (S-eAN/ePCF) to the T-eAN/ePCF, if the
S-HSGW is not reachable from the T-eAN/ePCF, then the T-ePCF selects a T-HSGW for the
session. During the A10 session establishment, the T-ePCF sends the T-HSGW the SHSGWs H1 IP address information received from the S-eAN/ePCF. The T-HSGW initiates
context transfer of the HSGW session state from the S-HSGW.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
182
The unidirectional H2 tunnel (traffic flows from the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW) is established
using the per-UE GRE keys that are allocated by the T-HSGW and exchanged between the THSGW and the S-HSGW as part of the H1 signaling. This GRE tunnel carries all the UEs
traffic from the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW. The detailed procedures for the H2 tunnel
establishment, H1 context transfer, and release of the H2 tunnel are specified in the following
sub-sections.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Each HSGW should only indicate that it supports the VSNP Extend Code field per 9.1.5 if all
HSGWs to which it has an H1/H2 interface also support the VSNP Extend Code field.
9
10
11
If a target HSGW receives context from a source HSGW during inter-HSGW context transfer
that includes VSNP Extend Code options negotiated with the UE that the target HSGW
cannot support, then the target HSGW may choose to renegotiate the PDN connection (using
VSNCP), may choose to close the PDN connection, or may choose to re-establish the PPP
session with the UE.
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
If any of the following capabilities is supported by one HSGW, then all the HSGWs that
participate in inter-HSGW context transfer with that HSGW shall also support that feature.
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
MUPSAP
26
27
28
11.1
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
11.1.1
40
41
42
43
Figure 52 illustrates an example call flow for an eHRPD inter-HSGW context transfer when
the UE is active on the eHRPD radio.
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
183
S-HSGW
(S-MAG)
T-eAN/
ePCF
S-eAN/
ePCF
UE
T-HSGW
(T-MAG)
P-GW
(LMA)
PCRF
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
0. The UE has an active session with the P-GW via the S-eAN/ePCF and the S-HSGW
1. Data
1. Data
1. Data
1
2
3
4
1. Data
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
8a. ULR
18
8b. CLR
19
8c. CLA
20
8d. ULA
21
22
9a. Data
23
24
9b. Data
25
9c. Data
26
10. PBU
27
28
11a. Data
11b. Data
29
11c. Data
30
12. PBA
31
14. Data
33
34
35
14. Data
32
36
37
38
19. A11-RRP
20. Data
20. Data
20. Data
20. Data
40
41
21. HI
22. HAck
39
23 Policy interaction
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
26b. A11-RRP
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
184
0.
The UE has a session up and running with the P-GW via the source eAN/ePCF (S-eAN/ePCF) and
source HSGW (S-HSGW).
1.
An end-to-end data path between the UE and the correspondent node is established and the UE can
send/receive packets to/from the network via the S-eAN/ePCF, S-HSGW and P-GW.
2.
The UE and/or the S-eAN decide that the UE will move to the T-eAN.
3.
The S-eAN and T-eAN cooperate using A13 or A16 signaling to move the eHRPD radio session
context to the T-eAN, including the H1 address at the S-HSGW.
4.
The T-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request (RRQ) message to the T-HSGW to signal
the handoff. The message includes the S-HSGWs H1 IP address and MSID of the UE, and sets
the A10 connections for the UE, etc. The T-eAN/ePCF sends this message anytime after step 3.
5.
The T-HSGW accepts the connection and sends an A11-Registration Reply (RRP) message back
to the T-eAN/ePCF with an accept indication.
6.
Triggered by step 4, the T-HSGW sends a Handover Initiate (HI) message (see RFC 5949 [89])
including the MSID to the S-HSGW to request the session context, subscription context, etc. The
message also contains the GRE key(s) that the T-HSGW wants to use for the uni-directional
tunnel(s) (H2 tunnels) between S-HSGW and T-HSGW for data transfer. The GRE keys
correspond to one GRE tunnel for forwarding the uplink data to the T-HSGW and one GRE tunnel
for forwarding the downlink data to the T-HSGW.
7.
The S-HSGW sends a Handover Ack (HAck) message to the T-HSGW with the session context
information TLVs as defined in section 11.3.3. This message includes the following set of
information at a minimum for each established PDN connection: MN-NAI, MN-LL-Identifier,
UEs IPv4 address(es)/IPv6 prefix(es), APNs, User Context Identifier if MUPSAP is in use, TFTs,
P-GW IP address(es), policy context, compression context (e.g., ROHC context), Users AAA
profile with subscription information, PPP state, MSK Info, and MSK lifetime. Other information
may be included if available. The relationship of each PDN-ID with APN, User Context Identifier
if MUPSAP is in use, P-GW address, and GRE key for uplink traffic to the P-GW is included in
the context that is transferred.
8.
In this scenario, the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy perform the HSGW relocation procedure.
Steps 8a to 8d are performed per section 11.3.5. Steps 8a to 8d are required only when the HSGW
relocation procedure is performed.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
8a The T-HSGW indicates to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy that it is the new HRPD serving Gateway
for this UE by sending a Update Location Request (ULR) message. The T-HSGW can initiate
this step after step 7.
37
38
39
40
8b The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy removes the S-HSGW as the Gateway serving the UE. The 3GPP2
AAA Proxy informs the S-HSGW by sending a Cancel Location Request (CLR) command
with the 3GPP2-Cancellation-Type AVP included with the cancellation type field is set to
HSGW Location Update Procedure.
41
42
43
44
45
8c
46
47
8d The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy acknowledges that the T-HSGW is the serving Gateway for the UE
by sending an Update Location Answer (ULA) command to the T-HSGW with a result code
of success.
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
9.
9a. The S-HSGW extracts the downlink packets from the PMIPv6 tunnel from the P-GW and
forwards the downlink packets to the T-HSGW over the downlink GRE tunnel.
9b. A PDN-ID is added in front of the packet and the packet is sent as received from the P-GW.
9c. The T-HSGW performs necessary packet processing operation for these downlink packets and
forwards them to the T-eAN/ePCF. The downlink packets are forwarded to the T-eAN/ePCF
through the T-HSGW and these packets are buffered until they can be delivered to the UE.
59
60
185
10. Triggered by step 8d, the T-HSGW sends a PBU to the P-GW to update the BCE for the UE with
T-HSGWs IP address as the new MAG.
11. 11a. The uplink data packets that the UE is still sending over the S-eAN/ePCF are received at the
S-HSGW.
11b. These packets are forwarded by the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW over the uplink H2 GRE
tunnel. The S-HSGW does not perform any UL packet processing operation on these data packets
(e.g., no HDLC and PPP de-framing of these UL packets received from the S-eAN/ePCF), except
for any reassembly as specified in section 11.3.2. The S-HSGW also forwards any control plane
packets, e.g., RSVP, DHCPv4 etc., from the UE that are sent over the S-eAN/ePCF to the THSGW. The S-HSGW adds an SR-ID in front of the A10 payload, after any necessary segment
reassembly, and puts this as the payload of the uplink H2 GRE tunnel.
Note: The SRID will be the same after the Handoff for each service connection, and thus the THSGW will be able to correlate the traffic with a particular A10 based on the SRID it receives
with the packet.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
11c. The T-HSGW performs all necessary packet processing operations for these uplink packets.
In this specification it is not required for the T-HSGW to wait for the PBA message as specified in
RFC 5213 [80], therefore the HSGW forwards these packets to the P-GW. The UL packets are
sent to the T-HSGW over the H2 UL GRE tunnel. The S-HSGW adds an SRID in front of the A10
payload and puts this as the payload of the H2 UL GRE tunnel.
17
12. The P-GW updates its BCE, switches the data path to the T-HSGW and returns a PBA message to
the T-HSGW to indicate successful operation. Anytime after step 12, the P-GW may perform a
Registration Revocation procedure with the S-HSGW with Revocation Trigger value Inter-MAG
handoff - same Access Types.
23
13. The P-GW sends a BRI to the S-HSGW with Revocation Trigger value set to Inter-MAG handoff
- same Access Types, and receives a BRA.
28
14. Now that the BCE is updated and the data-path is switched, the downlink data packets from the
P-GW start flowing to the T-HSGW. The T-HSGW forwards them to the T-eAN/ePCF. The TeAN/ePCF buffers them until they can be delivered to the UE.
18
19
20
21
22
24
25
26
27
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
20. At this time, both uplink and downlink traffic for the UE are going through the target system. The
UE can begin to send uplink packets as soon as step 15 happens. Also, the T-HSGW begins
forwarding downlink data directly received from the P-GW anytime after step 12.
46
21. Any time after step 11 and after the T-HSGW detects that there has been no data for a
configurable period of time over the H2 tunnel, the T-HSGW sends a HI message to tear down the
forwarding tunnels between the S-HSGW and T-HSGW.
50
22. The S-HSGW sends a HAck message to acknowledge successful teardown of the forwarding
tunnel(s). The S-HSGW deletes all context for the UE.
23. The P-GW interacts with the PCRF (via the Gx interface) to setup the policy associated with the
new bearer(s). This can happen in parallel with the PMIPv6 tunnel set up (i.e., anytime after step
9).
47
48
49
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
186
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
24. 24a. After the T-eAN/ePCF has acquired the UE and is assured that access to the system by the
UE would be directed to the T-eAN/ePCF, it sends an A16-Session Release Indication message to
the S-eAN/ePCF. This message indicates that the session is now under control of the TeAN/ePCF; hence the S-eAN/ePCF can terminate its connection with the S-HSGW and can purge
the session associated with the UE. This step can happen any time after step 15.
24b. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A16-Session Release Indication Ack message to the TeAN/ePCF.
25. 25a. Any time after step 21, the S-HSGW sends an A11-Registration Update message to the SeAN/ePCF to request tearing down the bearer connection with the S-eAN/ePCF.
25b. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Ack message to the S-HSGW.
26. 26a. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message (with lifetime=0) to the SHSGW to tear down the bearer between with the S-eAN/ePCF.
26b. The S-HSGW sends A11-Registration Reply message to the S-eAN/ePCF to confirm the deregistration process.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
187
11.1.2
This section describes inter-HSGW relocation with context transfer when the UE is dormant
on the eHRPD radio interface.
3
4
5
6
T-eAn/
ePCF
S-eAN/
ePCF
UE
S-HSGW
(S-MAG)
T-HSGW
(T-MAG)
PDN GW
(LMA)
PCRF
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
1. Data
1. Data
1. Data
8
9
10
2. Transition from
active to dormant
11
12
13
14
3. Session Establishment
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
8a. ULR
23
8b. CLR
24
8c. CLA
25
8d. ULA
26
27
28
9. A11-RRP
10a. Data
10a. Data
10b. Data
10c. Data
29
30
31
32
12. PBA
33
34
14. Data
14. Data
35
36
37
38
18 Policy
interaction
39
40
41
42
43
20b. A11-RRP
44
45
46
47
48
49
0.
The UE has an active session up and running with the P-GW via the source eAN/ePCF (SeAN/ePCF) and source HSGW (S-HSGW).
1.
An end-to-end data path between the UE and the correspondent node is established and the UE
can send/receive packets to/from the network via the S-eAN/ePCF, S-HSGW and P-GW.
2.
3.
After crossing the mobility boundary (footprint) of the current serving eAN/ePCF, the UE
requests a session to be established between the UE and the target eAN/ePCF. During this
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
188
procedure, the target eAN/ePCF receives the UATI of an existing eHRPD session (if available).
The UATI can be used as an identifier for the existing eHRPD session when the target eAN/ePCF
attempts to retrieve the existing eHRPD session state information from the source eAN/ePCF.
1
2
3
4
5
4.
6
7
4 b. The S-eAN/ePCF validates the A13-Session Information Request and sends the requested
eHRPD user session information to the T-eAN/ePCF in an A13-Session Information Response
message.
8
9
10
11
4c. The T-eAN/ePCF sends an A13-Session Information Confirm to the S-eAN/ePCF to indicate
that T-eAN/ePCF has received the eHRPD session information. Upon receipt of the A13-Session
Information Confirm message the S-eAN/ePCF deletes the associated session information.
12
13
14
15
16
5.
The T-eAN/ePCF sends A11-Registration Request message to the T-HSGW to signal the handoff.
The request includes the S-HSGWs H1 IP address and MSID of the UE, and sets the A10
connections for the UE, etc. The T-eAN/ePCF sends this message anytime after step 4a.
6.
Triggered by step 5, the T-HSGW sends a Handover Initiate (HI) message, see RFC 5949 [89],
including the MSID to the S-HSGW to request the session context, subscription context, etc. The
message also contains the GRE key(s) that the T-HSGW wants to use for the uni-directional
tunnel(s) between S-HSGW and T-HSGW for data transfer. The GRE keys correspond to one
GRE tunnel for forwarding the uplink data to the T-HSGW and one GRE tunnel for forwarding
the downlink data to the T-HSGW.
7.
The S-HSGW sends a Handover Ack (HAck) message to the T-HSGW with the session context
information TLVs as defined in section 11.3.3. This message includes the following set of
information at a minimum for each established PDN connection: MN-NAI, MN-LL-Identifier,
UEs IPv4 address(es)/IPv6 prefix(es), APNs, User Context Identifier if MUPSAP is in use, TFTs,
P-GW IP address(es), policy context, compression context (e.g., ROHC context), Users AAA
profile with subscription information, PPP state, MSK Info, and MSK lifetime. Other information
may be included if available. The relationship of each PDN-ID with APN, User Context Identifier
if MUPSAP is in use, P-GW address, and GRE key for uplink traffic to the P-GW is included in
the context that is transferred.
8.
In this scenario, the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy perform the HSGW relocation procedure.
Steps 8a to 8d are performed per section 11.3.5. Steps 8a to 8d are required only when the HSGW
relocation procedure is performed.
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
8a. The T-HSGW indicates to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy that it is the new serving Gateway for this
UE by sending a Update Location Request (ULR) command. The T-HSGW can initiate this step
after step 7.
40
41
42
43
8b. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy removes the S-HSGW as the Gateway serving the UE.The
3GPP2AAA Proxy informs the S-HSGW by sending a Cancel Location Request (CLR) command
with the 3GPP2-Cancellation-Type AVP included with the cancellation type field is set to
HSGW Location Update Procedure.
44
45
46
47
48
8c. The S-HSGW acknowledges with a Cancel Location Answer (CLA) command.
49
50
8d. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy acknowledges that the T-HSGW is the serving Gateway for the UE
by sending a Update Location Answer (ULA) command to the T-HSGW with code success.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
4a. The T-eAN/ePCF sends an A13-Session Information Request message to the S-eAN/ePCF to
request the eHRPD session information for the UE. The A13-Session Information Request
message shall include the UATI, the Security Layer Packet and the Sector ID of the serving cell.
9.
The T-HSGW accepts the connection and sends an A11-Registration Reply Message back to the
T-eAN/ePCF with an accept indication.
10. 10a. If any downlink data arrives at the S-HSGW during this procedure, the S-HSGW extracts the
downlink packets from the PMIPv6 tunnel from the P-GW and forwards the downlink packets to
the T-HSGW over the downlink GRE tunnel.
59
60
189
10b. A PDN-ID is added in front of the packet and the packet is sent as received from the P-GW.
10c. The T-HSGW performs necessary packet processing operation for these downlink packets
and forwards them to the T-eAN/ePCF. The downlink packets are forwarded to the T-eAN/ePCF
through the T-HSGW and these packets are buffered until they can be delivered to the UE. The TeAN will use normal paging procedures to place the UE on a traffic channel and subsequently
deliver the data. This is not shown in the figure.
11. Triggered by step 8d, the T-HSGW sends a PBU to the P-GW to update the BCE for the UE with
T-HSGWs IP address as the new MAG.
12. The P-GW/LMA updates its BCE, switches the data path to the T-HSGW (new MAG) and returns
a PBA message to the T-HSGW to indicate successful operation. Anytime after this step, the
P-GW may perform a Registration Revocation procedure with the S-HSGW with Revocation
Trigger value Inter-MAG handoff - same Access Types.
3
4
5
6
7
9
10
11
12
13
14
13. The P-GW sends a BRI to the S-HSGW and receives a BRA.
15
14. Now that the BCE is updated and the data-path is switched, the downlink data packets from the
P-GW start flowing to the T-HSGW. The T-HSGW forwards them to the T-eAN/ePCF. The TeAN/ePCF buffers them until they can be delivered to the UE.
17
15. The T-HSGW interacts with the PCRF (via the Gxa interface) to set up the policy associated with
the bearer(s) of the UE. This step can happen anytime after step 7.
16
18
19
20
21
22
16. After receipt of the PBA message (step 12) and after the T-HSGW detects that there has been no
data for a configurable period of time over the H2 tunnel, the T-HSGW sends a HI message to tear
down the forwarding tunnels between the S-HSGW and T-HSGW.
23
17. The S-HSGW sends a HAck message to acknowledge successful teardown of the forwarding
tunnel(s). The S-HSGW deletes all context for the UE.
27
18. The P-GW interacts with the PCRF (via the Gx interface) to setup the policy associated with the
new bearer(s). This can happen in parallel with the PMIPv6 tunnel set up (i.e., anytime after step
11).
19. 19a. Any time after step 6, the S-HSGW sends A11-Registration Update message to S-eAN/ePCF
to request tearing down of the bearer connections with the S-eAN/ePCF.
19b. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Ack message to the S-HSGW.
20. 20a. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message (with lifetime=0) to the SHSGW to tear down the bearer between with the S-eAN/ePCF.
20b. The S-HSGW sends an A11-Registration Reply message to the S-eAN/ePCF to confirm the
de-registration process.
24
25
26
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
190
1
2
3
11.2
The UE performs handoff to a Target eAN (T-eAN) where the T-eAN selects a T-HSGW.
Since there is no trust relationship between the T-HSGW and S-HSGW, in this example, the
T-HSGW requires the UE to perform LCP, CCP, and attach procedures for the PDNs the UE
is connected to. The UE shall set the Attach-Type in the VSNCP procedure to handover in
this case.
5
6
7
8
9
10
Handoff without context transfer will occur if there is no H1/H2 connectivity to the source
HSGW, or if for some reason the context transfer signaling exchange fails. This procedure
may not be necessary in a network with reliable H1/H2 connectivity between all HSGWs.
11
12
13
14
15
16
S-eAN/
ePCF
UE
17
18
19
20
S-HSGW
(S-MAG)
T-eAn/
ePCF
T-HSGW
(T-MAG)
PDN GW
(LMA)
PCRF
HSS/
3GPP
AAA
1. Data
1. Data
1. Data
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
3. HRPD session
transfer
28
29
5. A11-RRP
30
31
32
33
34
35
6. PPP: LCP-Configure-Req
6a. EAP-AKA'
36
37
38
7. Steps 8 to 17 of S2a attach procedures (see Section 5.4.1) using attach type of handover
39
8. Binding Revocation
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
191
0.
1.
The UE has an active session up and running with the P-GW via the source eAN/ePCF (SeAN/ePCF) and source HSGW (S-HSGW).
An end-to-end data path between the UE and the correspondent node is established and the UE
can send/receive packets to/from the network via the S-eAN/ePCF, S-HSGW and P-GW.
1
2
3
4
5
3.
4.
Anytime after step 3, the T-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message to the THSGW to signal the handoff. The request includes the S-HSGWs IP address, the MSID of the
UE, the existing A10 connection information for the UE, etc.
11
The T-HSGW accepts the connection and sends an A11-Registration Reply Message back to the
T-eAN/ePCF with an accept indication.
15
The assumption in this flow is that an H1 interface does not exist between the S-HSGW and THSGW. Therefore, since the T-HSGW does not have an authentication context for the UE, the THSGW sends an LCP Configure-Request to the UE.
18
6a. The UE, HSGW, and AAA Server continue the LCP negotiation procedures. EAP-AKA is
executed as the authentication protocol. CCP negotiation is performed if needed.
22
2.
5.
6.
Steps 7-9 are repeated for each PDN connection that the UE had on the S-HSGW.
7.
The UE and the eHRPD network perform the steps for PDN bearer establishment. These steps are
described in step 8 to 17 in Section 5.4.1. The following changes are required to the flow in
Section 5.4.1:
i. Step 8 in Section 5.4.1: the VSNCP Configure-Request message has the Attach Type
set to Handover to indicate to the network that the UE has previously established
state with the EPC network. The UE sets the IP address to the previously assigned IP
address(es) in the PDN Address Option.
8.
9.
The P-GW sends a PMIPv6 Binding Revocation Indication to the S-HSGW and receives an
acknowledgement. The Revocation Trigger value is Inter-MAG handoff - same Access Types.
If the Selected Bearer Control Mode of the PCO option is set to is Network only mode or
MS/NW, then the network initiates QoS update procedures to setup all dedicated bearers on the
T-HSGW for that PDN connection. Otherwise, the UE performs the UE initiated QoS update
procedures for that PDN connection.
10. 10a. The S-HSGW sends a Session Termination Request to the HSS/AAA per TS 29.273 [36].
10b. The HSS/AAA sends a Session Termination Answer to the S-HSGW.
11. 11a. The S-HSGW sends an A11-Registration Update message to S-eAN/ePCF to request tearing
down of the bearer connections with the S-eAN/ePCF. This step may occur any time after step 8.
11b. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Ack message to the S-HSGW.
7
8
10
12
13
14
16
17
19
20
21
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
12. 12a. The S-eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message with lifetime=0 to the SHSGW to tear down the bearer with the S-eAN/ePCF.
52
12b. The S-HSGW sends an A11-Registration Reply message to the S-eAN/ePCF to confirm the
de-registration process.
55
53
54
56
57
58
59
60
192
1
2
3
11.3
Inter-HSGW Stage 3
4
5
6
7
11.3.1
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
In order to establish a per-UE unidirectional GRE H2 tunnel, the HSGW shall use GRE as
defined in RFC 2784 [57], Key and Sequence Number Extensions to GRE as defined in RFC
2890 [58], and the GRE Key option defined in RFC 5845[87] to exchange the required perUE GRE keys when sending the HI message. In this specification, the T-HSGW shall include
two instances of the GRE Key Option. The first instance shall contain the H2 GRE Key for
the UE downlink traffic. The second instance shall contain the H2 GRE Key for the UE
uplink traffic. These two GRE Keys are used for traffic going from the S-HSGW to the THSGW for the UE.
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
If segmentation is being used on an A10 connection between the S-ePCF and the S-HSGW,
the S-HSGW shall reassemble the uplink PDU before sending the PDU over H2 to the THSGW.
26
27
28
29
30
For the details of encapsulation of the UE downlink and uplink traffic over the H2 GRE
tunnel, see section 11.3.4.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
11.3.2
HSGW Requirements
The S-HSGW shall set its MSK to either the value of the MSK received from the AAA or to
the value of the MSK Info received from another HSGW.
The S-HSGW shall use the 128 most significant bits of the MSK (Sub-MSK) as the Master
Session Key for the derivation of PMKs. The S-HSGW shall declare the remaining portion of
the received MSK as the unused MSK information. The S-HSGW shall set the value of the
MSK Lifetime Info TLV to the remaining lifetime of the authorized session.
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
The S-HSGW shall include the MSK Info TLV only if the unused portion of the MSK
information is 128 bits, the Target HSGW is trusted, and the link between the HSGWs is
secure (e.g., IPsec). At the inter-HSGW handoff, if the MSK Info TLV is included, the SHSGW shall set the value of the MSK Info TLV to the unused portion of the MSK
information. The T-HSGW shall set its MSK to the value of the MSK Info TLV and act as
defined above.
52
53
54
55
56
57
If the lifetime of the received MSK Info is close to expiry, or if the length of the received
MSK Info is equal to 128 bits, or if the MSK Info TLV is not received, the T-HSGW shall
initiate the authentication as soon as possible to continue with the session. When the new
MSK AVP is received from the AAA, the T-HSGW shall deprecate the current MSK value
58
59
60
193
and replace it with the value received in the MSK AVP. The T-HSGW shall derive the new
PMK from the new MSK as specified in section 4.2.2.3.
1
2
3
It is optional for the HSGW to support inter-HSGW handoff without context transfer. If the THSGW receives an A11-Registration Request and the T-HSGW cannot obtain a PPP context
for the UE from the S-HSGW, then the T-HSGW shall send an LCP Configure-Request
message to UE.
11.3.3
6
7
8
10
11
This section defines the TLVs that are needed for the transfer of context parameters between
the S-HSGW and T-HSGW. The format of the context parameters TLVs is illustrated in
Table 25.
Table 25
16
Type
13
14
15
16
12
17
24
31
Length
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Field Name
Length
Description
Type:
2 octets
Length:
2 octets
Context
variable
Parameter Data:
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
In the case of full context transfer, all the context parameters identified in this section shall be
transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW. In the case of partial context transfer, only the
context parameters that are explicitly identified in each of the sub-sections shall be transferred
from the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW.
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
194
11.3.3.1
User NAI
This TLV is of the following format. It carries the NAI of the user. This context parameter
shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer
and in the partial context transfer.
3
4
5
6
Table 26
7
8
9
10
31
Length
Type
11
24
12
13
NAI...
14
15
16
17
18
Type: 0xFF01
19
Length: 74 octets
20
21
NAI: This NAI is associated with the user and is received from the 3GPP AAA upon
succesful EAP authentication in the Permanent User Identity IE (Mobile-Node-Identitfier
AVP). The format is specified in TS 23.003 [19].
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
11.3.3.2
User MSID
This TLV is of the following format. It carries the MSID of the user. This context parameter
shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer
and in the partial context transfer.
31
32
Table 27
33
34
24
31
35
Type
36
Length
37
38
39
MSID
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Type: 0xFF02
Length: 22 octets
MSID: This is the MSID associated with the UE as received from the eAN via A11 messages.
The format of this field is as per the Session Specific Extension defined in A.S0017-D [5].
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
195
11.3.3.3
LCP Info
This TLV contains the parameters negotiated via the LCP during PPP connection
establishment between the HSGW and the UE. This context parameter shall be transferred
from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer and in the partial
context transfer.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Table 28
0
16
24
31
10
11
Type
Length
12
13
14
HP
UP
HA
UA
Reserved
15
16
17
HSGW-Magic Number
18
19
20
UE-Magic Number
21
22
HSGW-MRU
UE-MRU
23
24
25
HSGW-Auth-Proto
UE-Auth-Proto
26
27
28
29
30
Type: 0xFF03
31
32
Length: 24 octets
HP-bit (HSGW PFC): When set, this bit indicates that the HSGW has negotiated PFC (see
RFC 1661 [48]). Otherwise, it indicates that the HSGW has not negotiated PFC with the UE.
UP-bit (UE PFC): When set, this bit indicates that the UE has negotiated PFC (see RFC 1661
[48]). Otherwise, it indicates that the UE has not negotiated PFC with the HSGW.
HA-bit (HSGW ACFC): When set, this bit indicates that the HSGW has negotiated ACFC
(see RFC 1661 [48]). Otherwise, it indicates that the HSGW has not negotiated ACFC with
the UE.
UA-bit (UE ACFC): When set, this bit indicates that the UE has negotiated ACFC (see RFC
1661 [48]). Otherwise, it indicates that the UE has not negotiated ACFC with the HSGW.
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
HSGW-Magic Number: This field carries the Magic Number negotiated by the HSGW with
the UE and is coded per the Magic Number definition in RFC 1661 [48].
47
UE-Magic Number: This field carries the Magic Number negotiated by the UE with the
HSGW and is coded per the Magic Number definition in RFC 1661 [48].
46
48
49
50
51
HSGW-MRU: This field carries the Maximum-Receive-Unit negotiated by the HSGW with
the UE and is coded per the MRU definition in RFC 1661 [48].
52
UE-MRU: This field carries the Maximum-Receive-Unit negotiated by the UE with the
HSGW and is coded per the MRU definition in RFC 1661 [48].
55
53
54
56
57
58
59
60
196
1
2
UE-Auth-Proto: This field carries the Authentication-Protocol negotiated by the UE with the
HSGW and is coded per the Auth-Proto definition in RFC 1661 [48].
3
4
5
6
7
11.3.3.4
CCP Info
This TLV contains the parameters negotiated via CCP during PPP connection establishment
between the HSGW and the UE. These fields are defined in RFC 1962 [49]. This context
parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context
transfer and in the partial context transfer.
9
10
11
12
13
Table 29
14
15
16
16
17
Type
Length
HSGW-Comp-Proto
UE-Comp-Proto
18
31
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Type: 0xFF04
26
27
Length: 8 octets
28
HSGW-Comp-Proto: This field carries the CCP configuration option sent by the HSGW
during CCP exchange with the UE.
29
30
31
UE-Comp-Proto: This field carries the CCP configuration option sent by the UE during CCP
exchange with the HSGW.
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
11.3.3.5
39
40
Table 30
41
42
24
31
43
Type
44
Length
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
Type: 0xFF05
Length 5 octets
List of PDN IDs: The list of 1 octet long PDN IDs for the UE. At least 1 PDN ID shall be
present for the UE.
58
59
60
197
11.3.3.6
PDN Info
This TLV contains the PDN specific common info and shall be used only if MUPSAP is not
supported at the S-HSGW. This TLV shall be repeated for each connected PDN at the SHSGW. This context parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in
the case of full context transfer.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Table 31
0
16
24
31
10
11
Length
Type
12
13
PDN ID
14
Reserved
15
16
17
APN
18
19
20
Type: 0xFF06
11.3.3.7
21
22
24
23
25
APN: This field carries the Access Point Name that is associated with the PDN Identifier. See
TS 24.302 [28]. The HSGW shall inspect the APN. If it is the emergency APN, the HSGW
shall note that the UE is involved in emergency services relative to this PDN ID.
27
PCO Info
31
This TLV contains the PCO for a given PDN connection. This TLV shall be repeated for each
connected PDN at the S-HSGW. This context parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to
the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
33
26
28
29
30
32
Table 32
0
36
38
24
Type
35
37
34
Length
31
39
40
41
42
43
PDN ID
Reserved
44
45
46
PCO
47
48
49
50
51
Type: 0xFF07
52
53
55
54
56
57
58
59
60
198
PCO: This field carries the value portion of the Protocol Configuration Options received from
the UE for the associated PDN Identifier. See TS 24.008 clause 10.5.6.3 [26].
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11.3.3.8
11
12
Table 33
13
14
15
16
24
Type
17
31
Length
18
19
PDN ID
PDN Type
DHCP
Reserved
20
21
IPv6 Prefix
22
23
24
IPv6 Prefix
25
26
27
IPv6 IID
28
29
30
IPv6 IID
31
32
33
IPv6 LLA
34
35
36
IPv6 LLA
37
38
IPv6 LLA
39
40
41
IPv6 LLA
42
43
44
IPv4 Address
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
Type: 0xFF08
Length: = 48 octets
PDN ID: This field carries the 1 octet PDN Identifier.
PDN Type: This field carries the 1 octet PDN Type field. If the PDN Type field indicates that
the PDN is an IPv4 only PDN, the IPv6 Prefix and the IPv6 IID fields and the IPv6 LLA
fields are set to all 0s and the IPv4 Address field carries a non-zero PDN address. If the PDN
60
199
Type field indicates that the PDN is an IPv6 only PDN, the IPv6 Prefix and the IPv6 IID
fields carry non-zero IPv6 prefix and Interface Identifier (IID) information of the PDN. In this
case, the IPv4 Address field and IPv4 Default Router Address field are set to all 0s. If the
PDN Type field indicates that the PDN is a dual stack PDN, the IPv6 Prefix and the IPv6 IID
fields carry non-zero IPv6 prefix and Interface Identifier (IID) information of the PDN. If an
IPv4 Address has been assigned, the IPv4 Address and IPv4 Default Router Address fields
carry non-zero PDN Addresses.
DHCP-bit (1 bit): When set, this bit indicates that DHCPv4 is used to allocate the UEs IPv4
address.
Reserved (15 bits): Reserved for future use. Set to all 0s.
IPv6 Prefix: This field (8 octets long) carries the IPv6 prefix associated with the PDN
connection of the UE.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
IPv6 IID: This field (8 octets long) carries the IPv6 interface identifier assigned to the UE.
15
IPv6 LLA: This field (16 octets long) carries the IPv6 link-local address assigned by the
P-GW used by the HSGW on the access link shared with the UE.
17
IPv4 Address: This field (4 octets long) carries the IPv4 Address is assigned to the UE.
IPv4 Default Router Address: This field (4 octets long) carries the UEs IPv4 default router
address.
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
200
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
11.3.3.9
PMIPv6 Info
This TLV contains the parameters required by T-HSGW (new MAG) to perform PMIPv6
registration with the P-GW (LMA). This TLV is repeated for each of the connected PDNs for
the UE. This context parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in
the case of full context transfer.
Table 34
9
10
11
16
12
Type
13
24
31
Length
14
15
16
PDN ID
TT
Reserved
17
18
PMIPv6 UL GRE
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
Type: 0xFF09
Length: = 28 octets
PDN ID: This field carries the 1 octet PDN Identifier.
TT-flag: This is the 2-bits MAG-LMA transport flag. When this flag is set to 01, it indicates
that the LMA has an IPv4 interface only. In this case, the LMA IPv6 Address field is set to all
0s. When this flag is set to 10, it indicates that the LMA has an IPv6 interface only. In this
case, the IPv4 Address field is set to all 0s. When this flag is set to 11, it indicates that the
LMA has both IPv4 and IPv6 interfaces. In this case, both the IPv6 Address and the IPv4
Address fields carry non-zero values representing the IPv6 address and the IPv4 address of
the LMA respectively. The value of 00 for this flag is reserved.
Reserved: Reserved for future use. Set to all 0s.
PMIPv6 uplink GRE: This field (4 octets long) carries the Uplink GRE key for the PMIPv6
tunnel for the corresponding PDN connection.
LMA IPv6 Address: This field (16 octets long) carries the IPv6 Address of the LMA (P-GW)
for the corresponding PDN connection.
LMA IPv4 Address: This field (4 octets long) carries the IPv4 Address of the LMA (P-GW)
for the corresponding PDN connection.
58
59
60
201
11.3.3.10
This TLV contains the parameters negotiated for ROHC compression. This TLV is repeated
for each Service Connection for which ROHC has been negotiated. This context parameter
shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer
and in the partial context transfer.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Table 35
0
24
31
10
11
Length
Type
12
13
14
SRID
Reserved-1
CM
15
16
Forward/Reverse-MRRU
Forward/Reverse-MAX-CID
17
18
19
LC
Forward/Reverse Profile-Count
Reserved-2
20
21
22
Forward/Reverse Profiles .
23
24
25
26
27
Type: 0xFF0A
28
Length: 24 octets
29
30
31
32
SR-ID: This is the identifier of the service connection associated with this ROHC parameter
set.
34
Forward/Reverse MAX-CID: MAX-CID to be used for this ROHC state. For each direction,
the ROHC parameters shall be specified separately.
Forward/Reverse MRRU: MRRU to be used for this ROHC state. For each direction, the
ROHC parameters shall be specified separately.
LC (Large CID): 1-bit field of type Boolean. If set to 1, indicates whether Large CIDs are
supported of not. Otherwise, set to 0.
Reserved-2: Reserved for future use. Set to all 0s.
Forward/Reverse Profile-Count: Number of profiles supported. This parameter is exchanged
with the UE at the time of ROHC parameter negotiation. This is a binary number.
Forward/Reverse Profiles: n octet-pairs in ascending order, each octet-pair specifying a
ROHC profile supported. See RFC 3095 [60], RFC 3843 [70], RFC 4019 [73], and RFC 5225
[81].
33
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
202
11.3.3.11
ROHC IR Info
This TLV contains the most recent ROHC IR packet for a given Context ID. This TLV is
repeated for each flow with a unique Context ID. This context parameter shall be transferred
from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer and in the partial
context transfer.
3
4
5
6
7
8
Table 36
10
11
12
24
Type
Length
SRID
Reserved
31
13
14
15
16
17
ROHC IR Packet
18
19
20
21
Type: 0xFF0B
22
Length: 8 octets
23
24
SRID: This is the identifier of the service connection associated with this ROHC parameter
set.
25
26
27
28
ROHC IR Packet: ROHC IR packets for a flow identified by its Context ID, as per RFC 3095
[60] and RFC 5225 [81].
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
11.3.3.12
QoS Info
This TLV contains the parameters related to QoS for the UE. This TLV is repeated for each
FlowID for which QoS parameters have been negotiated. This context parameter shall be
transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer and in the
partial context transfer.
39
Table 37
40
41
42
16
43
Type
Length
FlowID
Granted FlowProfileID
Updated FlowProfileID
Requested FlowProfileIDs
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
Authorized FlowProfileIDs
55
56
57
58
Type: 0xFF0C
Length: 12 octets
59
60
203
31
Flow ID: This is the Flow ID for which the following QoS parameters are reported.
1
2
Granted FlowProfileID:
This is the initial granted FlowProfileID for the Flow ID. See: X.S0011 [6].
4
5
6
Updated FlowProfileID:
This is the most recently sent updated FlowProfileID for the Flow ID. See: X.S0011
[6].
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
Requested FlowProfileIDs:
16
This is the list of requested FlowProfileIDsfor the Flow ID. See: X.S0011 [6]. Each
FlowProfileID in the list is two octets long.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Authorized FlowProfileIDs:
25
This is the list of authorized FlowProfileIDs for the Flow ID. See: X.S0011 [6].
Each FlowProfileID in the list is two octets long.
11.3.3.13
17
26
27
28
29
TFTv4 Info
30
This TLV contains the parameters related to IPv4 TFT for the UE. This context parameter
shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
31
32
33
34
Table 38
0
16
35
36
24
31
37
38
Length
Type
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
Type: 0xFF0D
46
48
47
TFT IPv4 IE Type #0: This is the IPv4 TFT object as defined in X.S0011 [6].
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
204
11.3.3.14
TFTv6 Info
This TLV contains the parameters related to IPv6 TFT for the UE. This context parameter
shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
3
4
5
Table 39
6
7
8
9
31
Length
Type
10
24
11
12
13
14
15
16
Type: 0xFF0E
17
18
19
TFT IPv6 IE Type #0: This is the IPv6 TFT object as defined in X.S0011 [6].
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
11.3.3.15
30
Table 40
31
32
33
34
8
Type
35
24
31
Length
36
37
Diameter AVPs
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
Type: 0xFF0F
Length: > 4 octets
Diameter AVPs: This field contains one or more AAA AVP(s) related to authorization of the
users packet data service in the eHRPD system.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
205
11.3.3.16
Gxa Info
This TLV contains the Gxa rule objects received from the PCRF that includes all the AVPs
(QoS, SDF, charging rules etc.) during PCC transactions for a given UE. This context
parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context
transfer.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Table 41
0
16
24
31
10
11
Length
Type
12
13
14
Gxa AVPs
15
16
17
18
19
Type: 0xFF10
20
21
11.3.3.17
22
Gxa AVPs: Gxa AVPs related to the PCC rule set at the HSGW (BBERF) of the users IPCAN session in the eHRPD system. The PDN information is embedded in the Gxa rule set.
The format of the Gxa AVPs shall be as per TS 29.212 [31].
23
27
This TLV contains the parameters required by specific vendors implementation. This context
parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context
transfer and in the partial context transfer.
29
Table 42
0
24
25
26
28
8
Type
30
31
32
33
24
31
Length
34
35
36
37
38
Vendor-ID
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
Type: 0xFF11
46
47
48
Vendor-ID: This is the vendor identifier for the vendor that has a specific use of this TLV.
Vendor Specific Values: This field is populated based on specific a vendors implementation.
The field is opaque to any implementation that cannot parse this field. In such case, the TLV
should be silently discarded.
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
206
11.3.3.18
MSK Info
This TLV contains the MSK Info AVPs. This context parameter shall be transferred from SHSGW to the T-HSGW in the case of both full context transfer and in the partial context
transfer.
3
4
5
6
Table 43
16
31
Type
10
Length
11
12
13
14
15
16
MSK Info
17
18
19
20
Type: 0xFF12
21
22
Length: 24 octets
23
MSK Lifetime Info: This 4 octet field contains the lifetime of the MSK delivered to the THSGW. This value is of type unsigned 32 and it represents the period of time (in seconds) for
which the MSK Info is valid.
24
25
26
27
MSK Info: This field contains the unused portion of the MSK.
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
11.3.3.19
QoS-Check Info
This TLV contains the parameters related to authorized QoS for the UE during the QoSCheck procedure. This context parameter shall be transferred if an inter-HSGW handoff
occurs after a ResvConf message with opcode QoS-Check Conf has been sent, but before the
TFTs can be sent by the UE in a Resv message once the radio interface procedures for
establishing that IP Flow are complete. See steps 5 and 8 of Figure 23 in section 4.5.4.1.1.
This context parameter shall be transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in the case of
full context transfer.
39
40
Table 44
41
42
43
44
45
24
Type
Length
Flow ID
QoS-Check FlowProfileIDs
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
Type: 0xFF13
Length: 12 octets
58
59
60
207
31
Flow ID: This is the Flow ID for which the following FlowProfileIDs are reported during a
QoS-Check operation.
QoS-Check FlowProfileIDs: This is the list of authorized FlowProfileIDs for the Flow ID
during a QoS-Check operation. See: X.S0011 [6]. Each FlowProfileID in the list is two octets
long.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
11.3.3.20
This TLV contains the authorized IPv4 TFT for the UE during the QoS-Check procedure.
This context parameter shall be transferred if an inter-HSGW handoff occurs between steps 5
and 8 of Figure 23 in section 4.5.4.1.1. This context parameter shall be transferred from SHSGW to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
11
Table 45
0
10
16
Type
13
14
15
16
12
17
24
31
18
19
20
Length
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
Type: 0xFF14
28
29
Length: 4 octets
30
TFT IPv4 IE Type #0: This is the authorized IPv4 TFT object during a QoS-Check operation.
Ref: X.S0011 [6].
31
32
33
34
11.3.3.21
35
36
This TLV contains the authorized IPv6 TFT for the UE during the QoS-Check procedure.
This context parameter shall be transferred if an inter-HSGW handoff occurs after a ResvConf
message with opcode QoS-Check Conf has been sent, but before the TFTs can be sent by the
UE in a Resv message once the radio interface procedures for establishing that IP Flow are
complete. See steps 5 and 8 of Figure 23 in section 4.5.4.1.1. This context parameter shall be
transferred from S-HSGW to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
Table 46
0
16
Type
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
37
46
24
Length
31
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
Type: 0xFF15
57
58
Length: 4 octets
59
60
208
TFT IPv6 IE Type #2: This is the authorized IPv6 TFT object during a QoS-Check operation.
Ref: X.S0011 [6].
1
2
3
4
11.3.3.22
This TLV contains the compression information negotiated for each PDN connection in the
direction HSGW to UE. This context parameter shall be transferred from the S-HSGW to the
T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
6
7
8
9
Table 47
10
11
12
13
14
17
2
4
Type
15
16
1
6
3
1
Length
PDN-ID-1
Count-1
Compression-1-1
Compression-1-n
PDN-ID-2
Count-1
Compression-2-1
Compression-2-n
PDN-ID-3
Count-3
Compression-3-1
Compression-3-n
PDN-ID-m
Count-m
Compression-m-1
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
Compression-m-n
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
Type: 0xFF16
Length: 4 octets
PDN-ID-k: 8 bits - The PDN Identifier assigned to an APN.
Count-k: 8 bits - The count of following octets that comprise the context information for a
single compression protocol, i.e., the count of octets inclusive of Compression-k-1 to
Compression-k-n. The binary value contained in this field shall be 2.
Compression-k-j: size is indicated in the Count-k field.
Following the Count-k octet, the next two octets encode the protocol type with any remaining
octets used for parameters specific to that protocol type. Allowed protocol types are:
0x0003 ROHC small-CID. Coding of the specific parameters shall follow RFC
3241 [61].
Note: If multiple compression protocols are defined for a given APN, the PDN-ID may be
repeated within this TLV and followed by the context information for another compression
protocol.
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
209
11.3.3.23
This TLV contains the compression information negotiated for each PDN connection in the
direction UE to HSGW. This context parameter shall be transferred from the S-HSGW to the
T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
Table 48
0
1
6
4
5
7
2
4
Type
3
1
8
9
10
11
Length
12
PDN-ID-1
Count-1
Compression-1-1
Compression-1-n
PDN-ID-2
Count-1
Compression-2-1
Compression-2-n
PDN-ID-3
Count-3
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Compression-3-1
Compression-3-n
21
22
23
PDN-ID-m
Count-m
Compression-m-1
24
25
26
Compression-m-n
27
28
29
Type: 0xFF17
30
Length: 4 octets
32
31
33
Count-k: 8 bits - The count of following octets that comprise the context information for a
single compression protocol, i.e., the count of octets inclusive of Compression-k-1 to
Compression-k-n. The binary value contained in this field shall be 2.
35
34
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
210
1
2
3
4
5
6
11.3.3.24
7
8
9
10
Table 49
0
11
24
Type
12
31
Length
13
14
User Context
Idenfitier
PDN ID
15
16
17
PDN Connection
ID
APN
Length
APN
18
19
20
...
21
22
23
Reserved-APN-Fill
(as needed to fill to the next 4-octet boundary)
APN
24
25
26
27
28
29
SIPTO
Support
30
31
Reserved
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
Type:
0xFF18
Length: variable
PDN ID:
This field carries the 1 octet PDN Connection ID that was received
APN Length:
APN:
This field carries the Access Point Name that is associated with the PDN Identifier.
See TS 24.302 [28].
Reserved-APN-Fill: 0 to 3 octets to pad to the next 4-octet boundary. These reserved octets
(if any) shall be filled with 00H by the sender and ignored by the receiver.
APN Back-off Timer Remaining: This field carries a 4-octet unsigned integer indicating the
remaining number of seconds that the UE is required to wait before reattempting a PDN
connection to this APN.
SIPTO Support: This field carries the 1 octet SIPTO Support indicator.
56
57
58
59
60
211
11.3.3.25
This TLV contains the VSNP Extend Code information negotiated for each APN connection
in the direction HSGW to UE. This context parameter shall be transferred from the S-HSGW
to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
Table 50
0
16
3
4
5
6
24
31
8
9
Length
Type
10
11
PDN-ID-1
.
.
.
VSNP-Extend-Code
12
...
VSNP-Extend-Code
PDN-ID-2
13
14
15
16
17
...
18
PDN-ID-n
19
...
VSNP-Extend-Code
20
21
22
23
24
Type: 0xFF19
25
Length: 4 octets
26
28
27
29
VSNP-Extend-Code: 8 bits The Forward Link VSNP Extend Code negotiated for that APN
11.3.3.26
30
31
32
This TLV contains the VSNP Extend Code information negotiated for each APN connection
in the direction UE to HSGW. This context parameter shall be transferred from the S-HSGW
to the T-HSGW only in the case of full context transfer.
Table 51
0
16
34
35
36
37
33
38
24
31
39
40
Type
41
Length
42
43
PDN-ID-1
.
.
.
VSNP-Extend-Code
PDN-ID-2
...
VSNP-Extend-Code
44
45
46
47
48
...
PDN-ID-n
49
VSNP-Extend-Code
...
50
51
52
53
54
Type: 0xFF1A
55
Length: 4 octets
56
57
58
59
60
212
VSNP-Extend-Code: 8 bits The Reverse Link VSNP Extend Code negotiated for that APN.
1
2
3
11.3.3.27
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Table 52
12
13
16
24
31
14
Length
Type
15
16
17
18
Mobile Identity
19
20
Type: 0xFF1B
21
22
23
Length: 11 octets
24
Mobile Identity: This is the Mobile Identity supplied by the UE using Mobile Identity
Configuration Option of the VSNCP Configure Request message during Emergency PDN
connection. The format of this field is set to the value portion of the Mobile Identity IE as
defined in Section 10.5.1.4 of 3GPP TS 24.008 [26]. The type of identity shall be set to 001
(IMSI) or to 010 (IMEI) as sent by the UE in the VSNCP Configure-Request message.
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
11.3.4
H2 Stage 3
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
11.3.4.1
H2 Downlink Data
Each downlink data packet shall be encapsulated in an IPv4 or IPv6 packet with a GRE
header. The key present bit of the GRE header is set to 1, and the H2 downlink GRE key is
included in the key field. The source IP address of the packet is set to the S-HSGW H2 IP
address and the destination address is the T-HSGW H2 IP address. The H2 downlink GRE
key identifies the packet as a downlink packet that belongs to the UE. The protocol type field
of the GRE header shall be set to Unstructured Byte Stream (88 81H ref. A.S0017-D [5]).
45
46
47
48
49
The payload packet is always preceded with an 8 bit field that includes the PDN-ID with the 0
bit as the most significant followed by the IPv6/IPv4 payload packet. The outline of the
packet is shown in.
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
213
Table 53
0
8
0000
PDN-ID
24
31
2
3
4
Downlink IP Packet
5
6
7
...
8
9
10
11
PDN-ID: This is the PDN-ID for the PDN connection for this downlink data packet
12
Downlink IP Packet: This is the users IP packet received on a PDN connection from the PGW and being forwarded from the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW and then to the UE.
11.3.4.2
13
14
15
16
H2 Uplink Data
17
Each uplink data packet shall be encapsulated in an IPv4 or IPv6 packet with a GRE header.
The key present bit of the GRE header is set to 1, and the H2 uplink GRE key is included in
the key field. The source IP address of the packet is set to the S-HSGW H2 IP address, and
the destination IP address is the T-HSGW H2 IP address. The H2 uplink GRE key identifies
the packet as an uplink packet that belongs to the UE. The protocol type field of the GRE
header shall be set to Unstructured Byte Stream (88 81H ref. A.S0017-D [5]).
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
The payload packet is always preceded with an 8 bit field that includes the SR_ID associated
with the A10 connection over which this uplink data packet was received with the 0 bit as the
most significant followed by the payload packet. The outline of the packet is shown in Table
17.
Table 54
0
26
27
28
29
30
31
24
31
32
33
34
SR_ID
35
36
37
...
38
39
40
41
SR_ID: This the SR_ID associated with the A10 connection over which this uplink data
packet was received.
A10 GRE Payload: This is the GRE payload received on a specific A10 connection at the SHSGW and being forwarded from the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW.
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
214
11.3.5
The HSGW shall follow the procedure described in this section during an inter-HSGW
relocation with context transfer.
3
4
5
6
7
11.3.5.1
11.3.5.1.1
General
8
9
10
11
12
The Update Location Procedure is used between the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy to
update location information in the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy. The procedure is invoked by the
HSGW and is used to inform the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy about the identity of the HSGW
currently serving the user.
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Table 55
27
28
29
30
31
Information
Element Name
36
37
38
Description
User-Name (See
IETF RFC 3588
[65])
RAT Type
RAT-Type
Supported
Features
SupportedFeatures
(ref. 3GPP TS
29.229 [34])
33
35
Cat.
IMSI
32
34
Mapping to
Diameter AVP
39
40
41
42
43
Table 56
44
45
46
47
48
Information
Element Name
53
54
55
56
57
Description
Result-Code /
ExperimentalResult
Supported
Featues
SupportedFeatures
(ref. 3GPP TS
29.229 [34])
50
52
Cat.
Result
49
51
Mapping to
Diameter AVP
58
59
60
215
11.3.5.1.2
The HSGW shall make use of this procedure to update the HSGW identity stored in the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy. The HSGW uses this procedure during Intra-eHRPD Handoff with the
HSGW Relocation procedure using Context Transfer as defined in this specification.
2
3
4
5
6
If both the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server support the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter
Application and the HSGW needs to update the HSGW identity stored in the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy, the HSGW initiates the HSGW Relocation procedure by sending a Update Location
Request (ULR) command to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy. If the HSGW does not know if the
HSGWReloc feature is supported by the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy, the ULR command shall
include the Supported-Features AVP with the M bit set, the Feature-List-ID sub AVP set to
1 (Query Group), and the Feature-List sub AVP shall have bit 1 set indicating a request for
the HSGW Relocation procedure.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
If a Update Location Answer (ULA) command is received with the Experimental-ResultCode AVP set to DIAMETER_ERROR_FEATURE_UNSUPPORTED, the HSGW shall
abort the HSGW Relocation procedure.
When receiving an Update Location Answer from the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy, the HSGW shall
check the result code. If it indicates other than success the HSGW shall take corrective action
based on the received result code.
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
11.3.5.1.3
26
On receiving the Update Location Request (ULR) command, if the Supported-Feature AVP is
received, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall do one of the following:
28
If it supports all the features indicated in the Supported-Features AVP, the 3GPP2
AAA Proxy/Server shall include the Supported-Features AVP in the ULA command,
identifying the complete set of features that it supports for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter
Application.
27
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
If it does not support all the features indicated in the Supported-Features AVP, the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall return the ULA command with the ExperimentalResult-Code AVP set to DIAMETER_ERROR_FEATURE_UNSUPPORTED and
shall include the Supported-Features AVP identifying the complete set of features
that it supports for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application.
36
If it does not support the Supported-Features AVP, it shall return the ULA command
with the Result-Code AVP set to DIAMETER_AVP_UNSUPPORTED and a FailedAVP containing the Supported-Features AVP as received in the ULR command.
42
If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server includes the Supported-Features AVP in the Update
Location Answer (ULA) command, the Supported-Features AVP shall have the M bit
cleared. In this Grouped AVP, the Feature-List-ID sub AVP shall be set to 1 Query Group;
and the Feature-List sub AVP shall have bits set for the complete set of features supported by
the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server.
46
When receiving an Update Location Request the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall check
whether the IMSI is known. If it is not known, a Result Code of
DIAMETER_ERROR_USER_UNKNOWN
shall be returned.
37
38
39
40
41
43
44
45
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
216
When the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server receives the Update Location Request, it shall send a
Cancel Location Request (CLR; see 7.3.2.1) to the source HSGW and replace the stored
HSGW-Identity with the received value (the HSGW-Identity is received within the OriginHost AVP).
1
2
3
4
5
If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server successfully processes the received Update Location
Request, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall respond with a Update Location Answer with
result code success. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server may send the Update Location Answer
before receiving the Cancel Location Answer from the source HSGW.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
11.3.5.2
11.3.5.2.1
General
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
The Cancel Location procedure shall be invoked by the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server. It is used
between the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server and the HSGW to delete a subscribers session
information due to intra-eHRPD HSGW relocation.
This procedure is mapped to the commands Cancel Location Request/Answer (CLR/CLA) in
the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter application specified in section 6.3.
25
26
27
28
29
Table 57 specifies the involved information elements for the Cancel Location Request.
Table 58 specifies the involved information elements for the Cancel Location Answer.
30
31
32
33
34
Table 59 specifies the 3GPP2 Diameter AVP defined for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter application,
the AVP Code value, type, possible flag values and whether or not the AVP may be
encrypted.
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
217
Table 57
Information Element
Name
IMSI
Mapping to
Diameter AVP
Result
1
2
Cat.
Description
User-Name (See
IETF RFC 3588 [65])
Cancellation
-Type
Table 58
Information
Element Name
Mapping to
Diameter AVP
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Cat.
Result-Code /
ExperimentalResult
12
13
Description
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Table 59
21
3GPP2-Cancellation-Type AVP
22
23
24
25
Attribute Name
AVP Code
Value Type
Must
May
Should not
Must not
May Encr.
26
27
3GPP2-CancellationType
5535/56
Enumerated
M, V
NO
28
29
30
31
32
11.3.5.2.2
33
34
When receiving a Cancel Location Request the source HSGW shall check whether the user
name is known. If it is not known, a result code of DIAMETER_SUCCESS is returned.
35
36
37
38
If it is known and the value of the 3GPP2-Cancellation-Type AVP is HSGW-LocationUpdate-Procedure, the source HSGW shall complete any inter-HSGW context transfer
procedures and then delete all the user session contexts.
11.3.5.2.3
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
If the UE moved to a new HSGW, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall include the 3GPP2
Cancelation Type AVP with a value of "HSGW-Location-Update-Procedure when sending
Cancel Location Request to the source HSGW.
11.3.5.3
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
218
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
There are two types of handoff from E-UTRAN to eHRPD, optimized handoff and nonoptimized handoff.
13
14
15
Section 12.1 provides E-UTRAN to eHRPD optimized handoff flows. Section 12.2 provides
E-UTRAN to eHRPD non-optimized handoff flows.
16
17
18
Optimized handoff uses the S101 interface between the E-UTRAN and eHRPD
access networks to allow the UE to establish and maintain the eHRPD radio session
and HSGW context. This minimizes delay before the UE can send and receive
packets after moving to eHRPD. For active mode optimized handoff, the HSGW
establishes S103 interface (if supported) with S-GW for forwarding the packets from
E-UTRAN to eHRPD.
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
If the UE performs an initial attach on E-UTRAN, then the UE shall delete any eHRPD PPP
context (i.e., LCP, EAP-AKA, VSNCP and RSVP) it may have stored.
33
34
35
36
37
38
For optimized handoff, when the UE accesses eHRPD via the E-UTRAN radio and the S101
tunnel, it shall send a VSNCP Configure-Request message with attach-type set to handover to
the HSGW for each of its existing PDN connections in the EPS system that it intends to
maintain in eHRPD.
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
For non-optimized handoff, when the UE moves to the eHRPD access network, the UE shall
send a VSNCP Configure-Request message with attach type set to handover to the HSGW for
each PDN connection it wants to maintain in eHRPD.
When the UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message as described above, one of two
outcomes will occur:
47
48
49
1.
In the case the HSGW has full or partial context for the UE as described in section
9.1.9, the HSGW shall respond with VSNCP Configure-Ack as described in section
9.1.4. The UE then configures dedicated bearers, for any flows that the HSGW has
not previously established. See sections 12.2.1 and 12.2.2.
2.
In the case the HSGW has no context for the UE, the HSGW shall respond with LCP
Configure-Request (if not already sent). In this case, the UE and network shall
perform LCP negotiation, CCP negotiation as needed, authentication, and then
establish PDN connections and dedicated bearers as described in item (1) of this list.
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
219
12.1
1
2
The flows for the pre-registration and E-UTRAN to eHRPD handoff phases of optimized
handoff are shown in the following subsections.
12.1.1
3
4
5
6
The following flow describes the use of the S101 interface to tunnel eHRPD signaling
between the UE and the eAN/ePCF.
8
9
10
11
12
Roaming
eNB
UE
eAN/
ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP
AAA
Proxy
13
14
vPCRF
hPCRF
HSS/
AAA
15
16
17
18
2. Decision
to preregister with
eHRPD
19
20
21
22
3. eHRPD Session
Establishment
23
24
PPP LCP
Negotiation
selects EAP for
authentication.
4. Device
Authentication (A12)
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
At this point, all HRPD context and IP context has been established. If changes are necessary in these contexts,
e.g., steps 9 and/or 10 may be executed to perform context updates.
41
42
43
9. HRPD Session
Maintenance
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
The UE is initially attached to the E-UTRAN. The UE acquires IPv4 address(es) and/or IPv6 prefix(es).
Data flows between the UE and the P-GW(s) through the eNodeB and the S-GW.
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
220
2.
Based on a Radio Layer trigger, the UE decides to initiate a pre-registration procedure with potential
target eHRPD access. It is assumed that an S101 signalling relationship exists between the MME and
eAN/ePCF.
3.
The UE initiates the establishment of a new session in the eHRPD system through the S101 tunnel.
4.
If RAN-level authentication is required, the UE establishes an AN-PPP connection with the eAN/ePCF
and performs RAN-level authentication using the A12 interface. For details refer to A.S0022 [4].
5.
The eHRPD eAN/ePCF establishes the main A10 connection with the HSGW by exchanging A11Registration Request/Registration Reply messages. The A11-Registration Request message contains an
indication that the access is occurring through the S101 tunnel. For details refer to A.S0022 [4]. This
information is used by the HSGW in step 7 to defer interaction with the P-GW. The UE and HSGW
initiate the PPP connection establishment procedure.
6.
6a-b. The UE performs user authentication and authorization in the eHRPD access system using EAPAKA. The EAP-AKA messages are transferred between the UE and HSGW over PPP. The EAP
authenticator resides in the HSGW. The detailed EAP-AKA authentication flows are specified in
Section 4.2. The 3GPP AAA server authenticates and authorizes the UE for access in the eHRPD
system. The 3GPP AAA server queries the HSS and returns the subscription profile, and APN and
P-GW address pair for each PDN connection to the eHRPD system in this step. The 3GPP AAA server
also returns the NAI to be used to identify the UE in Proxy Binding Update message.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
6c. The HSGW stores the information received from the 3GPP AAA/HSS server.
22
23
24
7.
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
NOTE: The HSGW defers interaction with the P-GW until the UE arrives in eHRPD, at which
time it sends a PBU to the P-GW to complete the PDN connection.
38
39
40
41
8.
43
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
The network initiates resource reservation procedures to establish all dedicated bearers.
At this point the UE is registered in the eHRPD access system and it has been authenticated by the
AAA/HSS.
42
44
The UE exchanges VSNCP messages with the HSGW for each PDN connection (See section 5.4.1 for
details) that it currently has attachments to within E-UTRAN and that it wants to maintain on eHRPD.
The UE sets the Attach Type to handoff in the VSNCP Configure-Request message. Also, the UE
includes the IP address(es) it obtained via LTE in the VSNCP Configure-Request message. If the PDN
Type is IPv6 or IPv4v6, the UE includes the IPv6 HSGW Link Local Address IID option and sets the
value to all zeros in the VSNCP Configure-Request message. The HSGW includes the IPv6 HSGW
Link Local Address IID option and sets the value to the interface ID of the HSGW link local address in
the VSNCP Configure-Ack message. Interactions occur among the HSGW and PCRF per 3GPP
specifications (TS23.402 [25] section 9.3.1). The HSGW exchanges Gateway Control Session
Establishment/Ack messages with the hPCRF to obtain QoS policy rules required to perform bearer
binding update for all the active IP flows. As shown in the figure for the roaming scenario, the policy
interactions between the hPCRF in the HPLMN and the HSGW are relayed via the vPCRF in the
VPLMN.
9.
It may become necessary to modify the eHRPD radio session configuration between the UE and the
eAN/ePCF. For example, this may be necessary as a result of moving under the coverage area of a new
eAN/ePCF. This is accomplished by eHRPD signalling exchanges between the UE and the eAN/ePCF
via S101 tunneling.
10. If any bearer is added, modified, or deleted while the UE is operating on E-UTRAN, similar changes
shall be made in the context between the UE and the HSGW. This is accomplished by signaling those
changes between the UE and HSGW via S101 tunneling. Likewise, if any PDN connection is added, or
deleted while the UE is operating on E-UTRAN, similar changes are made in the HSGW via the use of
VSNCP.
10a. If the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request for a PDN connection for which it does not
have a P-GW identity, it obtains that information via an AAR/AAA exchange with the HSS/AAA. If
the HSGW already has the corresponding P-GW IP address, or receives it from the HSS/AAA
59
60
221
associated with the VSNCP Configure-Request message, the HSGW exchanges PBU/PBA messages
with the P-GW. The exchanges of AAR/AAA and PBU/PBA messages are not shown in the figure.
11. If not already initiated, PCRF interactions due to session maintenance can be initiated by the PCRF or
the HSGW. The PCRF initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Rules Provision Procedure specified in
TS 23.203 [21]. The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control and QoS Policy Rules Request Procedure as
specified in TS 23.203 [21].
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
222
1
2
12.1.2
It is assumed that either a full pre-registration context, or a partial context has been setup in
the HSGW, and PMIP binding is not established.
4
5
6
7
8
9
Roaming
UE
eNB
eAN/ePCF
MME
HSGW
P-GW
S-GW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP AAA
Proxy
vPCRF
hPCRF
10
11
12
13
14
15
1a. Decision to
handover to
eHRPD
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
7a. A11-RRQ
(Active Start)
7b. A11-RRP
38
39
40
41
42
43
8d. S101 HO
complete
Indication/Ack
44
45
9. IP Packets Flowing
46
47
9. IP Packets
Flowing
9. IP Packets Flowing
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
223
HSS/
AAA
1.
1a. E-UTRAN receives CDMA measurement reports from the UE and makes a HO decision.
1b. UE sends an HRPD Connection Request message to the E-UTRAN to request an HRPD traffic
channel. This request is forwarded to the MME. See TS 23.402 [25] for details.
1c. The MME sends the P-GW address(es) and the associated APNs and the uplink GRE key(s) along
with the HRPD Connection Request message to the eHRPD access node over the S101 tunnel.
NOTE: The GRE keys (one for each APN) sent in step 1c are further sent in step 2a to the HSGW, and
the HSGW uses them for uplink traffic towards the P-GW after the HO. The same keys are in use
between the S-GW and P-GW before the HO. Using the same keys assures that the P-GW can
associate the uplink data to the right UE, if the HSGW decides to send uplink data even before the
PBA message is received in step 8b (note that the P-GW as defined in TS 23.402 [25] is equipped to
receive data with the same GRE key even before updating the binding).
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
2a. The eHRPD eAN/ePCF allocates the requested radio resources and sends an A11-Registration
Request message to the HSGW. In this message the eAN/ePCF includes the P-GW address(es), the
associated uplink GRE key(s) received in step 1c and the indicator that the UE is communicating via a
tunnel (ref. Tunnel Mode indicator in A.S0022 [4]).
14
2b. The HSGW responds with an A11-Registration Reply containing a forwarding address (i.e.,
HSGW IP address, GRE key(s), and associated APN(s) ).
19
In response to the HRPD Connection Request message received in step 1c, the eHRPD eAN/ePCF
sends the HRPD Traffic Channel Assignment (TCA) message in an S101 message to the MME. The
S101 message also carries the HSGW IP address, GRE key(s) for data forwarding, and associated
APN(s).
15
16
17
18
20
21
22
23
24
25
4a. The MME configures resources for indirect data forwarding and signals the HSGW IP address and
GRE key(s) to the S-GW. The S-GW confirms data forwarding resources.
26
4b. The MME forwards the HRPD TCA message embedded in the S101 message to the E-UTRAN
which forwards it to the UE over the airlink.
29
E-UTRAN may return downlink IP packets back to the S-GW to be sent to the HSGW over the S103
interface. The HSGW will perform any necessary processing on the IP packets and forward them over
the appropriate A10 connection to the eAN/ePCF.
27
28
30
31
32
33
34
35
6b. The UE sends a Traffic Channel Completion (TCC) message to the eHRPD eAN/ePCF.
37
7a. The eHRPD eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request carrying an Active Start airlink record
and the indicator that the UE is now operating on the eHRPD radio to the HSGW.
7b. The HSGW responds to the eHRPD eAN/ePCF with an A11-Registration Reply.
In the case of pre-registration with one or more PDN connections already established at the HSGW,
steps 8 to 10 will take place. Otherwise, only step 8d will take place, and the HSGW waits for the UE
to setup PDN connections by sending VSNCP-Configure-Request messages for each PDN connection
at step 11.
8.
8a. Triggered by step 7a, the HSGW/MAG sends a PBU(s) to establish a PMIPv6 tunnel(s) with the
P-GW(s) the UE is associated with. The HSGW uses the NAI received in the Mobile-Node-Identifier
AVP upon successful authentication to identify the UE.
8b. The P-GW processes the PBU and updates the binding cache entry for the UE. The same IP
address(es) or prefix(es) are assigned to the UE. The P-GW/LMA sends a PBA message to the
HSGW/MAG, including the IP address(es)/prefix(es) allocated for the UE. The PMIPv6 tunnel is now
setup.
8c. The P-GW requires configuration for enforcing policy, the P-GW sends a Modify IP-CAN session
message to the hPCRF. The P-GW has requested an IP-CAN session, the hPCRF responds to the
36
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
224
P-GW with a Modify IP-CAN session Ack message. This message includes the Policy and Charging
rules provisioned into the P-GW.
1
2
Note: Steps 8a to 8c are repeated for each PDN connection that is to be established.
3
4
8d. The eHRPD eAN/ePCF signals handoff completion to the MME to confirm HO completion, and
receives an acknowledgement.
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
9.
L3 attach is completed and the UE can now send/receive packets to/from the eHRPD access network.
10. The E-UTRAN system, including eNodeB, MME, S-GW, and P-GW release resources, including
sending a PMIPv6 BRI message from the P-GW to the S-GW as specified in TS 29.275 [37]. See also
TS 23.402 [25].
11. If the UE had not completed PDN connection and bearer addition/deletion while on E-UTRAN, the UE
completes those activities over the eHRPD radio. In the case of pre-registration with partial context,
EPS resources including eNodeB, MME, S-GW are released when the UE sets up the PDN
connections over eHRPD. If any PDN connection is added, modified, or deleted while the UE is
operating on E-UTRAN, similar changes are made in the HSGW via the use of VSNCP.
11a. If the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request for a PDN connection for which it does not
have a P-GW identity, it obtains that information via an AAR/AAA exchange with the HSS/AAA. If
the HSGW already has the corresponding P-GW IP address, or receives it from the HSS/AAA
associated with the VSNCP Configure-Request message, the HSGW exchanges PBU/PBA messages
with the P-GW. The exchanges of AAR/AAA and PBU/PBA messages are not shown in the figure.
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
225
12.1.3
This procedure is used in the case the UE has a dormant PPP session in the target HSGW
through the pre-registration procedure. It is assumed that the UE has pre-registered with
eHRPD, that the PPP inactivity timer is still running, and that the HSGW has full context for
the UE (except for PMIP bindings).
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Roaming
UE
eNB
MME
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
S-GW
P-GW
P-GW
P-GW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP AAA
Proxy
vPCRF
10
hPCRF
HSS/
AAA
11
12
13
14
15
1. UE is idle in
LTE
16
17
2. UE
Decision to
perform
Cell reselection
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
29
30
28
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
The UE is attached to the E-UTRAN network and stays in ECM_IDLE state. The UE has a
dormant eHRPD session in the target eHRPD eAN through the pre-registration procedure.
48
49
50
51
52
The UE is in idle mode. Based on some trigger, the idle UE decides to perform cell re-selection to
the eHRPD eAN. Note, the cell re-selection decision can be made at any time when the UE is
attached in the E-UTRAN network (including as soon as the UE has completed pre-registration).
53
3. The UE follows eHRPD procedures to inform the eAN the UE has performed an inter-technology
idle mode mobility event and is now tuned to eHRPD.
57
2.
54
55
56
58
59
60
226
4.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
5~6. Upon receipt of the A11-Registration Request message for eHRPD session with nonzero lifetime
timer and the Tunnel Mode Indicator is set to 0 or is not present, the HSGW determines that it
does not have a PMIPv6 binding(s) for this UE and exchanges PBU/PBA messages with the
appropriate P-GW(s). The UE address information in PMIPv6 PBA returns the IP Address
assigned to the UE. At this point the user plane is switched in the P-GW towards the eHRPD
access network via the HSGW. The P-GW updates the HSS/AAA using an exchange of
AAR/AAA messages (not shown in the figure).
6a-6b. The P-GW sends an Indication of IP-CAN Session Modification message to the PCRF and
PCRF acknowledges. Since steps 6 and 6a are both triggered by the PBU in step 5, steps 6 and 6a
may occur in parallel.
NOTE:For multiple PDN connections, steps 5-6 and 6a-6b are performed for each PDN connection.
7.
The HSGW sends A11-Registration Reply to acknowledge the eHRPD access. The A11Registration Request message is validated and, if new A10 connections are being established, the
HSGW accepts the A10 connections by returning an A11-Registration Reply message with an
accept indication. This step may occur any time after step 4.
8.
At any time after step 6, the P-GW shall initiate resource allocation deactivation procedure in
E-UTRAN as defined in TS 23.402 subclause 5.6.2.2 [25].
9.
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
The eAN sends an A11-Registration Request for all A10s. This A11-Registration Request
contains the tunnelled mode indicator set to 0 to indicate to the HSGW that the UE is
operating on the eHRPD radio. If the Tunnel Mode Indicator is not present, then the HSGW shall
always assume that the UE is operating on the eHRPD radio, and thus all PMIP bindings for the
UE should be established.
10. If the UE had not completed PDN connection and bearer addition/deletion while on E-UTRAN,
the UE completes those activities over the eHRPD radio. If any PDN connection is added,
modified, or deleted while the UE is operating on E-UTRAN, similar changes are made in the
HSGW via the use of VSNCP.
10a. If the HSGW receives a VSNCP Configure-Request for a PDN connection for which it does
not have a P-GW identity, it obtains that information via an AAR/AAA exchange with the
HSS/AAA. If the HSGW already has the corresponding P-GW IP address, or receives it from the
HSS/AAA associated with the VSNCP Configure-Request message, the HSGW exchanges
PBU/PBA messages with the P-GW. The exchanges of AAR/AAA and PBU/PBA messages are
not shown in the figure.
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
227
12.2
Non-Optimized Handoff
2
3
4
The flows for non-optimized handoff are shown in the following sections.
12.2.1
UE
eAN/ePCF
SGW
HSGW
PCRF
P-GW
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSS/
AAA
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1. Connection
Establishment, including
possible eHRPD session
retrieval from another eAN/
ePCF.
23
24
25
26
27
28
3. A11-RRP
29
30
31
32
6.
Gateway
Control
Session
Setup
5. VSNCP Configuration-Request
(PDN-ID, Attach Type = handover, )
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
228
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
In this flow, it is assumed that the UE is returning to the same HSGW and eHRPD RAN that hold the
context for the UE. This assumption makes it possible to avoid showing the removal of the A10
connections to the S-eAN/ePCF by the S-HSGW, as well as context transfer between HSGWs. Those
procedures are defined in A.S0008-C [1] and A.S0009-C [2], and in section 11 of this document.
1.
2.
The ePCF recognizes that the A10 session associated with the UE is available, and sends an
Active Start indication in an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW.
3.
4.
The HSGW retrieves the UE context from the HSS/AAA, including the IP address(es) of P-GW(s)
currently in use by all PDN connections for the UE.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Steps 5-12 are repeated for each additional PDN connection that the UE must re-establish.
5.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, PDN Type, APN, PDN Address, Protocol
Configuration Options, and Attach Type = Handoff Attach. The User Context Identifier is also
included if MUPSAP is supported. When known, PDN Type indicates the UE IP version
capability (IPv4, IPv4/IPv6, IPv6), which is the capability of the IP stack associated with the UE.
The Protocol Configuration Options indicates whether the UE supports network initiated bearers.
6.
The HSGW performs the Gateway Control Session Establishment procedure with the PCRF (see
TS 23.203 [21]). As part of this step, the PCRF sends the QoS rules and events to the HSGW.
7.
The HSGW sends a PMIP Binding Update to the P-GW in order to update the registration see TS
29.275 [37]. If MUPSAP is supported, the HSGW includes the PDN Connection ID information
element in the PBU message.
8.
The P-GW performs a PCRF interaction to retrieve the QoS policy parameters.
9.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW see TS 29.275 [37].
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
10. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack (PDN-ID, User Context Identifier if the PDN
Connection ID information element received in the PBA message, APN, PDN Address, PCO, and
Attach Type) message to the UE over the main service connection. The Protocol Configuration
Options parameter may indicate the Selected Bearer Control Mode.
NOTE: If dynamic policy is not supported, the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS-only.
11. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID and may include the IPv4 Default Router
Address if an IPv4 address is to be assigned either immediately or deferred.
12. The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
Step 13 is repeated as necessary until all bearers for all PDN connections are re-established.
13. Bearers for a PDN connection are re-established on eHRPD based on the Selected Bearer Control
Mode:
13a.) If the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS-only, the HSGW assumes that the UE will reestablish all bearers. The UE performs UE requested bearer resource allocation section 4.5.4.1.1
for all bearers. If there is no change to the QoS info, steps 6 and 7 are not performed as the QoS
info and service connections are retained. As part of re-establishing bearers, one or more bearers
may need to be deleted with the RAN. The UE performs standard HRPD procedures to remove the
corresponding Reservations.
13b.) If the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS/NW, the HSGW re-establishes all bearers. The
HSGW performs NW initiated dedicated bearer setup section 4.5.3.1 for all bearers. If there is
no change to the QoS info steps 4 and 5 are not performed as the QoS info and service connections
are retained. As part of re-establishing bearers, one or more bearers may need to be deleted.
58
59
60
229
Note: It is FFS how the stale bearers get deleted in the case the Selected Bearer Control Mode is
MS/NW.
Note: It is FFS how the HSGW informs the UE in MS/NW mode about which IP Flows the UE shall
initiate.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
230
1
2
12.2.2
This procedure is used in the case there is null context in the target HSGW for the UE.
For simplicity, it is assumed that the eHRPD session context already is available to the
eAN/ePCF to which the UE performs the handoff. The UE had previously been on
eHRPD, and does not use the S101 tunneling mechanism to pre-register on eHRPD.
4
5
6
7
8
9
Roaming
10
11
eNB
UE
12
MME
eAN/
ePCF
15
16
17
18
19
S-GW
3GPP2
AAA
3GPP
AAA Proxy
vPCRF
hPCRF
HSS/
AAA
13
14
HSGW
P-GW
P-GW
P-GW
2. UE
Decision to
perform Cell
re-selection
20
21
5. A11-RRP
22
23
6 VSNCP Configure-Request
24
25
7. The HSGW determines that it has no context saved for this UE.
The UE, RAN, HSGW, and Core Network perform steps 6 through 17 of the flow
in section 5.4.1 with Attach Type = Handover Attach.
26
27
28
29
30
31
8. DHCP
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
10. The UE, RAN, HSGW, and PCRF establish dedicated bearers (IP flows) based on the Bearer Control Mode:
10a. If the selected BCM = NW-Initiated, then the UE, RAN, HSGW, and Core Network perform the procedures
in section 4.5.3.1 to establish dedicated bearers (IP flows) using Network Initiated QoS.
10b. If the selected BCM = UE-Initiated, then the UE, RAN, HSGW, and Core Network perform the procedures in
section 4.5.4.1.1 to establish dedicated bearers (IP flows) using UE Initiated QoS.
42
43
44
45
46
1.
It is assumed that the UE has an existing eHRPD session with the eAN/ePCF, and that the HSGW
has no saved context for the UE. The UE does not use S101 to pre-register with eHRPD. When
the UE re-attaches to eHRPD, it needs to establish complete context with the HSGW.
2.
The UE is in LTE. Based on some trigger, the UE decides to perform cell re-selection to the
eHRPD AN. Note: the cell re-selection decision can be made at any time when the UE is attached
in the E-UTRAN network. The eNB may be involved in redirecting the UE to eHRPD.
3.
4.
Since the eHRPD session is in this subnet, and since no A10 connections exist, the eHRPD
eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request to establish all A10s. This A11-Registration
Request contains the Tunnel Mode Indicator set to 0 to indicate to the HSGW that the UE is
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
231
operating on the eHRPD radio. If the Tunnel Mode Indicator is not present, then the HSGW
always assumes that the UE is operating on the eHRPD radio.
5.
Triggered by step 4 the HSGW sends A11-Registration Reply to acknowledge the eHRPD access.
The A11-Registration Request message is validated.
6.
Since the UE had previously been on eHRPD and had not used S101 to pre-register, the UE sends
a VSNCP Configure-Request to the HSGW. The User Context Identifier configuration option is
also included if MUPSAP is supported. The UE makes the assumption that the HSGW has
maintained partial context from the previous time that the UE had established context on eHRPD.
7.
8.
9.
The HSGW notes that it has no saved context for the UE. The HSGW initiates LCP and the other
procedures contained in steps 6 to 17 of the flow in section 5.4.1 to establish PPP, authentication,
CCP, and PDN contexts for the UE. This step may occur prior to the VSNCP Configure-Request
being sent in step 6.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
(optional) The UE can now issue a DHCPv4 DISCOVER (optionally with rapid commit option)
message on the BE service connection provided the UE requested deferred IP address allocation.
15
18
9b. The HSGW shall send a Router Advertisement message if the P-GW sends the IPv6 prefix to
the HSGW.
10. The UE, RAN, HSGW and PCRF proceed to re-establish dedicated bearers based on the Bearer
Control Mode.
10a. If the selected BCM indicates NW-initiated QoS, then the procedures of section 4.5.3.1 are
executed for each dedicated bearer (IP flow) that was setup on LTE.
10b. If the selected BCM indicates UE-initiated QoS, then the procedures of section 4.5.4.1.1 are
executed for each dedicated bearer (IP flow) that was setup on LTE that the UE wishes to
establish.
16
17
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
232
1
2
12.2.3
This procedure is used in the case there is no eHRPD session in the target evolved HRPD
system for the UE.
4
5
6
7
8
9
UE
eAN/ePCF
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
SGW
HSGW
PCRF
3GPP2
AAA
Proxy
HSS/
AAA
P-GW
17
18
19
20
5.
Gateway
Control
Session
Setup
4. VSNCP Configure-Request
(PDN-ID, Attach Type = handover, )
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
7. PCRF Interaction
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
OPTIONAL PROCEDURE
35
12. DHCP
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
1.
It is assumed that the UE does not have an existing eHRPD session with the eAN/ePCF (thus, the
HSGW has no saved context for the UE). The UE does not use S101 to pre-register with eHRPD.
When the UE re-attaches to eHRPD, it needs to go through full eHRPD session establishment and
establish complete context with the HSGW.
2.
The UE is in LTE. Based on some trigger, the UE decides to perform cell re-selection to the
eHRPD AN. Note: the cell re-selection decision can be made at any time when the UE is attached
in the E-UTRAN network. The eNB may be involved in redirecting the UE to eHRPD.
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
233
3.
The UE follows the steps 1 to 7b from the call flow in section 5.4.1 to establish an eHRPD session
and a PPP and authentication session with the HSGW.
Steps 4 - 11 are repeated for each additional PDN connection that the UE must move from the LTE
system.
4.
5.
The UE sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message over the main service connection. The
information in the message includes a PDN-ID, User Context Identifier if MUPSAP is supported,
PDN Type, APN, PDN Address, Protocol Configuration Options, and Attach Type = Handover
Attach. When known, PDN Type indicates the UE IP version capability (IPv4, IPv4/IPv6, IPv6),
which is the capability of the IP stack associated with the UE. The Protocol Configuration Options
indicates whether the UE supports network initiated bearers.
The HSGW performs the Gateway Control Session Establishment procedure with the PCRF (see
TS 23.203 [21]). As part of this step, the PCRF sends the QoS rules and events to the HSGW.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
The HSGW sends a Proxy Binding Update to the P-GW in order to update the registration see TS
29.275 [37]. If MUPSAP is supported, the HSGW includes PDN Connection ID information
element in the Proxy Binding Update message.
15
7.
The P-GW performs a PCRF interaction to retrieve the QoS policy parameters.
19
8.
The P-GW responds with a PBA message to the HSGW see TS 29.275 [37].
9.
The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Ack (PDN-ID, User Context Identifier if the PDN
Connection ID information element is received in the PBA message, APN, PDN Address, PCO,
and Attach Type) message to the UE over the main service connection. The Protocol
Configuration Options parameter may indicate the Selected Bearer Control Mode.
6.
NOTE: If dynamic policy is not supported, the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS-only.
10. The HSGW sends a VSNCP Configure-Request message to complete the protocol specified in
RFC 3772 [69]. The message includes the PDN-ID and may include the IPv4 Default Router
Address if an IPv4 address is to be assigned either immediately or deferred.
11. The UE responds with a VSNCP Configure-Ack message.
12. (optional) The UE can now issue a DHCPv4 DISCOVER (optionally with rapid commit option)
message on the BE service connection provided the UE requested deferred IP address allocation in
Step 8.
13. 13a. The UE may send a Router solicitation message.
13b. The HSGW shall send a Router Advertisement message if the P-GW sends the IPv6 prefix to
the HSGW.
Step 14 is repeated as necessary until all bearers for all PDN connections are established.
16
17
18
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
14. Bearers for a PDN connection are re-established on eHRPD based on the Selected Bearer Control
Mode:
14a. If the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS-only, the HSGW assumes that the UE will
establish all bearers. The UE performs UE requested bearer resource allocation section 4.5.4.1.1
for all bearers.
43
14b. If the Selected Bearer Control Mode is MS/NW, the HSGW establishes all bearers. The
HSGW performs NW initiated dedicated bearer setup section 4.5.3.1 for all bearers.
49
44
45
46
47
48
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
234
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
13.1
10
11
Roaming
Scenarios
12
13
14
15
16
17
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
20
21
22
23
24
5. Binding
Revocation
Acknowledgement
25
26
27
30
31
32
7. HSGW runs
the UE context
maintenance
timer
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
H-PCRF
2. Binding
Revocation
Indication
3. Gateway Control Session Termination
19
29
V-PCRF
1. UE handoff to EUTRAN
18
28
P-GW
10. A11RegistrationUpdate
11. A11RegistrationAcknowledge
12. A11RegistrationRequest
(Lifetime = 0)
13. A11RegistrationReply
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
235
HSS/AAA
1.
2.
The P-GW sends a Binding Revocation Indication message to the trusted non-3GPP IP access
as defined in RFC 5846 [88], with the Revocation Trigger value set to Inter-MAG Handover
- Different Access Type.
3.
4.
The HSGW initiates the Gateway Control Session Termination Procedure with the PCRF as
specified in TS 23.203 [21].
The PCRF responds to the HSGW with Acknowledge Gateway Control Session Termination
message.
5.
The HSGW returns a Binding Revocation Acknowledgement message to the P-GW. This
message can be sent any time after step 2.
6.
Anytime after step 2, the HSGW releases the PDN connection contexts and TFTs. The
HSGW. retains the LCP, CCP, authentication session and A10 session information for the
UE, including the QoS information received from the RAN associated with the A10
connections for the UE (including the Flow ID to A10 mapping).
7.
The HSGW uses the UE Context Maintainance timer per section 9.1.9 to wait to release the
remainder of the session information for the UE.
8.
Upon expiry of the UE Context Maintenance timer, the HSGW sends aSession Termination
Request to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server for releasing the Pi* and STa Diameter Sessions.
9.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Note: The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server forwards the Session Termination Request to the 3GPP
HSS/AAA and responds to the HSGW with a Session Termination Answer on receiving the
response from the 3GPP HSS/AAA.
25
10. Upon expiry of the UE Context Maintenance timer, the HSGW sends an A11-Registration
Update message to initiate with the ePCF the release of the A10 session for the UE.
29
26
27
28
30
31
32
12. The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request with the lifetime value set to zero to
release the A10 session.
33
13. The HSGW responds with A11-Registration Reply with lifetime zero.
36
34
35
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
236
1
2
3
13.2
4
5
6
Roaming
Scenarios
7
8
9
10
UE
eAN/ePCF
HSGW
P-GW
V-PCRF
H-PCRF
11
12
13
1. UE is redirected
to EUTRAN
14
2. A11-Registration
Request
(Active Stop)
15
16
17
3. A11-Registration
Reply
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
1.
2.
The eAN/ePCF sends an A11-Registration Request message to the HSGW with an Active
Stop indication to the HSGW for all IP flows in the activated state associated with the UE.
3.
4.
The UE performs the E-UTRAN access procedures shown in TS 23.402 [25] clause 8.2.1.1 or
8.2.1.2.
5.
Steps 2 to 13 from the call flow in section 13.1 are performed to release the related eHRPD
network resources.
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
237
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
238
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
15.1
General
The procedures in this section shall be supported if the HSGW and the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server support Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application. It is assumed that the deployment of
the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application will be consistent throughout the operator network.
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
The Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration procedure is mapped to the command pair Query
Profile Request/Answer (QPR/QPA) defined for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application.
Appropriate settings of the Supported-Features AVP within the QPR command are used to
query the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration information.
Some 3GPP2 access network QoS parameters can be derived from the 3GPP EPS parameters
received at the HSGW during UE Authentication and Authorization. Section 20 (Annex E)
provides some examples on how such mapping between the 3GPP EPS parameters and the
3GPP2 access network parameters can be performed based on operator policy. The HSGW
forwards such derived 3GPP2 access network QoS parameters to the eAN/ePCF as part of
Subscriber QoS Profile via A11-Session Update message.
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
239
15.2
UE
HSGW
3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server
3 GPP
AAA
Server
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
HSS
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
0.
User is authenticated with the 3GPP AAA as per EAP-AKA authentication procedures. That is,
steps 1-23, section 4.2.5.1 have successfully completed.
39
1.
The HSGW invokes the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration procedure by sending the Query
Profile Request (QPR) command to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server. If the HSGW does not know if
the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server supports the SubQoSConfig feature, it includes the SupportedFeatures AVP within the QPR command, with the Feature-List-ID sub AVP set to 1 (Query
Group) and feature bit 0 in the Feature-List sub AVP set to 1. The HSGW uses this procedure
to retrieve Subscriber QoS Profile information from the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server.
42
2.
On successful processing of the Query Profile Request (QPR) command, the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server responds with a Query Profile Answer (QPA) command with Result Code success
(DIAMETER_SUCCESS) that includes the Subscriber QoS Profile information to the HSGW. If
Supported-Features AVP is included in the QPR command, the Supported-Features AVP is
included in the QPA command also, indicating the complete set of features supported by the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server uses IMSI-based Network Access
Identifier (NAI) as the key to the subscriber profile information.
40
41
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
240
3.
1
2
3
If the HSGW receives the Subscriber QoS Profile information from the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server, it forwards Subscriber QoS Profile information elements to the eAN/ePCF via A11Session Update procedures. Refer to A.S0008 [1] and A.S0009 [2].
4
5
6
7
15.3
8
9
During intra-eHRPD handoff with HSGW relocation with context transfer, the Subscriber
QoS Profile Information context is not transferred from the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW. The THSGW shall perform the Subscriber QoS Profile Information retrieval procedures with the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server after receiving the H1-Ack message from the S-HSGW.
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
UE
17
S- eAN/
ePCF
T- eAN/
ePCF
S- HSGW
(S- MAG)
T- HSGW
(T- MAG)
P- GW
( LMA)
PCRF
3 GPP2
AAA
Proxy
18
19
0. Steps 0-7 : Section 11.1.1 (Handoff When the UE is Active on the eHRPD Radio)
Steps 0-7: Section 11.2 (Handoff When the UE is Dormant on the eHRPD Radio)
20
21
22
23
24
1. AAA Message
(Query Profile Request)
25
26
2. AAA Message
(Query Profile Answer)
27
28
3. A11-Signaling
(Update Subscriber QoS Profile
at eAN)
29
30
31
32
33
4. Steps 8-26 : Section 11.1.1 (Handoff When the UE is Active on the eHRPD Radio)
Steps 8-20: Section 11.2 (Handoff When the UE is Dormant on the eHRPD Radio)
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
0.
UE has an active session with the P-GW via the S-eAN/ePCF and the S-HSGW. The UE or the SeAN decides that the UE moves to the T-eAN. eHRPD radio session context is transferred to the
T-eAN including the H1 address of the S-HSGW. The T-eAN/ePCF sets up the A10 connection
with the selected T-HSGW. The T-HSGW performs the Handover Initiate procedures with the SHSGW over the H1 Interface, and the S-HSGW responds with a Handover Ack message that
contains the user session context parameters as described in section 11.1.1 steps 0-7, and section
11.1.2 steps 0-7. Context parameters related to the Subscriber QoS Profile are not transferred from
the S-HSGW to the T-HSGW.
1.
The T-HSGW invokes the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration procedure by sending the Query
Profile Request (QPR) command to the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server If the HSGW does not know if
the 3GPP2 Proxy/Server supports the SubQosConfig feature, it includes Supported-Features AVP
in the QPR command, with the Feature-List-ID sub AVP set to 1 (Query Group) and feature bit
0 in the Feature-List sub AVP set to 1.
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
241
2.
3.
4.
On successful processing of the Query Profile Request (QPR) command, the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server responds to the T-HSGW with a Query Profile Answer (QPA) command with Result
Code success (DIAMETER_SUCCESS) that includes the 3GPP2 Subscriber QoS Profile
information. If the Supported-Features AVP is included in the QPR command, the SupportedFeatures AVP is included in the QPA command also, indicating the complete set of features
supported by the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server. The 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server uses the IMSI-based
Network Access Identifier (NAI) as the key to the subscriber profile information.
If the T-HSGW receives the 3GPP2 Subscriber QoS Profile information from the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server, it forwards the Subscriber QoS Profile information elements to the T-eAN/ePCF via
A11-Session Update procedures.
The remainder of the handoff procedure continues from step 8 in sections 11.1.1 and 11.1.2.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15.4
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
24
25
27
29
23
26
28
30
The handling and usage of the Subscriber QoS Profile attributes at the HSGW shall be as
specified in Annex D (Section 19). The HSGW shall store the Subscriber QoS Profile
attributes.
Table 60 specifies the information elements supported in the Query Profile Request
command.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
Table 61 specifies the information elements supported in the Query Profile Answer command.
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
242
Table 60
1
2
3
4
5
6
Information
Element Name
9
10
15
16
17
18
19
20
Description
Authentication
Session State
Auth-SessionState
(ref. IETF RFC
3588 [65])
Supported
Features
SupportedFeatures
(ref. 3GPP TS
29.229 [34])
12
14
Cat.
User-Name
(ref. IETF RFC
3588 [65])
11
13
Mapping to
Diameter AVP
User Identity
(IMSI)
7
8
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
243
Table 61
Information
Element Name
Result Code
Mapping to Diameter
AVP
Result-Code /
Experimental-Result
(ref. RFC3588 [65]).
Cat.
Description
User Identity
(IMSI)
User-Name
(ref. RFC 3588 [65])
Authentication
Session State
Auth-Session-State
(ref. RFC 3588 [65])
Redirect-Host
(ref. RFC 3588 [65])
Supported Featues
Service Option
Profile
(ref. X.S0011 [6])
Maximum
Authorized
Aggregate
Bandwidth for Best
Effort Traffic
(ref. X.S0011 [6])
Supported-Features
(ref. 3GPP TS 29.229
[34])
Maximum-AuthorizedAggregate-Bandwidthfor-Best-Effort-Traffic
(ref. section 15.4.6)
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
23
Service-Option-Profile
(ref. section 15.4.5)
20
21
22
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
If the Result-Code is
DIAMETER_SUCCESS, this information
element may be included. This is a Grouped
AVP and shall indicate the maximum number
of allowed link flows and allowed Service
Options.
43
If the Result-Code is
DIAMETER_SUCCESS, this information
element may be included and shall indicate
the maximum bandwidth that may be
allocated to a user for best effort traffic.
50
44
45
46
47
48
49
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
244
Information
Element Name
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Mapping to Diameter
AVP
Cat.
Authorized Flow
Profile IDs for the
User for Each
Direction
(ref. X.S0011 [6])
Authorized-FlowProfile-IDs-for-the-User
(ref. section 15.4.7)
If the Result-Code is
DIAMETER_SUCCESS, this information
element may be included. This is a Grouped
AVP and indicates the Flow Profile IDs that
the user is allowed to request in a QoS Sub
Blob.
Authorized Flow
Profile IDs for the
User for Each
Direction
(ref. X.S0011 [6])
Authorized-FlowProfile-IDs-for-the-User
(ref. section 15.4.7)
If the Result-Code is
DIAMETER_SUCCESS, this information
element may be included. This is a Grouped
AVP and indicates the Flow Profile IDs that
the user is allowed to request in a QoS Sub
Blob.
Inter-User-Priority
(ref. section 15.4.8)
If the Result-Code is
DIAMETER_SUCCESS, this information
element may be included and indicates the
inter-user priority that may be assigned to
users packet flow for best effort traffic.
Max-Per-Flow-Priorityfor-the-User
(ref. section 15.4.9)
If the Result-Code is
DIAMETER_SUCCESS, this information
element may be included and shall indicate
the maximum priority that may be assigned to
a users packet flow.
21
22
23
24
25
Description
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
15.4.1
48
49
50
51
52
53
On receiving a Query Profile Answer (QPA) command from the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server,
the HSGW shall check the Result Code. If the result code indicates other than success
(DIAMETER_SUCCESS) the HSGW takes corrective action based on the received result
code.
54
55
56
57
58
59
On receiving a Query Profile Answer (QPA) command from the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server
with success (DIAMETER_SUCCESS) Result Code, the HSGW shall check for the presence
of the Subscriber QoS Parameters listed in Section 15.1, and shall handle them as per
procedures specified in Annex D (Section 19).
60
245
1
2
3
4
15.4.2
5
6
7
8
9
10
If it supports all the features indicated in the Supported-Features AVP, the 3GPP2
AAA Proxy/Server shall include the Supported-Features AVP in the QPA command,
identifying the complete set of features that it supports for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter
Application.
If it does not support all the features indicated in the Supported-Features AVP, the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall return the QPA command with the ExperimentalResult-Code AVP set to DIAMETER_ERROR_FEATURE_UNSUPPORTED and
shall include the Supported-Features AVP identifying the complete set of features
that it supports for the Pi*3GPP2 Diameter Application.
If it does not support the Supported-Features AVP, it shall return the QPA command
with the Result-Code AVP set to DIAMETER_AVP_UNSUPPORTED and a FailedAVP containing the Supported-Features AVP as received in the QPR command.
If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server includes the Supported-Features AVP in the Query Profile
Answer (QPA) command, the Supported-Features AVP shall have the M bit cleared. In this
Grouped AVP, the Feature-List-ID sub AVP shall be set to 1 (Query Group); and the
Feature-List sub AVP shall have bits set for the complete set of features supported by the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server supports the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration
(SubQoSConfig) feature:
It shall check whether the User Name (IMSI) in the User-Name AVP is known. If it
is not known, a Result Code of DIAMETER_ERROR_USER_UNKNOWN shall be
returned.
32
33
34
35
36
37
If the user is known but does not have any Subscriber QoS Profile configured for it,
the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall respond with Experimental-Result-Code
DIAMETER_ERROR_NO_SUBSCRIBER_QoS_PROFILE.
38
42
The Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration procedure is a stateless procedure. The 3GPP2
AAA Proxy/Server shall include the Auth-Session-State AVP in the Query Profile Answer
(QPA) command, with the value set to NO_STATE_MAINTAINED.
39
40
41
43
44
45
46
47
48
If the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server successfully processes the received Query Profile Request
(QPR) command, the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server shall respond with a Query Profile Answer
(QPA) command with Result Code success (DIAMETER_SUCCESS), and shall include the
subscribed QoS information elements as listed in Table 61.
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
246
15.4.3
2
3
4
5
15.4.3.1
Result-Code
The Result-Code AVP values defined in Diameter Base Protocol RFC 3588 [65] shall be
applicable.
7
8
9
10
11
15.4.3.2
12
When one of the result codes defined here is included in an answer command, it shall be
inside an Experimental-Result AVP with Vendor-ID set to the 3GPP2 Vendor-ID (5535).
13
14
15
16
17
Experimental-Result
15.4.3.3
Experimental-Result-Code
The Experimental-Result-Code AVP contains the 3GPP2 assigned value representing the
result of processing a request command.
18
19
20
21
22
15.4.3.3.1
23
DIAMETER_ERROR_FEATURE_UNSUPPORTED (3001)
This Experimental Result Code shall be sent by the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server to the HSGW
if it does not support all the features indicated in the Supported-Features AVP.
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
15.4.3.3.2
DIAMETER_ERROR_NO_SUBSCRIBER_QoS_PROFILE (4001)
This Experimental Result Code shall be sent by the 3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server to the HSGW
if the user is known but it does not have a Subscriber QoS Profile configured for the user.
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
247
15.4.4
AVPs
Table 62 lists the Diameter AVPs defined for the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration
feature for use in the Query Profile Request (QPR) and Query Profile Answer (QPA)
commands.
2
3
4
5
6
Table 62
9
10
AVP Section
Should Must May
Value Type Must May
Code defined
not
not
Encr.
Attribute Name
Service-Option-Profile
Maximum-Authorized-AggregateBandwidth-for-Best-Effort-Traffic
Authorized-Flow-Profile-IDs-for-the-User
Inter-User-Priority
Maximum-Per-Flow-Priority-for-the-User
ProfileID-Forward
9074 15.4.5
Grouped
11
12
13
No
No
15
9131
9139
9133
35
V
V
V
V
M
M
M
M
No
No
No
No
17
15.4.7
15.4.8
15.4.9
15.4.10
Grouped
Integer32
Integer32
Integer32
ProfileID-Reverse
36 15.4.11 Integer32
V
M
No
ProfileID-Bi-Directional
37 15.4.12 Integer32
V
M
No
Max-Link-Flows
57 15.4.13 Unsigned32 V
M
No
Service-Option-Number
58 15.4.14 Unsigned32 V
M
No
NOTE: The AVP header bit denoted as M, indicates whether support of the AVP is required. The AVP
header bit denoted as V, indicates whether the optional Vendor-ID field is present in the AVP
header. For further details, see IETF RFC 3588 [65].
14
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
Table 63 lists the Diameter AVPs re-used by the Subscriber QoS Profile Configuration feature
for use in the Query Profile Request (QPR) and Query Profile Answer (QPA) commands from
existing Diameter Applications, including a reference to their respective specifications. Other
AVPs from existing Diameter Applications except for the AVPs from Diameter Base Protocol
do not need to be supported.
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
Table 63
Attribute Name
Reference
User-Name
RFC3588 [65]
Supported-Features
TS 29.229 [34]
Feature-List-ID
TS 29.229 [34]
Feature-List
TS 29.229 [34]
Comments
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
248
15.4.5
Service-Option-Profile
The Service-Option-Profile AVP (AVP code 5535/9074) is of type Grouped. It specifies the
authorized packet data Service Options and the allowed maximum number of simultaneous
Link Flows.
3
4
5
6
7
AVP format:
8
9
10
11
{Max-Link-Flows}
12
13
14
* [AVP]
15
16
17
18
15.4.6
19
Maximum-Authorized-Aggregate-Bandwidth-for-Best-Effort-Traffic
The Maximum-Authorized-Aggregate-Bandwidth-for-Best-Effort-Traffic AVP (AVP code
5535/9130) is of type Unsigned32. It shall indicate the maximum bandwidth with range 1 to
2**32 (binary value of the maximum allowed aggregate bandwidth, in bits per second) that
may be allocated to a user for best-effort traffic.
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
15.4.7
27
Authorized-Flow-Profile-IDs-for-the-User
The Authorized-Flow-Profile-IDs-for-the-User AVP (AVP code 5535/9131) is a Grouped
AVP. It provides the list of Flow Profile IDs that the user is allowed to specify/request in a
QoS_Sub_Blob.
28
29
30
31
32
33
* [ProfileID-Forward]
* [ProfileID-Reverse]
* [ProfileID-Bi-direction]
* [AVP]
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
15.4.8
Inter-User-Priority
The Inter-User-Priority AVP (AVP code 5535/9139) is of type Integer32. It indicates the
inter-user priority assigned to the user for best effort traffic. The low order 3 bits shall indicate
the inter-user priority used for scheduling packets (ref. X.S0011 [6]). Priority 7 is the highest
and 0 is the lowest.
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
249
15.4.9
Maximum-Per-Flow-Priority-for-the-User
The Maximum-Per-Flow-Priority-for-the-User AVP (AVP code 5535/9133) is of type
Integer32. It indicates the maximum priority that may be assigned to users packet flow. The
low order 4 bits shall indicate the maximum priority that the user can specify for a packet data
flow. Priority 15 is the highest and 0 is the lowest. Specifically:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
15.4.10
10
9
11
12
ProfileID-Forward
13
The ProfileID-Forward AVP (AVP code 5535/35) is of type Integer32. It is used to indicate
Flow Profile ID that the user is allowed to request on the forward link. The Flow Profile ID
shall be included in the least significant 16 bits. The most significant 16 bits shall be set to 0.
14
15
16
17
18
15.4.11
19
ProfileID-Reverse
20
The ProfileID-Reverse AVP (AVP code 5535/36) is of type Integer32. It is used to indicate
Flow Profile ID that the user is allowed to request on the reverse link. The Flow Profile ID
shall be included in the least significant 16 bits. The most significant 16 bits shall be set to 0.
21
22
23
24
25
15.4.12
26
ProfileID-Bi-Directional
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
15.4.13
Max-Link-Flows
34
35
The Max-Link-Flows AVP (AVP code 5535/57) is of type Unsigned32. It shall indicate the
maximum number of link flows that the user is allowed to establish.
15.4.14
36
37
38
39
Service-Option-Number
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
250
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
Priority
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
In addition to these standard QCIs, operators are allowed to define additional QCIs for specific
services in which the standard QCIs are insufficient. An example is a public safety service where the
operator may want a unique priority associated with the service.
On the other hand, eHRPD uses FlowProfileIDs (see 3GPP2 C.R1001 [12]). A FlowProfileID is a
scalar value representing a flow description. A flow description specifies all relevant air interface
parameters necessary to support a particular packet data service. There are hundreds of flow
descriptions identified in C.R1001 [12] with a FlowProfileID associated with each description.
36
37
38
39
40
41
The QCIs are used exclusively in the EPC and E-UTRAN portion of the network while FlowProfileIDs
are used exclusively in the eHRPD portion of the network (see Figure 65). So the method used for
specifying service parameters for a particular service in eHRPD (namely FlowProfileIDs) shall be
mapped to the service parameters associated with the same service in EPC (namely QCIs).
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
251
HSS
SWx
2
3
S6a
PCRF
S1-MME
eNodeB
X2
E-UTRAN/
EPC
MME
S1-U
S101
Gxc
Gx
S11
Serving
Gateway
PDN
Gateway
S5
IETF
Rx
Gxa
SGi
Operators IP
Services (e.g, IMS,
PSS, etc.)
8
9
10
S6b
S103
S2a
3GPP AAA
Server
STa
11
12
13
14
15
eHRPD
QoS managed by
3GPP QCIs
HSGW
H1/H2
Pi*
3GPP2
AAA Proxy
A13/A16
HRPD BTS
17
18
A10/A11
eAN/ePCF
16
19
A12
AN-AAA
QoS managed by
3GPP2 Flow Profile
IDs
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
1.
31
2.
For a given QCI to FlowProfileID association, map the GBR value used in 3GPP to the data
rate associated with the FlowProfileID.
33
From the characteristics of the 3GPP2 FlowProfileID, find the associated 3GPP QCI.
2.
From the bit rate of the 3GPP2 FlowProfileID, determine the 3GPP GBR.
32
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
Mapping across technologies is only to convey the type of service. Therefore, the mapping
will associate QCI values with FlowProfileID values.
45
48
The mapping maintained in the HSGW may be customized by the operator and is guided by
the services deployed by the operator.
When mapping between FlowProfileID data rates and GBR, the following considerations
apply:
46
47
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
252
a.
When mapping from a FlowProfileID data rate to GBR, a bit rate shall be
calculated such that the EPS bearer supports the service.
b.
c.
It is assumed that both the FlowProfileID data rates and the GBR data rate
values include IP/UDP/RTP headers. The IP/UDP/RTP components being
referred to are not part of the tunneling header.
d.
It is further assumed that for variable data rate GBR services (e.g., voice), the
peak data rate value is used to represent the GBR data rate values.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
5.
Given that a set of FlowProfileIDs is provided to the HSGW, the HSGW maps the
FlowProfileIDs to a single QCI when considering the service characteristics. To facilitate this
mapping, the UE should select FlowProfileIDs that have similar QoS characteristics resulting
in the same QCI.
6.
When multiple bit rates are indicated by the FlowProfileIDs, the operator determines (based
on operator determined charging rules, etc.) the mapping of the QCI information returned by
the PCRF to a set (one or more) of FlowProfileIDs that are sent to the UE.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
253
Table 64
QCI
Resource
Type
(bit rate
included
if GBR)
GBR
(32.8
kbps1)
Priority
GBR
(32.8
kbps2)
GBR
(37.6
kbps1)
GBR
(24 kbps)
GBR
(32 kbps)
GBR
(40 kbps)
GBR
(48 kbps)
GBR
(64 kbps)
33
GBR
GBR
(24 kbps)
2
2
5
5
GBR
(64 kbps)
GBR
(128
kbps)
4
4
NonGBR
NonGBR
Packet
Delay
Budget
100 ms
100 ms
100 ms
150 ms
150 ms
150 ms
150 ms
150 ms
50 ms
300 ms
300 ms
300 ms
100 ms
100 ms
Packet
Error
Loss
Rate
Example
Services
10-2
10
PTT Voice
Conversational
Voice
10-2
10
-3
10
-3
10
-3
Conversational
Video (Live
Streaming)
Conversational
Video (Live
Streaming)
Conversational
Video (Live
Streaming)
Conversational
Video (Live
Streaming)
Conversational
Video (Live
Streaming)
Real Time
Gaming
NonConversational
Video (Buffered
Streaming)
NonConversational
Video (Buffered
Streaming)
NonConversational
Video (Buffered
Streaming)
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-6
10-6
10
eHRPD
FlowProfileID
0x0100
-2
-6
10-6
10-6
0x0118
0x0101
eHRPD Flow
Description
3
4
5
6
Conversational
Rate Set 1
Speech
PTT Rate set 1
Speech
(maximum of 6
frames bundled)
Conversational
Rate Set 2
Speech
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
0x0300
Conversational
Video Streaming
0x0301
Conversational
Video Streaming
0x0302
Conversational
Video Streaming
25
Conversational
Video Streaming
28
Conversational
Video Streaming
31
34
0x0005
Real Time
Gaming
0x030c
Video Streaming
19
20
21
22
23
24
0x0303
0x0305
26
27
29
30
32
33
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
0x030e
Video Streaming
42
43
44
45
0x0311
PTT Control
Signaling
0x0503
IMS Signaling
0x0500
Video Streaming
Real Time
Control
Signaling
Conversational
Control
Signaling
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
254
Resource
Type
(bit rate
included
if GBR)
Priority
NonGBR
300 ms
10-6
NonGBR
100 ms
10-3
NonGBR
NonGBR
1
2
3
QCI
4
5
Packet
Delay
Budget
Packet
Error
Loss
Rate
Video (Buffered
Streaming) TCPbased (e.g., www,
e-mail, chat, ftp,
p2p file sharing,
progressive video,
etc.)
Voice,
Video (Live
Streaming)
Interactive
Gaming
TCP-based (e.g.,
www, e-mail,
chat, ftp, p2p file
sharing,
progressive video,
etc.)
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
8
9
300 ms
Example
Services
10-6
24
eHRPD
FlowProfileID
eHRPD Flow
Description
0x0000
Best effort
0x0600
Interactive
Gaming
0x0000
Best effort
0x0000
Best effort
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
Footnote 1:
Assumptions for GBR rate set 1 and rate set 2 calculations:
Rate Set 1 and rate set 2 conversational voice, no voice-frame bundling, and no header
compression.
This yields 1 voice frame carried in 1 IP packet every 20ms in each (uplink and downlink)
direction.
Assume GBR accounts for the peak data rate; therefore data rate of only the full rate frame is
used.
Rate Set 1 Full Rate frame: 171 bits => 22 octets
Rate Set 2 Full Rate frame: 266 bits => 34 octets
RTP Header = 12 octets
UDP Header = 8 octets
IPv4 Header = 20 octets
IPv6 Header = 40 octets
Rate Set 1 GBRv4 = (22+12+8+20)*8*50 = 24.8 kbps (use rate set 1 GBRv6 value).
Rate Set 1 GBRv6 = (22+12+8+40)*8*50 = 32.8 kbps => use 32.8.
Rate Set 2 GBRv4 = (34+12+8+20)*8*50 = 29.6 kbps (use rate set 2 GBRv6 value).
Rate Set 2 GBRv6 = (34+12+8+40)*8*50 = 37.6 kbps => use 37.6 kbps in each direction.
Footnote 2:
The maximum bit rate for PTT using FlowProfileID 0x0118 is the same as that for FlowProfileID
0x0100. It is possible that bundling may occur, and in that case, the bit rate would be reduced.
Footnote 3:
There is no GBR FlowProfileID in C.R1001 that provides 50 ms maximum latency. FlowProfileID
0x0005 provides 100 ms maximum latency and supports 32 kbps as a close approximation for QCI 3,
55
56
57
58
59
60
255
2
3
4
5
The information received across the Gxa interface is illustrated in Table 65 along with an
indication if it is required and how it is used in eHRPD.
6
7
8
9
Table 65
Attribute Name
Reference
(3GPP TS
29.212
Clause)
[31]
Description
3GPP-MSTimeZone
3GPP TS
29.061
[30]
3GPP-SGSNAddress
3GPP TS
29.061
[30]
3GPP-SGSNIPv6-Address
3GPP TS
29.061
[30]
AN-GW-Address
5.3.49
10
All
eHRPD Mapping
11
Need
on Gxa
for
eHRPD
access
No mapping
required.
No
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
Carries the
address of the
serving HSGW.
Yes
No mapping
required.
No
No mapping
required.
No
No mapping
required.
Yes
No mapping
required.
No
Note 3
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
All
All
3GPP-SGSNMCC-MNC
3GPP TS
29.061
[30]
3GPP-UserLocation-Info
3GPP TS
29.061
[30]
3GPP
3GPP2-BSID
3GPP2
X.S0011
[6]
3GPP2
AccessNetworkChargingIdentifier-Value
3GPP TS
29.214
[33]
Allocation-andRetentionPriority
5.3.32
APN-AggregateMax-Bitrate-DL
26
27
28
29
30
31
All
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
All
5.3.39
APN-AggregateMax-Bitrate-UL
5.3.40
Bearer-ControlMode
5.3.23
Called-StationID
41
No mapping
required.
Yes
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
IETF RFC
4005 [71]
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
53
PDNConnection-ID
5.3.58
All
No mappring
required.
Yes
55
CC-RequestNumber
IETF RFC
4006 [72]
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
57
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
54
56
58
59
60
256
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
eHRPD Mapping
Need
on Gxa
for
eHRPD
access
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
All
Yes
CC-RequestType
IETF RFC
4006 [72]
User-CSGInformation
3GPP TS
32.299
[41]
4
6
Access
type
Reference
(3GPP TS
29.212
Clause)
[31]
3
5
Description
Attribute Name
Event-Trigger
5.3.7
Flow-Description
3GPP TS
29.214
[33]
Flow-Information
5.3.53
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
Flow-Label
5.3.52
All
No mappring
required.
Yes
Framed-IPAddress
IETF RFC
4005 [71]
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
Framed-IPv6Prefix
IETF RFC
4005 [71]
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
Guaranteed-Bit
Rate-DL (note 1)
5.3.25
All
Yes
Guaranteed-Bit
Rate-UL (note 1)
5.3.26
All
Yes
IP-CAN-Type
5.3.27
All
Yes
3GPP TS
29.214
[33]
All
Yes
3GPP TS
29.214
[33]
All
Yes
5.3.54
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
Packet-FilterIdentifier
5.3.55
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
Packet-FilterInformation
5.3.56
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
Max-RequestedBandwidth-UL
(note 2)
46
Max-RequestedBandwidth-DL
47
(note 2)
45
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
Packet-FilterContent
56
57
58
59
60
257
Attribute Name
Packet-FilterOperation
Packet-FilterUsage
Reference
(3GPP TS
29.212
Clause)
[31]
Description
5.3.57
All
All
All
All
5.3.66
NetworkRequestSupport
5.3.24
Precedence
5.3.11
Access
type
eHRPD Mapping
Need
on Gxa
for
eHRPD
access
No mapping
required.
Yes
No mapping
required.
Yes
No mapping
required.
Yes
Yes
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
PCC-RuleStatus
5.3.19
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
QoS-ClassIdentifier (QCI)
5.3.17
All
See Annex A.
Yes
QoS-Information
5.3.16
All
Yes
All
No Mapping
required.
Yes
29
3GPPGPRS
No mapping
required.
No
31
Default-EPSBearer-Qos
RAI
RAT-Type
5.3.48
3GPP TS
29.061
[30]
5.3.31
23
24
27
28
30
32
33
All
Yes
No mapping
required.
Yes
34
35
36
37
5.3.41
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
RuleDeactivationTime
5.3.42
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
Rule-FailureCode
5.3.38
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
SecurityParameter-Index
5.3.51
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
SessionRelease-Cause
5.3.44
All
No mappring
required.
Yes
Rule-ActivationTime
22
26
All
5.3.50
21
25
ResourceAllocationNotification
20
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
258
Attribute Name
Reference
(3GPP TS
29.212
Clause)
[31]
Subscription-Id
IETF RFC
4006 [72]
3GPP TS
29.229
[34]
2
3
4
5
6
7
Description
Access
type
eHRPD Mapping
Need
on Gxa
for
eHRPD
access
All
Yes
All
No mapping
required.
Yes
All
HSGW may
include this in the
TFT sent to or
received from the
UE.
Yes.
8
9
SupportedFeatures
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
ToS-TrafficClass
5.3.15
Trace-Data
3GPP TS
29.272
[35]
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
Trace-Reference
3GPP TS
29.272
[35]
3GPPEPS
No mapping
required.
No
Tunnel-HeaderFilter
5.3.34
Non-3GPP
No mapping
required.
No.
Tunnel-HeaderLength
5.3.35
Non-3GPP
No mapping
required.
No
TunnelInformation
5.3.36
Non-3GPP
No mapping
required.
No
All
Yes
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
User-EquipmentInfo
IETF RFC
4006 [72]
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
NOTE 1: When sending from the PCRF to the BBERF, the Guaranteed-Bit-Rate-UL/DL AVP indicate the
allowed guaranteed bit rate for the uplink/downlink direction; when sending from the BBERF to the
PCRF, the Guaranteed-Bit-Rate-UL/DL AVP indicate the requested guaranteed bit rate for the
uplink/downlink direction.
NOTE 2: When sending from the PCRF to the BBERF, the Max-Requested-Bandwidth-UL/DL AVP indicate the
maximum allowed bit rate for the uplink/downlink direction; when sending from the BBERF to the
PCRF, the Max-Requested-Bandwidth-UL/DL AVP indicate the maximum requested bit rate for the
uplink/downlink direction.
NOTE 3:
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
259
2
3
4
The following table provides a brief description of CDR parameters specified in 3GPP TS
32.251 [40] for offline charging, along with an indication if it is required and how it is used in
eHRPD. The categorization of the CDRs as Mandatory (M), Conditional (C) or Operator
Optional (OM or OC) shall be as specified in 3GPP TS 32.251 [40]. The use of these
parameters for IP CAN bearer charging (IPBC) and/or for Flow Based Bearer Charging
(FBC) is also indicated.
Table 66
Field
Record Type
Category
Needed
for
eHRPD
access
eHRPD
Mapping
Charging
Mode
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
10
11
12
15
16
17
20
21
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
Served IMSI
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
OC
19
Served IMEISV
18
OC
14
Record Type
IMSI
Unauthenticated
Flag
13
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
S-GW Address
used
Served 3GPP2
MEID
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
35
Served MN NAI
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
37
P-GW Address
used
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
39
Charging ID
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
PDN Connection
Id
OM
33
34
36
38
40
41
42
43
44
45
Serving node
Address
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
Serving node
Address
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
48
Serving node
Type
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
Note -1
50
Serving node
Type
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
46
47
49
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
260
Field
Category
Description
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Needed
for
eHRPD
access
eHRPD
Mapping
Charging
Mode
S-GW Change
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
PGW PLMN
Identifier
Oc
No
Not
Supported
IPBC
FBC
Access Point
Name Network
Identifier
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
PDP/PDN Type
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Served
PDP/PDN
Address
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Dynamic Address
Flag
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
List of Service
Data
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
List of Traffic
Data Volumes
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
OC
No
Not
Supported
IPBC
FBC
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
Record Opening
Time
MS Time Zone
30
31
32
Duration
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
Duration
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
Diagnostics
Record
Sequence
Number
OM
C
Node ID
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Record
Extensions
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Local Record
Sequence
Number
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
APN Selection
Mode
OM
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Served MSISDN
OM
No
Not
Supported
IPBC
FBC
57
58
59
60
261
Field
Category
Description
Needed
for
eHRPD
access
eHRPD
Mapping
Charging
Mode
OC
No
Not
Supported
IPBC
FBC
User CSG
information
OC
No
Not
Supported
IPBC
FBC
3GPP2 User
Location
information
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
No Mapping
Required
FBC
Charging
Characteristics
Selection Mode
OM
IMS Signalling
Context
OC
External
Charging
Identifier
OC
P-GW Address
used.
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Yes
A Charging Identifier received from a nonEPC, external network entity. Used of IM-CN
Subsystem
Yes
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
Serving Node
PLMN Identifier
OC
No
Not
supported
IPBC
FBC
PS Furnish
Charging
Information
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
FBC
CAMEL
Information
OC
No
Not
Supported
FBC
RAT Type
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Start Time
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
OC
Yes
No Mapping
Required
IPBC
FBC
Stop Time
2
3
User Location
Information
Charging
Characteristics
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
Note-1:
At this time there is no definition for Serving Node Type of eAN or ePCF in 3GPP specifications. The operator may
choose to set this field according to operator policy.
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
262
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Table 67
21
22
23
24
25
26
Description
The HSGW shall forward the MaximumAuthorized-Aggregate-Bandwidth-for-Best-EffortTraffic parameter, if available, as part of the
Subscriber QoS Profile via A11-Session Update
message to the eAN/ePCF.
Shall be set to the value in the Authorized-FlowProfileIDs-for-the-User AVP received from the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server.
Shall be set to the value in the Maximum-PerFlowPriority-for-the-User AVP received from the
3GPP2 AAA Proxy/Server.
Shall be set to the value in the Service-OptionProfile AVP received from the 3GPP2 AAA
Proxy/Server.
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
263
Description
HSGW shall forward Inter-User Priority for BestEffort Traffic parameter, if available, to the
eAN/ePCF via A11-Session Update message.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
264
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Table 68
11
12
13
14
15
Deriving 3GPP2 Access Network QoS Parameters from 3GPP EPS Parameters
16
17
Derived from the Priority in QCI in the EPSSubscribed-QoS-Profile AVP in the APNConfiguration associated with the default bearer for
the default APN.
Note 2.
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Derived from the Priority in the ARP in the EPSSubscribed-QoS-Profile AVP in the APNConfiguration associated with the default bearer for
the default APN.
Note 3.
25
26
27
28
29
Note 1:
The UE-AMBR value is stored as a subscription parameter at the HSS. Subscribed UEAMBR AVP is received at the HSGW during the UE Authentication and Authorization
procedure within the APN-Configuration Grouped AVP.
30
31
32
The Maximum Authorized Aggregate Bandwidth for Best-Effort Traffic parameter can be
derived from the DL Data Rate (Max-Requested-Bandwidth-DL) value in the 3GPP
subscribed AMBR AVP. While mapping from the 3GPP E-UTRAN data rates to 3GPP2
eHRPD network data rates, consideration needs to be given to the difference in the data
rates supported by the two networks.
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
Note 2:
The QCI value is received at the HSGW in the EPS Subscribed QoS-Profile (ref. sec 7.3.37,
3GPP TS 29.272 [35]) AVP within the APN-Configuration Grouped AVP associated with the
default bearer for the default APN during the Authentication and Authorization procedure.
40
41
42
The Inter-User Priority for Best-Effort Traffic parameter can be derived from the Priority
parameter associated with the QoS-Class-Identifier (QCI) value.
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
Note 3:
The ARP value is received at the HSGW in the EPS-Subscribed-QoS-Profile AVP within the
APN-Configuration Grouped AVP associated with the default bearer for the default APN
during the Authentication and Authorization procedure.
The Inter-User Priority for Best-Effort Traffic parameter can be derived from the Priority
parameter associated with the Allocation-Retention-Priority (ARP) value.
Inter-User Priority for Best-Effort Traffic parameter can also be derived from both the Priority
parameter associated with the QoS-Class-Identifier (QCI) value and with the AllocationRetention-Priority (ARP) value.
55
56
57
58
59
60
265